home *** CD-ROM | disk | FTP | other *** search
- Path: igor.rutgers.edu!rutgers!sun-barr!cs.utexas.edu!uunet!peora!tarpit!tous!bilver!dona
- From: dona@bilver.uucp (Don Allen)
- Newsgroups: alt.conspiracy
- Subject: FILE: Committee of 300 - Part 1
- Message-ID: <1992Nov15.193939.26364@bilver.uucp>
- Date: 15 Nov 92 19:39:39 GMT
- Organization: W. J. Vermillion - Winter Park, FL
- Lines: 877
-
-
- Copyright (C) 1992 by Dr. John Coleman
-
- "Conspirators' Hierarchy: The Story of the Committee of 300", by
- Dr. John Coleman, is reproduced here with the permission of the
- publisher: American West Publishers.
-
-
-
- CONSPIRATORS'
- HIERARCHY:
- THE STORY OF THE
- COMMITTEE OF 300
-
-
-
- Dr. John Coleman
-
-
-
- FOREWARD
-
-
-
- In my career as a professional intelligence officer, I had
- many occasions to access highly classified documents, but dur-
- ing service as a political science officer in the field in Angola,
- West Africa, I had the opportunity to view a series of top secret
- classified documents which were unusually explicit. What I saw
- filled me with anger and resentment and launched me on a
- course from which I have not deviated, namely to uncover what
- power it is that controls and manages the British and United
- States governments.
- I was thoroughly familiar with all of the well known secret
- societies such as the Royal Institute for International Affairs
- (RIIA), the Council on Foreign Relations (CFR), the Bilder-
- bergers, Trilaterals, the Zionists, Freemasonry, Bolshevism-
- Rosicrucianism and all of the spinoffs of these secret societies.
- As an intelligence officer, and even before that as a young
- student in the course of my studies at the British Museum in
- London, I had cut my eye teeth on all of them, plus a good
- number of others with whom I imagined Americans were familiar.
- But when I came to the United States in 1969, I found that
- names like the Order of St. John of Jerusalem, Club of Rome
- the German Marshall Fund, the Cini Foundation, the Round
- Table, the Fabianists, the Venetian Black Nobility, the Mont
- Pelerin Society, Hellfire Clubs, and many others were at best
- totally unknown here, or else their true functions were at best
- but poorly understood, if at all.
-
- i
-
- In 1969-1970 set about remedying the situation in a series
- of monographs and cassette tapes. Much to my surprise I soon
- found plenty of people willing to quote these names as if they
- had known of them all of their writing careers, but who were not
- in the least bit knowledgeable about the subjects, yet quite
- unwilling to state the source of their lately acquired informa-
- tion. I consoled myself with the thought that imitation is the
- sincerest form of flattery.
- I pursued my investigations, pressing on in the face of
- severe risks, attacks on myself and my wife, financial losses,
- continual harassment, threats and calumny, all part of a care-
- fully-crafted and orchestrated program to discredit me, run by
- government agents and informers, embedded in the so-called
- Christian rightwing, the "Identity Movement" and rightwing
- "patriotic" groups. These agents operated, and still operate,
- under cover of strong and fearless outspoken opposition to
- Judaism their main enemy, they would have us believe. These
- agent-informers are led and controlled by a group of homosexu-
- als who are well-liked and well-respected by political and reli-
- gious conservatives all across the United States.
- Their program of calumny, lies and hatred, disinformation
- about my work, even lately attributing it to other writers, contin-
- ues unabated but it has not had the desired effect. I shall carry on
- with my task until I have finally ripped off the mask of the entire
- secret upper-level parallel government that runs Britain and the
- U.S. This book is a part of that ongoing effort.
-
- Dr. John Coleman, November 1991
-
- ii
-
-
-
- TABLE OF CONTENTS
-
- FORWARD - i
-
- AN OVERVIEW AND SOME CASE HISTORIES - 1
-
- INSTITUTIONS THROUGH WHICH
- CONTROL IS EXERCISED - 48
-
- PAST AND PRESENT INSTITUTIONS/ORGANIZATIONS
- AND THOSE DIRECTLY UNDER INFLUENCE OF THE
- COMMITTEE OF 300 - 221
-
- SPECIAL FOUNDATIONS AND INTEREST GROUPS - 226
-
- BANKS - 227
-
- LEGAL ASSOCIATIONS AND LAWYERS - 231
-
- ACCOUNTANTS/AUDITORS - 232
-
- TAVISTOCK INSTITUTIONS IN THE UNITED STATES - 232
-
- BIBLIOGRAPHY, SUMMARIES AND NOTES - 253
-
-
-
- Copyright (C) 1992 by Dr. John Coleman
-
- "Conspirators' Hierarchy: The Story of the Committee of 300" by
- Dr. John Coleman, is reproduced here with the permission of the
- publishers: America West Publishers.
-
-
- AN OVERVIEW AND SOME CASE HISTORIES
-
- Certainly a fair number of us are aware that the people
- running our government are not the people who are really in
- control of political and economic matters, domestic and foreign.
- This has led many to seek the truth in the alternative press, those
- newsletter writers who, like me, have sought, but not always
- found what it is that is making the United States terminally ill.
- "Seek and ye shall find" has not always been the case with this
- group. What we did find was that the people walk in great
- darkness, mostly not caring or bothering to find out where their
- country is headed, firm in the belief that it will always be there
- for them. This is the way the largest population group has been
- manipulated to react, and their attitude plays right into the hands
- of the secret government.
- We frequently hear about "they " doing this, that or the other.
- "They" seem literally to be able to get away with murder.
- "They" increase taxes, send our sons and daughters to die in
- wars that do not benefit our country. "They" seem above our
- reach, out of sight, frustratingly nebulous when it comes to
- taking action against "them." No one seems able to clearly
- identify who "they" are. It is a situation that has pertained for
- decades. During the course of this book, we shall identify the
- mysterious "they" and then, after that, it is up to the people to
- remedy their situation.
- On 30th April 1981, I wrote a monograph disclosing the
- existence of the Club of Rome identifying it as a Committee of
-
- 1
-
- 3OO subversive body. This was the first mention of both of these
- organizations in the United States. I warned readers not to be
- fooled by the feeling that the article was far-fetched and I drew a
- parallel between my article and the warning issued by the
- Bavarian government when the secret plans of the Illuminati fell
- into its hands. We shall return to the Club of Rome and the role
- of the Committee of 300 in U.S. affairs later herein.
- Many of the predictions made in that 1981 article have since
- come to pass, such as the unknown Felipe Gonzalez becoming
- prime minister of Spain, and Mitterand being returned to power
- in France; the downfall of Giscard D' Estang and Helmut
- Schmidt, the return to power of Swedish nobleman and Com-
- mittee of 300 member Olaf Palme, the nullifying of Reagan's
- presidency and the destruction of our steel, auto and housing
- industries in terms of the post-industrial zero-growth order
- handed down by the Committee of 300.
- The importance of Palme lies in the use made of him by the
- Club of Rome to deliver technology to the Soviet Union on the
- forbidden list of the U.S. Customs, and Palme's world-wide
- communications network employed to train the spotlight on the
- phony Iran hostage crisis, while he shuttled back and forth
- between Washington and Teheran in an effort to undermine the
- sovereign integrity of the U.S. and place the phony crisis in the
- realm of a Committee of 300 institution, viz, the World Court at
- The Hague, Holland.
- In what is in fact an open conspiracy against God and man,
- which includes enslaving the majority of humans left on this
- earth after wars, plagues and mass-murder have done with them
- is not well hidden. In the intelligence community, it is taught
- that the best way to hide something is to place it in open view.
- As an example of the foregoing, when Germany wanted to hide
- its prize new Messerschmidt fighter plane in 1938, the aircraft
- was put on display at the Paris Air Show. While secret agents
- and spies were collecting information from hollow tree trunks
- and from behind loose bricks in a wall, the information they
-
- 2
-
- sought was staring them right in the face.
- The upper-level parallel secret government does not operate
- from dank basements and secret underground chambers. It places
- itself in full view in the White House, Congress and in Number
- 10 Downing Street and the Houses of Parliament. It is akin to
- those weird and supposedly terrifying "monster" films, where
- the monster appears with distorted features, long hair and even
- longer teeth, growling and slavering all over the place. This is
- distraction, the REAL MONSTERS wear business suits and
- drive to work on Capitol Hill in limousines.
- These men are IN OPEN VIEW. These men are the servants
- of the One World Government-New World Order. Like the
- rapist who stops to offer his victim a friendly ride, he does not
- LOOK like the monster he is. If he did, his intended victim
- would run off screaming in fright. The same applies to govern-
- ment at all levels. President Bush does not LOOK like a dutiful
- servant of the upper-level parallel government, but make no
- mistake about it, he is as much a MONSTER as are those
- horrors found in horror-movies.
- Stop for a moment and consider how President Bush ordered
- the brutal slaying of 150,000 Iraqi troops, in a convoy of military
- vehicles carrying white flags, on their way back to Iraq under
- Geneva Convention rules of agreed disengagement and with-
- drawal. Imagine the horror of the Iraqi troops when, in spite of
- waving their white flags, they were mowed down by American
- aircraft. In another part of the front, 12,000 Iraqi soldiers were
- buried alive in trenches they occupied. Is that not MONSTROUS
- in the truest sense of the word? From where did President Bush
- get his orders to act in this MONSTROUS fashion? He got them
- from the Royal Institute for International Affairs (RIIA) who
- received its mandate from the Committee of 300, also known as
- the "Olympians."
- As we shall see, even the "Olympians" do not hide their
- faces. Often times they put on a show which could be likened to
- the Paris Air Show, even as conspiracy buffs spend their time in
-
- 3
-
- fruitless searching in the wrong places and in the wrong direc-
- tion. Note how the Queen, Elizabeth II, performs the ceremonial
- opening of the British Parliament? There, in full view is the
- head of the Committee of 300. Have you ever witnessed the
- swearing-in ceremony of a United States President? There in
- full view is another member of the Committee of 300. The
- problem is only one of perception.
- Who are the conspirators who serve the mighty all-powerful
- Committee of 300? The better-informed of our citizens are
- aware that there is a conspiracy and that the conspiracy goes
- under various names such as the Illuminati, Freemasonry, the
- Round Table, the Milner Group. To them the CFR and the
- Trilaterals represent most of what they do not like in regard to
- domestic and foreign policy. Some even know that the Round
- Table has a big input into United States affairs through the
- British ambassador in Washington. The problem is that real hard
- information on the treasonous activities of members of the
- invisible Government is very hard to come by.
- I quote the profound statement made by the prophet Hosea,
- which is found in the Christian Bible: "My people perish for lack
- of knowledge." Some may already have heard my expose of the
- foreign aid scandal, in which work I named several conspirato-
- rial organizations, whose number is legion. Their final objective
- was the overthrow of the U.S. Constitution and the merging of this
- country, chosen by God as HIS country, with a godless One
- World-New World Order Government which will return the
- world to conditions far worse than existed in the Dark Ages.
- Let us talk about actual case histories, the attempt to com-
- munize and deindustrialize Italy. The Committee of 300 long
- ago decreed that there shall be a smaller--much smaller--and
- better world, that is, their idea of what constitutes a better world.
- the myriads of useless eaters consuming scarce natural re-
- sources were to be culled. Industrial progress supports popula-
- tion growth. Therefore the command to multiply and subdue the
- earth found in Genesis had to be subverted.
-
- 4
-
- This called for an attack upon Christianity; the slow but sure
- disintegration of industrial nation states; the destruction of hun-
- dreds of millions of people, referred to by the Committee of 300
- as "surplus population," and the removal of any leader who
- dared to stand in the way of the Committee's global planning to
- reach the foregoing objectives.
- Two of the Committee's earliest targets were Italy and Paki-
- stan. The late Aldo Moro, Prime Minister of Italy, was one
- leader who opposed "zero growth" and population reductions
- planned for his country, thereby incurring the wrath of the Club
- of Rome commissioned by the "Olympians" to carry out its
- policies in this regard. In a Rome courtroom on November 1Oth,
- 1982, a close friend of Moro's testified that the former prime
- minister was threatened by an agent of the Royal Institute for
- International Affairs (RIIA) who is also a Committee of 300
- member while he was still the U.S. Secretary of State. The
- meteoric rise of the man the witness named as Kissinger will be
- dealt with later.
- It will be recalled that Prime Minister Moro was kidnaped by
- the Red Brigades in 1978 and subsequently brutally shot to death.
- It was at the trial of members of the Red Brigades that several of
- them testified to the fact that they knew of high-level U.S.
- involvement in the plot to kill Moro. When threatening Moro,
- Kissinger was obviously not carrying out U.S. foreign policy, but
- rather acting according to instructions received from the Club of
- Rome, the foreign-policy arm of the Committee of 3OO.
- The witness who delivered the bombshell in open court was
- a close associate of Moro's, Gorrado Guerzoni. His explosive
- testimony was broadcast over Italian television and radio on
- November lOth, 1982, and printed in several Italian newspa-
- pers yet this vital information was suppressed in the U.S.
- Those famous bastions of freedom with a compelling right to
- know, the Washington Post and the New York Times, did not
- think it important to even print a single line of Guerzoni's
- testimony.
-
- 5
-
- Nor was the news carried by any of the wire services or
- television stations. The fact that Italy's Aldo Moro had been a
- leading politician for decades, and who was kidnaped in broad
- daylight in the spring of 1978, all of his bodyguards butchered
- in cold blood, was not deemed newsworthy, even though
- Kissinger stood accused as an accomplice to these crimes? Or
- was the silence BECAUSE of Kissinger's involvement?
- In my 1982 expose of this heinous crime, I demonstrated
- that Aldo Moro, a loyal member of the Christian Democrat
- Party, was murdered by assassins controlled by P2 Masonry
- with the object of bringing Italy into line with Club of Rome
- orders to deindustrialize the country and considerably reduce its
- population. Moro's plans to stabilize Italy through full employ-
- ment and industrial and political peace would have strengthened
- Catholic opposition to Communism and made the destabilization
- of the Middle East--a prime goal--that much harder.
- From the foregoing it becomes clear just how far ahead the
- conspirators plan. They do not think in terms of a Five Year
- Plan. One needs to go back to Weishaupt's statements about the
- early Catholic Church to understand what was involved in the
- murder of Aldo Moro. Moro's death removed the roadblocks to
- the plans to destabilize Italy, and as we now know, enabled
- conspiracy plans for the Middle East to be carried out in the
- Gulf War 14 years later.
- Italy was chosen as a test-target by the Committee of 300.
- Italy is important to the conspirators' plans because it is the
- closest European country to the Middle East linked to Middle
- East economics and politics. It is also the home of the Catholic
- Church, which Weishaupt ordered destroyed, and home for
- some of Europe's most powerful top oligarchical families of the
- ancient Black Nobility. Should Italy have been weakened by
- Moro's death, it would have had repercussions in the Middle
- East which would have weakened U.S. influence in the region.
- Italy is important for another reason; it is a gateway for drugs
- entering Europe from Iran and Lebanon, and we shall return to
-
- 6
-
- that subject in due course.
- Various groups had combined under the name of socialism
- to bring about the downfall of several Italian governments since
- the Club of Rome was established in 1968. Among these are the
- Black Nobility of Venice and Genoa, P2 Masonry and the Red
- Brigades, all working for the same goals. Police investigators in
- Rome working on the Red Brigades-Aldo Moro case came
- across the names of several very prominent Italian families
- working closely with this terrorist group. The police also dis-
- covered evidence that in at least a dozen cases, these powerful
- and prominent families had allowed their homes and/or property
- to be used as safe houses for Red Brigades cells.
- America's "nobility" were doing their share to destroy the
- Republic of Italy, a notable contribution having come from
- Richard Gardner even while in his official capacity as President
- Carter's ambassador to Rome. At that time Gardner was operat-
- ing under the direct control of Bettino Craxi, an important
- member of the Club of Rome and a key man in NATO. Craxi
- was the leading edge of the conspirators' attempts to destroy the
- Italian Republic. As we shall see, Craxi was almost successful
- in ruining Italy, and as the conspirators hierarchy's leading
- player, was able to get divorce and abortion pushed through the
- Italian Parliament, resulting in the most far-reaching and de-
- structive religious and social changes ever to strike at the Catholic
- Church, and consequently, the morals of the Italian nation.
- After President Ronald Reagan was elected, an important
- meeting was held in Washington D.C. in December 1980 under
- the auspices of the Club of Rome and the Socialist International.
- Both these organizations are directly responsible to the Com-
- mittee of 300. The main agenda was to formulate ways and
- means of how to neutralize the Reagan presidency. A group plan
- was adopted and, as we look back, it is perfectly clear that the
- plan the conspirators agreed to follow has been very successful.
- In order to get an idea of how vast and how all-pervasive is
- this conspiracy, it would be appropriate at this point to name the
-
- 7
-
- goals set by the Committee of 300 for the pending conquest and
- control of the world. There are at least 40 known "branch
- offices" of the Committee of 300, and we shall be listing them
- all, together with a description of their functions. Once this is
- studied it becomes easy to understand how one central con-
- spiratorial body is able to operate so successfully and why it is
- that no power on earth can withstand their onslaught against the
- very foundations of a civilized, progressive world, based on
- freedom of the individual, especially as it is declared in the
- United States Constitution.
- Thanks to the sworn testimony of Guerzoni, Italy and Eu-
- rope but not the U.S. learned that Kissinger was behind the
- death of Aldo Moro. This tragic affair demonstrates the ability of
- the Committee of 300 to impose its will upon any government
- without exception. Secure in his position as a member of the
- most powerful secret society in the world, and I am not talking
- about Freemasonry, Kissinger not only terrified Moro, but carried
- through on his threats to "eliminate" Moro if he did not give up
- his plan to bring economic and industrial progress to Italy.
- In June and July of 1982, the wife of Aldo Moro testified in
- open court that her husband's murder came about as a result of
- serious threats against his life, made by what she called "a high
- ranking United States political figure." Mrs. Eleanora Moro
- repeated the precise phrase reportedly used by Kissinger in the
- sworn testimony of Guerzoni: "Either you stop your political
- line or you will pay dearly for it." Recalled by the judge,
- Guerzoni was asked if he could identify the person Mrs. Moro
- was talking about. Guerzoni replied that it was indeed Henry
- Kissinger as he had previously intimated.
- Guerzoni went on to explain to the court that Kissinger had
- made his threats in Moro's hotel room during the Italian leaders
- official visit to the U.S. Moro--then Prime Minister and Foreign
- Minister of Italy, a NATO member-country--was a man of high
- rank, one who should never have been subjected to Mafia-like
- pressures and threats. Moro was accompanied on his American
-
- 8
-
- visit by the President of Italy in his official capacity. Kissinger
- was then, and still is, an important agent in the service of the
- Royal Institute for International Affairs, a member of the Club
- of Rome and the Council on Foreign Relations.
- Kissinger's role in destabilizing the United States by means
- of three wars, the Middle East, Korea and Vietnam, is well
- known, as is his role in the Gulf War, in which the U.S. Army
- acted as mercenaries for the Committee of 300 in bringing
- Kuwait back under its control and at the same time making an
- example out of Iraq so that other small nations would not be
- tempted to work out their own destiny.
- Kissinger also threatened the late Ali Bhutto, President of
- the sovereign nation of Pakistan. Bhutto's "crime" was that he
- favored nuclear weapons for his country. As a Moslem state,
- Pakistan felt threatened by continued Israeli aggression in the
- Middle East. Bhutto was judicially murdered in 1979 by the
- Council on Foreign Relations representative in the country
- General Zia ul Haq.
- In his planned ascent to power, ul Haq encouraged a frenzied
- mob to set fire to the U.S. Embassy in Islamabad in an apparent
- attempt to show the CFR that he was his own man and to secure
- more foreign aid and, it was later learned, to murder Richard
- Helms. Several years later, ul Haq paid with his life for interven-
- ing in the war raging in Afghanistan. His C-130 Hercules aircraft
- was hit by an E.L.F. (electricallow frequency) shot shortly after
- it took off, causing the aircraft to loop into the ground.
- The Club of Rome, acting on Committee of 300 orders to
- eliminate General ul Haq, had no compunction in sacrificing the
- lives of a number of U.S. servicemen on board the flight,
- including a U.S. Army Defense Intelligence Agency group headed
- by Brigadier General Herber Wassom. General ul Haq had been
- warned by the Turkish Secret Service not to travel by plane, as
- he was targeted for a mid-air bombing. With this in mind, ul Haq
- took the United States team with him as "an insurance policy,"
- as he commented to his inner circle advisors.
-
- 9
-
- In my 1989 work "Terror' in the Skies," I gave the following
- account of what happened: "Shortly before ul Haq's C-130 took
- off from a Pakistan military base, a suspicious looking truck
- was seen close to the hangar that had housed the C-130. The
- control tower warned base security, but by the time action was
- taken, the C-130 was already airborne and the truck had gone. A
- few minutes later the plane began looping-the-loop until it hit
- the ground and exploded in a ball of fire. There is no explanation
- for such behavior by the C-130, an aircraft with a marvelously
- reliable record, and a joint Pakistani-United States board of
- enquiry Found no pilot error or mechanical or structural failure.
- Looping-the-loop is a recognized trade mark of an aircraft hit by
- E.L.F. fire.
- That the Soviet Union has been able to develop high-peak
- radio frequency devices is known to the West through the work
- of Soviet scientists who work in the Kurchatov Atomic Energy
- Institute's Intensive Relatavistic Electron Beam Division. Two
- of its specialists were Y. A. Vinograov and A. A. Rukhadze.
- Both scientists worked in the Lededev Physics Institute, which
- specializes in electronic and X ray lasers.
- After receiving this information, I searched for confirmation
- from other sources and found that in England the International
- journal of Electronics had published some material which ap-
- peared to confirm the information given to me about the method
- chosen to shoot down General ul Haq's C-130. In addition, the
- information was confirmed by two of my intelligence sources. I
- received some useful information from a Soviet scientific paper
- on these subjects, published in England under the title "Soviet
- Radio Electronics and Communications Systems." There was
- no doubt in my mind that General ul Haq had been murdered.
- The truck seen near the C-130 hanger undoubtedly carried a
- mobile E.L.F. device of the type the Soviet Armed Forces are
- known to possess.
- According to written testimony by Bhutto, smuggled out of
- the country while he was in prison, Kissinger severely threatened
-
- 10
-
- him: "I will make a horrible example if you continue with your
- nation-building policies." Bhutto had fallen afoul of Kissinger
- and the Club of Rome by calling for a nuclear energy program to
- bring Pakistan into a modern industrialized state which, in the
- eyes of the Committee of 300, was a direct contravention of its
- orders delivered by Kissinger to the Pakistani government. What
- Kissinger was doing when he threatened Bhutto was not official
- U.S. policy, but the policy of the modern-day Illuminati.
- One needs to have a clear understanding of just why it is that
- nuclear power is so hated all over the world, and why the fake
- "environmentalist" movement, established and financially sup-
- ported by the Club of Rome, was called upon to wage war on
- nuclear energy. With nuclear energy generating electricity in
- cheap and abundant supplies, Third World countries would
- gradually become independent of U.S. foreign aid and begin to
- assert their sovereignty. Nuclear generated electricity is THE
- key to bringing Third World countries out of their backward
- state, a state which the Committee of 300 has ordered to remain
- in position.
- Less foreign aid means less control of a country's natural
- resources by the I.M.F. It was this idea of developing nations
- taking charge of their destiny that was an anathema to the Club
- of Rome and its ruling Committee of 300. We have seen oppo-
- sition to nuclear power in the United States successfully used to
- block industrial development in conformity with the Club's
- "Post-Industrial Zero-Growth" plans.
- Dependence upon U.S. foreign aid actually keeps foreign
- countries in servitude to the Council on Foreign Relations. The
- people of the recipient countries receive very little of the money
- as it usually ends up in the pockets of government leaders who
- allow the natural raw material assets of the country to be savagely
- stripped by the I.M.F. Mugabe of Zimbabwe, formerly Rhodesia,
- is a good example of how raw material assets, in this case high
- grade chrome ore, is controlled through foreign aid. LONRHO,
- the giant conglomerate run by Angus Ogilvie, an important
-
- 11
-
- member of the Committee of 300, on behalf of his cousin,
- Queen Elizabeth II, now has total control of this valuable resource
- while the people of the country sink ever deeper into poverty
- and misery, notwithstanding a hand-out of in excess of $300
- million from the United States.
- LONRHO now has a monopoly of Rhodesian chrome and
- charges any price it likes, whereas, under the Smith government
- this was not allowed. A reasonable price level was maintained
- for twenty-five years prior to the Mugabe regime taking power.
- While there were problems during the 14-year rule of Ian Smith,
- since his departure unemployment has quadrupled and Zimbabwe
- is in a state of chaos and de facto bankruptcy. Mugabe received
- enough foreign aid from the U.S. (in the region of $300 million
- per annum) to enable him to build three hotels on the French
- Cote d'Azur, Cap Ferat and Monte Carlo, while his citizens
- grapple with disease, unemployment and malnutrition, not to
- mention an iron-fisted dictatorship that allows no complaints.
- Contrast this with the Smith government which never asked for
- nor received one red cent in aid from the United States. Thus it
- is clear that foreign aid is a powerful means of exercising
- control of countries such as Zimbabwe and indeed all African
- countries.
- It also keeps U.S. citizens in a state of involuntary servitude
- and therefore less able to mount meaningful opposition to gov-
- ernment. David Rockefeller knew what he was doing when his
- foreign aid bill became law in 1946. It has, since then, become
- one of the most hated laws on the statute books following public
- exposure of what it is a racket run by government and paid for
- by we, the people.
- How can the conspirators maintain their grip upon the world,
- and more especially, their chokehold over the U.S. and Britain?
- One of the most asked questions is, "How can any single entity
- know at all times what is going on and how is control exercised?"
- This book will attempt to answer these and other questions. The
- only way we can come to grips with the reality of the conspirator's
-
- 12
-
- success is by mentioning and discussing the secret societies,
- front organizations, government agencies, banks, insurance
- companies, international businesses, the petroleum industry and
- the hundreds of thousands of entities and foundations whose
- leading lights make up the membership of the Committee of
- 300--the ULTIMATE controlling body that runs the world and
- has done so for at least a hundred years.
- Since there already are scores of books on the Council on
- Foreign Relations (CFR) and the Trilaterals, we shall go directly
- to the Club of Rome and the German Marshall Fund. When I
- introduced these organizations to the United States, few, if any,
- had heard of them. My first work, "The Club of Rome," published
- in 1983 attracted almost no attention. Many uninitiated people
- thought the Club of Rome was something to do with the Catholic
- Church and that the German Marshall Fund referred to the
- Marshal Plan.
- This is precisely why the Committee chose these names, to
- confuse and to deflect attention away from what was happening.
- Not that the U.S. government didn't know, but as it was part of
- the conspiracy, it helped to keep the lid on information rather
- than let the truth be known. A few years after I published my
- work, a few writers saw in it a wealth of hitherto untapped
- information and began writing and talking about it as though
- they had always had full knowledge of it.
- It came as a revelation to them that the Club of Rome and its
- financiers under the title of the German Marshall Fund were two
- highly-organized conspiratorial bodies operating under cover of
- the North Atlantic Treaty Organization (NATO) and that the
- majority of Club of Rome executives were drawn from NATO.
- The Club of Rome formulated all of what NATO claimed as its
- policies and, through the activities of Committee of 300 member
- Lord Carrington, was able to split NATO into two factions, a
- political (left wing) power group and its former military alliance.
- The Club of Rome is still one of the most important foreign
- policy arms of the Committee of 300--the other being the
-
- 13
-
- Bilderbergers. It was put together in 1968 from hard-core mem-
- bers of the original Morgenthau group on the basis of a telephone
- call made by the late Aurellio Peccei for a new and urgent drive
- to speed up the plans of the One World Government--now
- called the New World Order, although I prefer the former name.
- It is certainly a better job-description than the New World
- Order, which is somewhat confusing as there have been several
- "New World Orders" before, but no One World Government.
- Peccei's call was answered by the most subversive "future
- planners" drawn from the United States, France, Sweden, Brit-
- ain, Switzerland and Japan that could be mustered. During the
- period 1968-1972, The Club of Rome became a cohesive entity
- of new-science scientists, globalists, future planners and inter-
- nationalists of every stripe. As one delegate put it, "We became
- Joseph's Coat of Many Colors." Peccei's book "Human Qual-
- ity" formed the basis of the doctrine adopted by NATO's political
- wing.
- The following is extracted from Dr. Peccei's book, "Human
- Quality":
-
- "For the first time since the first millennium was ap-
- proached in Christendom, large masses of people are
- really in suspense about the impending advent of some-
- thing unknown which could change their collective fate
- entirely.... Man does not know how to be a truly modern
- man.... Man invented the story of the Bad Dragon, but if
- ever there was a bad dragon, IT IS MAN HIMSELF....
- Here we have the human paradox: man trapped by his
- extraordinary capacity and achievements, as in a quick-
- sand--the more he uses his power the more he needs it.
-
- "We must never tire of repeating how foolish it is to
- equate the present profound pathological state and mal-
- adjustment of the entire human system to any cyclic
- crisis or passing circumstances. Since man has opened
-
- 14
-
- Pandora's Box of new technologies, he has suffered
- uncontrolled human proliferation, the mania for growth,
- energy crises, actual or potential resource scarcities,
- degradation of environment, nuclear folly and a host of
- related afflictions."
-
- This is identical to the program adopted by the much later
- fake "environmentalist" movement spawned by the same Club
- of Rome to blunt and turn back industrial development.
- Broadly, the anticipated counter-program of the Club of
- Rome would cover inventing and disseminating "post industri-
- alization" ideas in the United States, coupled with the spread of
- counterculture movements such as drugs, rock, sex, hedonism,
- Satanism, witchcraft and "environmentalism." Tavistock Institute,
- Stanford Research Institute and the Institute for Social Relations,
- in fact the entire wide spectrum of research organizations in
- applied social psychiatry either had delegates on the board of
- the Club of Rome, or acted as advisors and played a guiding role
- in NATO's attempt to adopt the "Aquarian Conspiracy."
- The name, New World Order, is seen as something devel-
- oped as a consequence of the Gulf War in 1991, whereas the
- One World Government is recognized as being centuries old.
- The New World Order is not new, it has been around and
- developing under one or another guise for a very long time but it
- is perceived as a DEVELOPMENT OF THE FUTURE, which
- is not the case; the New World Order is PAST AND PRESENT.
- That is why I said earlier that the term One World Government
- is, or ought to be, preferred. Aurellio Peccei once confided in his
- close friend Alexander Haig that he felt like "Adam Weishaupt
- reincarnated." Peccei had much of Weishaupt's brilliant ability
- to organize and control the Illuminati of today, and it showed
- through in Peccei's control of NATO and formulating its policies
- on a global scale.
- Peccei headed the Atlantic Institute's Economic Council for
- three decades while he was the Chief Executive Officer for
-
- 15
-
-
- Giovanni Agnellis' Fiat Motor Company. Agnelli, a member of
- an ancient Italian Black Nobility family of the same name, is
- one of the most important members of the Committee of 300.
- He played a leading role in development projects in the Soviet
- Union.
- The Club of Rome is a conspiratorial umbrella organization,
- a marriage between Anglo-American financiers and the old
- Black Nobility families of Europe, particularly the so-called
- "nobility" of London, Venice and Genoa. The key to the suc-
- cessful control of the world is their ability to create and manage
- savage economic recessions and eventual depressions. The
- Committee of 300 looks to social convulsions on a global scale,
- followed by depressions, as a softening-up technique for bigger
- things to come, as its principal method of creating masses of
- people all over the world who will become its "welfare" recipients
- of the future.
- The committee appears to base much of its important deci-
- sions affecting mankind on the philosophy of Polish aristocrat,
- Felix Dzerzinski, who regarded mankind as being slightly above
- the level of cattle. As a close friend of British intelligence agent
- Sydney Reilly (Reilly was actually Dzerzinski's controller dur-
- ing the Bolshevik Revolution's formative years), he often con-
- fided in Reilly during his drinking bouts. Dzerzinski was, of
- course, the beast who ran the Red Terror apparatus. He once told
- Reilly, while the two were on a drinking binge, that "Man is of
- no importance. Look at what happens when you starve him. He
- begins to eat his dead companions to stay alive. Man is only
- interested in his own survival. That is all that counts. All the
- Spinoza stuff is a lot of rubbish."
- The Club of Rome has its own private intelligence agency
- and also "borrows" from David Rockefeller's INTERPOL. Ev-
- ery U.S. intelligence agency cooperates very closely with it, as
- does the KGB and the Mossad. The only agency that remained
- beyond its reach was the East-German intelligence service. the
- STASSY. The Club of Rome also has its own highly organized
-
- 16
-
- political and economic agencies. It was they who told President
- Reagan to retain the services of Paul Volcker, yet another im-
- portant Committee of 300 member. Volcker stayed on as Federal
- Reserve Board chairman, notwithstanding the faithful promise
- of candidate Reagan that he would dismiss him as soon as he,
- Reagan, was elected.
- The Club of Rome, after playing a key role in the Cuban
- Missile Crisis, attempted to sell its "crisis management" (the
- forerunner of FEMA) program to President Kennedy. Several
- Tavistock scientists went to see the President to explain what it
- meant, but the President rejected the advice they gave. The same
- year that Kennedy was murdered, Tavistock was back in Wash-
- ington to talk with NASA. This time the talks were successful.
- Tavistock was given a contract by NASA to evaluate the effect
- of its coming space program on American public opinion.
- The contract was farmed to the Stanford Research Institute
- and the Rand Corporation. Much of the material produced by
- Tavistock, Stanford and Rand never saw the light of day and
- remains sealed until now. Several Senate oversight committees
- and sub-committees I approached to obtain information told me
- they had "never heard of it," nor did they have the slightest idea
- where I might find what I was seeking. Such is the power and
- prestige of the Committee of 300.
- In 1966 I was advised by my intelligence colleagues to
- approach Dr. Anatol Rappaport who had written a treatise in
- which the administration was said to be interested. It was a
- paper intended to bring an end to NASA's space program, which
- Rapport said had outlived its usefulness. Rappaport was quite
- happy to give me a copy of his paper which, without going into
- fine detail, basically claimed that NASA's space program should
- be scrapped. NASA has too many scientists who were exerting a
- bad influence on America because they were always eager to
- lecture schools and university audiences on how rocketry worked,
- from construction to propulsion. Rappaport claimed that this
- would produce a generation of adults who would decide to
-
- 17
-
- become space scientists, only to find themselves "redundant" as
- no one would need their services by the year 2000.
- No sooner had Rappaport's profiling report on NASA been
- presented to NATO by the Club of Rome, than the Committee of
- 300 demanded action. NATO-Club of Rome officials charged
- with urgent anti-NASA action were Harland Cleveland, Joseph
- Slater, Claiborne K. Pell, Walter J. Levy, George McGhee,
- William Watts, Robert Strausz-Hupe (U.S. ambassador to NATO)
- and Donald Lesh. In May 1967 a meeting was organized by the
- Scientific and Technological Committee of the North Atlantic
- Assembly and the Foreign Policy Research Institute. It was
- called "Conference on Transatlantic Imbalance and Collabora-
- tion" and it was held at Queen Elizabeth's palatial property in
- Deauville, France.
- The basic purpose and intent of the conference at Deauville
- was to end U.S. technological and industrial progress. Out of the
- conference came two books, one of which is mentioned herein,
- Brzezinski's "Technotronic Era." The other was written by
- conference chairman, Aurellio Peccei, entitled "The Chasm
- Ahead." Peccei largely agreed with Brzezinski, but added that
- there world be chaos in a future world NOT RULED BY A
- ONE WORLD GOVERNMENT. In this regard, Peccei insisted
- that the Soviet Union must be offered "a convergence with
- NATO," such a convergence ending in an equal partnership in a
- New World Order with the United States. Both nations would be
- responsible for future "crisis management and global planning."
- The first Club of Rome's "global planning contract" went to the
- Massachusetts Institute of Technology (MIT), one of the premier
- Committee of 300's research institutes. Jay Forrestor and Den-
- nis Meadows were placed in charge of the project.
- What was their report all about? It did not differ fundamen-
- tally from what Malthus and Von Hayek preached, namely the
- old question of not enough natural resources to go around. The
- Forrestor-Meadows Report was a complete fraud. What it did
- not say was that man's proven inventive genius would in all
-
- 18
-
- likelihood work its way around "shortages." Fusion energy, the
- DEADLY enemy of the Committee of 300, could be applied to
- CREATING natural resources. A fusion torch could produce
- from one square mile of ordinary rock enough aluminum, for
- example, to fill our needs for 4 years.
- Peccei never tired of preaching against the nation-state an
- how destructive they are for the progress of mankind. He called
- for "collective responsibility." Nationalism was a cancer on
- man was the theme of several important speeches delivered by
- Peccei. His close friend Ervin Lazlo produced a work in 1977 in
- a similar vein which was called "Goals of Mankind," a landmark
- study for the Club of Rome. The entire position paper was a
- vitriolic attack on industrial expansion and urban growth.
- Throughout these years, Kissinger, as the designated contact
- man, kept in close touch with Moscow on behalf of the RIIA.
- "Global modeling" papers were regularly shared with Kissinger's
- friends in the Kremlin.
- With regard to the Third World, the Club of Rome's Harland
- Cleveland prepared a report which was the height of cynicism.
- At the time, Cleveland was United States Ambassador to NATO.
- Essentially, the paper said it would be up to Third World nations
- to decide among themselves which populations should be
- eliminated. As Peccei later wrote (based on the Cleveland Re-
- port): "Damaged by conflicting policies of three major countries
- and blocs, roughly patched up here and there, the existing
- international economic order is visibly coming apart at the
- seams....The prospect of the necessity of the recourse to triage--
- deciding who must be saved--is a very grim one indeed. But, if
- lamentably, events should come to such a pass, the right to make
- such decisions cannot be left to just a few nations because it
- would lend themselves to ominous power over life of the world's
- hungry."
- In this is found the committee policy of deliberately starving
- African nations to death, as evidenced in the sub-Sahara na-
- tions. This was cynicism at its worst, because the Committee of
-
- 19
-
- 300 had already abrogated the decisions of life and death unto
- itself, and Peccei knew it. He had previously so indicated in his
- book "Limits of Growth." Peccei completely dismissed industrial
- and agricultural progress and in its place demanded that the
- world come under one coordinating council, to whit, the Club of
- Rome and its NATO institutions, in a One World Government.
- Natural resources would have to be allocated under the
- auspices of global planning. Nation states could either accept
- Club of Rome domination or else survive by the law of the
- jungle and fight to survive. In its first "test case," Meadows and
- Forrestor planned the 1973 Arab-Israeli War on behalf of the
- RIIA to sharply bring home to the world that natural resources
- like petroleum would in the future come under global planners
- control, meaning of course, under the control of the Committee
- of 300.
- Tavistock Institute called for a consultation with Peccei to
- which McGeorge Bundy, Homer Perlmutter and Dr. Alexander
- King were invited. From London Peccei traveled to the White
- House where he met with the President and his cabinet, Followed
- by a visit to the State Department where he conferred with the
- Secretary of State, the State Department's intelligence service
- and State's Policy Planning Council. Thus, from the very be-
- ginning, the United States government was fully aware of the
- Committee of 300's plans for this country. That should answer
- the often asked question, "Why would our government allow
- the Club of Rome to operate in a subversive manner in the
- United States?"
- Volcker's economic and monetary policies were a reflection
- of those of Sir Geoffrey Howe, Chancellor of the exchequer and
- member of the Committee of 300. This serves to illustrate how
- Britain has controlled the United States, beginning from soon
- after the War of 1812, and continues to exercise control over this
- country through the policies of the Committee of 300.
-
-
- <<<<< cont in Committee of 300 - part 2 >>>>>
-
-
- --
- <*> Don Allen <*> 1:363/81.1 - Fidonet #1 - Homebody BBS
- dona@bilver.uucp - Internet 1:363/29.8 - Fidonet #2 - Gourmet Delight
- 88:4205/1.1 - MUFON Network 1:3607/20.2 -- Odyssey - Alabama UFO Net
- NSA grep food: Aviary, Ed Dames, Los Alamos - Majestic - Jason - RIIA - UN
-
- Path: igor.rutgers.edu!rutgers!jvnc.net!yale.edu!yale!gumby!destroyer!uunet!peora!tarpit!tous!bilver!dona
- From: dona@bilver.uucp (Don Allen)
- Newsgroups: alt.conspiracy
- Subject: FILE: Committee of 300 - Part 2
- Message-ID: <1992Nov15.194248.26541@bilver.uucp>
- Date: 15 Nov 92 19:42:48 GMT
- Organization: W. J. Vermillion - Winter Park, FL
- Lines: 1059
-
- ----Committee of 300 - Part 2 ----------------------------------------
-
-
- What are the goals of the secret elite group, the inheritors of
- Illuminism (Moriah Conquering Wind), the Cult of Dionysius,
-
- 20
-
- the Cult of Isis, Catharism, Bogomilism? This elite group that
- also calls itself the OLYMPIANS (they truly believe they are
- equal in power and stature to the legendary gods of Olympus,
- who have, like Lucifer their god, set themselves above our true
- God) absolutely believe they have been charged with imple-
- menting the following by divine right:
- (1) A One World Government-New World Order with a
- unified church and monetary system under their direc-
- tion. Not many people are aware that the One World
- Government began setting up its "church" in the 1920's/
- 1930's, for they realized the need for a religious belief
- inherent in mankind to have an outlet and, therefore,
- set up a "church" body to channel that belief in the
- direction they desired.
- (2) The utter destruction of all national identity and national
- pride.
- (3) The destruction of religion and more especially the
- Christian religion, with the one exception, their own
- creation mentioned above.
- (4) Control of each and every person through means of
- mind control and what Brzezinski call "technotronics"
- which would create human-like robots and a system of
- terror beside which Felix Dzerzinski's Red Terror will
- look like children at play.
- (5) An end to all industrialization and the production of
- nuclear generated electric power in what they call "the
- post-industrial zero-growth society." Exempted are the
- computer and service industries. United States indus-
- tries that remain will be exported to countries such as
- Mexico where abundant slave labor is available.
- Unemployables in the wake of industrial destruction
- will either become opium-heroin and or cocaine addicts,
- or become statistics in the elimination process we know
- today as Global 2000.
- (6) Legalization of drugs and pornography.
-
- 21
-
-
- (7) Depopulation of large cities according to the trial run
- carried out by the Pol Pot regime in Cambodia. It is
- interesting to note that Pol Pot's genocidal plans were
- drawn up here in the United States by one of the Club
- of Rome's research foundations. It is also interesting
- that the Committee is presently seeking to reinstate the
- Pol Pot butchers in Cambodia.
- (8) Suppression of all scientific development except for
- those deemed beneficial by the Committee. Especially
- targeted is nuclear energy for peaceful purposes. Par-
- ticularly hated are the fusion experiments presently
- being scorned and ridiculed by the Committee and its
- jackals of the press. Development of the fusion torch
- would blow the Committee's conception of "limited
- natural resources" right out of the window. A fusion
- torch properly used could create unlimited untappeed
- natural resources from the most ordinary substances.
- Fusion torch uses are legion and would benefit mankind
- in a manner which is as yet not even remotely com-
- prehended by the public.
- (9) Cause by means of limited wars in the advanced coun-
- tries, and by means of starvation and diseases in Third
- World countries, the death of 3 billion people by the
- year 2000, people they call "useless eaters." The
- Committee of 300 commissioned Cyrus Vance to write
- a paper on this subject of how best to bring about such
- genocide. The paper was produced under the title the
- "Global 2000 Report" and was accepted and approved
- for action by President Carter, for and on behalf of the
- U.S. Government, and accepted by Edwin Muskie,
- then Secretary of State. Under the terms of the Global
- 2000 Report, the population of the United States is to
- be reduced by 100 million by the year 2050.
- (10)To weaken the moral fiber of the nation and to demor-
- alize workers in the labor class by creating mass unem-
-
- 22
-
- ployment. As jobs dwindle due to the post industrial
- zero growth policies introduced by the Club of Rome,
- demoralized and discouraged workers will resort to
- alcohol and drugs. The youth of the land will be en-
- couraged by means of rock music and drugs to rebel
- against the status quo, thus undermining and eventually
- destroying the family unit. In this regard The Commit-
- tee of 300 commissioned Tavistock Institute to prepare
- a blueprint as to how this could be achieved. Tavistock
- directed Stanford Research to undertake the work under
- the direction of Professor Willis Harmon. This work
- later became known as "The Aquarian Conspiracy."
- (11) To keep people everywhere from deciding their own
- destinies by means of one created crisis after another
- and then "managing" such crises. This will confuse and
- demoralize the population to the extent where faced
- with too many choices, apathy on a massive scale will
- result. In the case of the United States, an agency for
- crisis management is already in place. It is called the
- Federal Emergency Management Agency (FEMA),
- whose existence I first disclosed in 1980. There will be
- more on FEMA as we proceed.
- (12) To introduce new cults and continue to boost those
- already functioning which includes rock "music"
- gangsters such as the filthy, degenerate Mick Jagger's
- "Rolling Stones" (a gangster group much favored by
- European Black Nobility) and all of the Tavistock-
- created "rock" groups which began with "The Beatles."
- To continue to build up the cult of Christian funda-
- mentalism begun by the British East India Company's
- servant, Darby, which will be misused to strengthen the
- Zionist state of Israel through identifying with the Jews
- through the myth of "God's Chosen People" and by
- donating very substantial amounts of money to what
- they mistakenly believe is a religious cause in the
-
- 23
-
- furtherance of Christianity.
- (14) To press for the spread of religious cults such as the
- Moslem Brotherhood, Moslem fundamentalism, the
- Sikhs, and to carry out experiments of the Jim Jones
- and "Son of Sam" type of murders. It is worth noting
- that the late Ayatollah Khomeini was a creation of
- British Intelligence Military Intelligence Division 6,
- commonly known as M16, as I reported in my 1985
- work, "What Really Happened In Iran."
- (15) To export "religious liberation" ideas around the world
- so as to undermine all existing religions but more
- especially the Christian religion. This began with "Je-
- suit Liberation Theology" which brought about the
- downfall of the Somoza family rule in Nicaragua and
- which is today destroying EI Salvador, now 25 years
- into a "civil war," Costa Rica and Honduras. One very
- active entity engaged in so-called liberation theology is
- the Communist oriented Mary Knoll Mission. This
- accounts for the extensive media attention to the mur-
- der of four of Mary Knoll's so-called nuns in EI Salva-
- dor a few years ago.
- The four nuns were Communist subversive agents
- and their activities were widely documented by the
- government of EI Salvador. The United States press
- and news media refused to give any space or coverage
- to the mass of documentation in possession of the
- Salvadorian government, documentation which proves
- what the Mary Knoll Mission nuns were doing in the
- country. Mary Knoll is in service in many countries,
- and played a leading role in bringing Communism to
- Rhodesia, Mozambique, Angola and South Africa.
- (16) To cause a total collapse of the world's economies and
- engender total political chaos.
- (17) To take control of all Foreign and domestic policies of
- the United States.
-
- 24
-
- (18) To give the fullest support to supranational institutions
- such as the United Nations (UN), the International
- Monetary Fund (IMF), the Bank of International
- Settlements (BIS), the World Court and, as far as pos-
- sible, make local institutions of lesser effect by gradu-
- ally phasing them out or bringing them under the mantle
- of the United Nations.
- (19) Penetrate and subvert all governments, and work from
- within them to destroy the sovereign integrity of nations
- represented by them.
- (20) Organize a world-wide terrorist apparatus and negoti-
- ate with terrorists whenever terrorist activities take
- place. It will be recalled that it was Bettino Craxi who
- persuaded the Italian and U.S. governments to negoti-
- ate with the Red Brigades kidnapers of Prime Minister
- Moro and General Dozier. As an aside, General Dozier
- is under orders not to talk about what happened to him.
- Should he break that silence, he will no doubt be made
- "a horrible example of" in the manner in which
- Kissinger dealt with Aldo Moro, Ali Bhutto and Gen-
- eral Zia ul Haq.
- (21) Take control of education in America with the intent
- and purpose of utterly and completely destroying it.
- Much of these goals, which I first enumerated in 1969, have
- since been achieved or are well on their way to being achieved.
- Of special interest in the Committee of 300 program is the core
- of their economic policy, which is largely based on the teach-
- ings of Malthus, the son of an English country parson who was
- pushed to prominence by the British East India Company upon
- which the Committee of 300 is modeled.
- Malthus maintained that man's progress is tied to the earth's
- natural ability to support a given number of people, beyond
- which point earth's limited resources would rapidly be depleted.
- Once these natural resources have been consumed, it will be
- impossible to replace them. Hence, Malthus observed, it is
-
- 25
-
- necessary to limit populations within the boundaries of decreas-
- ing natural resources. It goes without saying that the elite will
- not allow themselves to be threatened by a burgeoning popula-
- tion of "useless eaters," hence culling must be practiced. As I
- have previously stated, "culling" is going on today, using the
- methods mandated in the "Global 2000 Report."
- All economic plans of the Committee meet at the crossroads
- of Malthus and Frederick Von Hayek, another doom and gloom
- economist who is sponsored by the Club of Rome. The Austrian
- born Von Hayek has long been under the control of David
- Rockefeller, and Von Hayek theories are fairly widely accepted
- in the United States. According to Von Hayek, the United States
- economic platform must be based on (a) Urban Black Markets
- (b) Small Hong Kong-type industries utilizing sweat-shop labor
- (c) The Tourist Trade, (d) Free Enterprise Zones where specula-
- tors can operate unhindered and where the drug trade can flourish
- (e) End of all industrial activity and (f) Close down all nuclear
- energy plants.
- Von Hayek's ideas dove-tail perfectly with those of the Club
- of Rome, which is perhaps why he is so well promoted in
- rightwing circles in this country. The mantle of Von Hayek is
- being passed to a new, younger economist, Jeoffrey Sachs, who
- was sent to Poland to take up where Von Hayek left off. It will
- he recalled that the Club of Rome organized the Polish eco-
- nomic crisis which led to political destabilization of the country.
- The exact same economic planning, if one dare call it that, will
- be forced upon Russia, but if widespread opposition is encoun-
- tered, the old price-support system will quickly be restored.
- The Committee of 300 ordered the Club of Rome to use
- Polish nationalism as a tool to destroy the Catholic Church and
- pave the way for Russian troops to reoccupy the country. The
- "Solidarity" movement was a creation of the Committee of
- 300's Zbigniew Brzezinski, who chose the name for the "trade
- union" and selected its office holders and organizers. Solidarity
- is no "labor" movement, although Gdansk shipyard workers
-
- 26
-
- were used to launch it, but rather, it was a high-profile POLIT-
- CAL organization, created to bring forced changes in prepara-
- tion for the advent of the One World Government.
- Most of Solidarity's leaders were descendants of Bolshevik
- Jews from Odessa and were not noted for hating Communism.
- This helps to understand the saturation coverage provided by
- the American news media. Professor Sachs has taken the pro-
- cess a step further, ensuring economic slavery for a Poland
- recently freed from the domination of the USSR. Poland will
- now become the economic slave of the United States. All that
- has happened is that the master has changed.
- Brzezinski is the author of a book that should have been read
- by every American interested in the future of this country.
- Entitled "The Technotronic Era," it was commissioned by the
- Club of Rome. The book is an open announcement of the
- manner and methods to be used to control the United States in
- the future. It also gave notice of cloning and "robotoids," i.e.
- people who acted like people and who seemed to be people, but
- who were not. Brzezinski, speaking for the Committee of 300
- said the United States was moving "into an era unlike any of its
- predecessors; we were moving toward a technotronic era that
- could easily become a dictatorship." I reported fully on "the
- Technotronic Era" in 1981 and mentioned it in my newsletters a
- number of times.
- Brzezinski went on to say that our society "is now in an
- information revolution based on amusement focus, spectator
- spectacles (saturation coverage by television of sporting events)
- which provide an opiate for an increasingly purposeless mass."
- Was Brzezinski another seer and a prophet? Could he see into
- the future? The answer is NO; what he wrote in his book was
- simply copied from the Committee of 300's blueprint given to
- the Club of Rome for execution. Isn't it true that by 1991 we
- already have a purposeless mass of citizens? We could say that
- 30 million unemployed and 4 million homeless people are a
- "purposeless mass," or at least the nucleus of one.
-
- 27
-
- In addition to religion, "the opiate of the masses" which
- Lenin and Marx acknowledged was needed, we now have the
- opiates of mass spectator sport, unbridled sexual lusts, rock
- music and a whole new generation of drug addicts. Mindless sex
- and an epidemic of drug usage was created to distract people
- from what is happening all around them. In "The Technotronic
- Era" Brzezinski talks about "the masses" as if people are some
- inanimate object--which is possibly how we are viewed by the
- Committee of 300. He continually refers to the necessity of
- controlling us "masses."
- At one point, he lets the cat out of the bag:
- "At the same time the capacity to assert social and political
- control over the individual will vastly increase. It will soon be
- possible to assert almost continuous control over every citizen
- and to maintain up-to-date files, containing even the most per-
- sonal details about health and personal behavior of every citizen
- in addition to the more customary data.
- "These files will be subject to instantaneous retrieval by the
- authorities. Power will gravitate into the hands of those who
- control information. Our existing institutions will be supplanted
- by pre-crisis management institutions, the task of which will be
- to identify in advance likely social crises and to develop pro-
- grams to cope with them. (This describes the structure of FEMA
- which came much later. )
- "This will encourage tendencies through the next several
- decades toward a TECHNOTRONIC ERA, A DICTATORSHIP,
- leaving even less room for political procedures as we know
- them. Finally, looking ahead to the end of the century, the
- possibility of BIOCHEMICAL MIND CONTROL AND GE-
- NETIC TINKERING WITH MAN, INCLUDING BEINGS
- WHICH WILL FUNCTION LIKE MEN AND REASON LIKE
- THEM AS WELL, COULD GIVE RISE TO SOME DIFFICULT
- QUESTIONS."
- Brzezinski was not writing as a private citizen but as Carter's
- National Security Advisor and a leading member of the Club of
-
- 28
-
- Rome and a member of the Committee of 300, a member of the
- CFR and as a member of the old Polish Black Nobility. His book
- explains how America must leave its industrial base behind and
- enter into what he called "a distinct new historical era."
- "What makes America unique is its willingness to experience
- the future, be it pop-art or LSD. Today, America is the creative
- society, the others, consciously or unconsciously, are emulative.
- What he should have said was that America is the proving
- ground for Committee of 300 policies which lead directly to a
- dissolution of the old order and an entry into the One World
- Government-New World Order.
- One of the chapters in "The Technotronic Era" explains how
- new technology will bring in its wake intense confrontation that
- will strain social and international peace. Oddly enough we are
- already under intense strains through surveillance. Lourdes in
- Cuba is one place where this is happening. The other is NATO
- headquarters in Brussels, Belgium, where a giant computer
- designated "666" can store data of every type mentioned by
- Brzezinski, plus possessing an expanded capacity to take in data
- for several billions more people than presently exist, if it ever
- comes to that, but which, in the light of the Global 2000 geno-
- cidal report, will probably never need to be utilized.
- Retrieval of data will be simple in the United States where
- social security and or driver licence numbers could simply be
- added to 666 to provide the surveillance recording announced
- by Brzezinski and his Committee of 300 colleagues. The Com-
- mittee already in 1981 warned governments, including the
- government of the USSR, that there "will be chaos unless the
- Committee of 300 takes complete control of preparations for the
- New World Order. CONTROL WILL BE EXERCISED
- THROUGH OUR COMMITTEE AND THROUGH GLOBAL
- PLANNIG AND CRISIS MANAGEMENT." I reported this
- factual information a few months after I received it in 1981.
- Another item I reported back then was that RUSSIA HAD
- BEEN INVITED TO JOIN THE PREPARATIONS FOR THE
-
- 29
-
- COMlNG ONE WORLD GOVERNMENT.
- When I wrote these things in 1981, the conspirators' global
- plans were already in an advanced state of preparedness. Look-
- ing back over the past 10 years, it can be seen just how rapidly
- the Committee's plans have advanced. If the information provided
- in 1981 was alarming, then it should be even more alarming
- today as we near the final stages of the demise of the United
- States as we know it. With unlimited funding, with several
- hundred think tanks and 5000 social engineers, the media
- banking and control of most governments a reality, we can see
- that we are tracing a problem of immense proportions, one that
- cannot he opposed by any nation at this time.
- As I have so often stated, we have been misled into believ-
- ing that the problem I am talking about has its origin in Moscow
- We have been brainwashed into believing that Communism is
- the greatest danger we Americans are facing. This is simply not
- so. The greatest danger arises from the mass of traitors in our
- midst. Our Constitution warns us to be watchful of the enemy
- within our gates. These enemies are the servants of the Committee
- of 300 who occupy high positions within our governmental
- structure. The UNITED STATES is where we MUST begin our
- fight to turn back the tide threatening to engulf us, and where we
- must meet, and defeat these internal conspirators.
- The Club of Rome also had a direct hand in creating the 25-
- year old war in EI Salvador, as an integral part of the wider plan
- drawn up by Elliot Abrams of the U.S. State Department. It was
- Committee of 300 member Willy Brandt, leader of the Socialist
- International and a former chancellor of West Germany, who
- paid for the "final offensive" by the Salvadorian guerrillas
- which, fortunately, was not successful. EI Salvador was chosen
- by the committee to turn Central America into a zone for a new
- Thirty-Year War, which task was allocated to Kissinger to carry
- out under the innocuous title of "The Andes Plan."
- Just to demonstrate how the conspirators operate across all
- national boundaries, the "final offensive" action planned by
-
- 30
-
- Willy Brandt came about as a result of a visit to Felipe
- Gonzalez, who at the time was preparing himself for his Club of
- Rome-ordained role as Spain's future prime minister. Apart
- from myself and one or two of my intelligence colleagues and
- former colleagues, no one appeared to have heard of Gonzalez
- before he surfaced in Cuba. Gonzalez was the Club of Rome's
- case officer for EI Salvador, and the first Socialist to be elevated
- to political power in Spain since the death of General Franco.
- Gonzalez was on his way to Washington to attend the Club
- of Rome Socialist "get Reagan" meeting which took place in
- December 1980. Present at the Gonzalez-Castro meeting was
- the left-wing guerrilla, Guillermo Ungo, run by the Institute for
- Policy Studies (IPS), the Committee of 300's most notorious
- Washington-based leftwing think tank. Ungo was run by an IPS
- fellow who died in a mysterious plane crash while enroute from
- Washington to Havana to visit Castro.
- As most of us know, both the left and the right of the
- political spectrum is controlled by the same people, which will
- help to explain the fact that Ungo was a life-long friend of the
- late Napoleon Duarte, leader of the rightwing in EI Salvador. It
- was after the Cuban meeting that the "final offensive" by the
- Salvadorian guerrillas was carried out.
- The polarizing of South America and the U.S was a special
- assignment given to Kissinger by the Committee of 300. The
- Malvinas War (also known as the Falklands War) and the sub-
- sequent overthrow of the Argentine government, followed by
- economic chaos and political upheavals, were planned by
- Kissinger Associates acting in concert with Lord Carrington, a
- top-ranking member of the Committee of 300.
- One of the principal Committee of 300 assets in the U.S., the
- Aspen Institute of Colorado, also helped plan events in Argentina
- even as it did in the case of the fall of the Shah of Iran. Latin
- America is important to the United States, not only because we
- have so many mutual defense treaties with countries there, but
- also because it has the potential of providing a huge market for
-
- 31
-
- American exports of technology, heavy industrial equipment
- which world have galvanized many of our faltering companies
- and provided thousands of new jobs. This was to be prevented
- all costs, even if it meant 30 years of war.
- Instead of seeing this huge potential in a positive light, the
- Committee of 300 saw it as a dangerous threat to its post-
- industrial zero-growth U.S. plans and immediately acted to
- make an example of Argentina as a warning to other Latin
- American nations to forget any ideas they may have had to
- promote nationalism, independence and sovereign integrity. This
- is the reason why so many Latin American countries turned to
- drugs as their sole means of support, which may very well have
- been the intention of the conspirators in the first place.
- Americans in general look down on Mexico, which is pre-
- cisely the attitude with which the Committee wants the people
- of the United States to regard Mexico. What we need to do is
- change our thinking about Mexico and South America in general.
- Mexico represents a potentially huge market for all types of
- U.S. goods which could mean thousands of jobs for Americans
- and Mexicans alike. Transferring our industries "south of the
- border" and paying the maquiladores slave wages is not in the
- interests of either country. It benefits nobody but the
- "Olympians."
- Mexico received most of its nuclear power technology from
- Argentina, but the Malvinas War put an end to that. The Club of
- Rome decreed back in 1986 that it would stop exports of nuclear
- technology to developing countries. With nuclear power stations
- generating abundant cheap electricity, Mexico would have be-
- come the "Germany of Latin America." Such a state of affairs
- would have been a disaster for the conspirators who have, by
- 1991, stopped all exports of nuclear technology except that
- destined for Israel.
- What the Committee of 300 has in mind for Mexico is a
- feudal peasantry, a condition that allows for easy management
- and looting of Mexican oil. A stable and prosperous Mexico can
-
- 32
-
- only be a plus for the United States. This is what the conspira-
- tors wish to prevent, so they have engaged in decades of innuendo,
- slander and direct economic war on Mexico. Before former
- President Lopes Portillo took office and nationalized the banks
- Mexico was losing $200 million a day to capital flight, organized
- and orchestrated by the Committee of 300's representatives in
- banks and brokerage houses on Wall Street.
- If only we in the United States had statesmen and not
- politicians running the country, we could act together and set
- back the One World Government-New World Order plans to
- return Mexico to a state of helplessness. If we were able to
- defeat the Club of Rome's plans for Mexico, it would come as a
- shock to the Committee of 300, a shock from which they would
- take a long time to recover. The inheritors of the Illuminati pose
- as great a threat to the United States as they do to Mexico. By
- seeking common ground with Mexican patriotic movements
- we in the United States could forge a formidable force to be
- reckoned with. But such action requires leadership, and we are
- more lacking in leadership than in any other area of endeavor.
- The Committee of 300 through its many affiliated organi-
- zations was able to nullify the Reagan presidency. Here is what
- Stuart Butler of the Heritage Foundation had to say on the
- subject "The right thought it had won in 1980 but in fact it have
- lost." What Butler was referring to was the situation in which
- the Right found itself when it realized that every single position
- of importance in the Reagan administration was filled by
- Fabianist appointees recommended by the Heritage Foundation.
- Butler went on to say that Heritage would use rightwing ideas to
- impose leftwing radical principles upon the United States, the
- same radical ideas which Sir Peter Vickers Hall, top Fabianist in
- the U.S. and the number one man at Heritage, had been openly
- discussing during the election year.
- Sir Peter Vickers Hall remained an active Fabianist even
- though he was running a conservative "think tank." As a mem-
- ber of the British oligarchical Vickers armament manufacturing
-
- 33
-
- family, he had position and power. The Vickers family supplied
- both sides in the First World War and again during Hitler's rise
- to power. Vickers' official cover was the University of Califor-
- nia's Urban and Regional Development Institute. He was a
- longtime confidant of British Labour leader and Committee of
- 300 member Anthony Wedgewood Benn.
- Both Vickers and Benn are integrated with the Tavistock
- Institute for Human Relations, the premiere brainwashing
- institution in the world. Vickers uses his Tavistock training to
- very good effect when speech-making. Consider the following
- example:
- "There are two Americas. One is the nineteenth century
- heavy-industry based society. The other is the growing post
- industrial society, in some cases built on the shards of the old
- America. It is the crisis between these two worlds which will
- produce the economic and social catastrophe of the next decade.
- The two worlds are in fundamental opposition, they cannot co-
- exist. In the end the post industrial world must crush and oblit-
- erate the other one." Remember, this speech was made in 1981
- and we can see from the state of our economy and our industries
- just how accurate was Sir Peter's prediction. When concerned
- people ask me how long the 1991 recession will last, I refer
- them to Sir Peter's statements and add my own opinion that it
- will not end until 1995/1996, and even then what emerges will
- not be the America we knew in the 1960's and 1970's. That
- America has already been destroyed.
- I reported Sir Peter's speech in my newsletter soon after it
- was delivered. How prophetic it was, but then it was easy to
- predict a future already written for America by the Committee
- of 300 and its executive Club of Rome. What was Sir Peter
- saying in a euphemistic manner? Translated into ordinary
- everyday English, he was saying that the old American way of
- life, our true and trusted republican form of government based
- upon our Constitution, was going to be crushed by the New
- World Order. America as we knew it was going to have to go, or
-
- 34
-
- be crushed to pieces.
- As I said, Committee of 300 members often make them-
- selves highly visible. Sir Peter was no exception. To make it
- clearly understood where he was coming from, Sir Peter rounded
- off his speech by declaring:
- "I am perfectly happy working with the Heritage Foundation
- and groups like that. True Fabians look to the New Right to push
- through some of their more radical ideas. For more than a
- decade the British population has been subject to a constant
- propaganda barrage of how it was on the industrial skids. All of
- this is true, but the net effect of the propaganda was to demoralize
- the population. (Exactly as intended by the new-science scientist
- at Tavistock.)
- "This will happen in the United States as the economy
- worsens. This (demoralizing process) is necessary to make people
- accept difficult choices. If there is no planning for the future or
- if constituencies block progress there will be social chaos on a
- scale which is currently hard to imagine. The outlook for urban
- America is bleak. There is a possibility of doing something with
- the inner cities, but basically the cities will shrink and the
- manufacturing base will decline. This will produce social con-
- vulsions."
- Was Sir Peter a psychic, a magician of great report or merely
- a charlatan fortune teller with a great deal of luck? The answer is
- "none of these." All Sir Peter was doing was reading off the
- blueprint of the Committee of 300-Club of Rome for slow death
- of the United States as a former industrial giant. Looking back
- over the ten years of Sir Peter's predictions, can anybody doubt
- that the Committee of 300's plans for the demise of an industri-
- alized United States has become a fait accompli?
- Haven't Sir Peter's predictions proved to be remarkably
- accurate? Indeed they have, almost down to the last word. It is
- worth noting that Sir Peter Vickers (Sir Peter Vickers-Hall's
- father-in-law) worked on the Stanford Research paper, "Chang-
- ing Images of Man," from which much of the 3000 pages of
-
- 35
-
- material advice sent to the Reagan Administration was taken.
- Moreover, as a senior MJ6 British intelligence officer, Sir Peter
- Vickers was in a position to give Heritage a great deal of
- advance information.
- As a member of the Committee of 300 and NATO, Sir Peter
- Vickers was around when NATO directed the Club of Rome to
- develop a social program which would utterly change the di-
- rection in which America wanted to go. The Club of Rome,
- under Tavistock direction, ordered Stanford Research Institute
- (SRI) to develop such a program, not only for America, but for
- every nation in the Atlantic Alliance and the OECD nations.
- It was Sir Peter's protege, Stuart Butler, who gave President
- Reagan 3000 pages of "recommendations," which no doubt
- contained some opinions expressed by Anthony Wedgewood
- Benn, a member of parliament and a ranking member of the
- Committee of 300. Benn told members of the Socialist Interna-
- ional who met in Washington on December 8, 1980: "You can
- thrive under Volcker's credit collapse if you profile Reagan to
- intensify the credit collapse."
- That Butler's advice was taken and applied to the Reagan
- administration can be seen in the collapse of the Savings and
- loan and banking industries which accelerated under Reagan
- economic policies. While Benn called it "profiling," he really
- meant that Reagan should be brainwashed. It is worth noting
- that Von Hayek-who is a founder member of Heritage-used
- his student, Milton Friedman, to preside over the Club of Rome's
- plans to deindustrialise America using the Reagan presidency to
- accelerate the collapse of first the steel industry, and then the
- auto and housing industries, for example.
- In this regard a French Black Nobility member, Etienne
- D'Avignon, as a member of the Committee of 300, was assigned
- the task of collapsing the steel industry in this country. It is
- doubtful that any of the hundreds of thousands of steel workers
- and shipyard workers who have been without jobs for the past
- decade have ever heard of D'Avignon. I fully reported the
-
- 36
-
- D'Avignon Plan in April 1981 Economic Review. At-
- tending that fateful December lOth Club of Rome meeting in
- Washington D.C. was a mystery man from Iran who turned out
- to be Bani Sadr, the Ayatollah Khomeini's special envoy.
- One speech in particular at the December 1Oth, 1980 conclave
- caught my attention, mainly because it came from Francois
- Mitterand, a man the French establishment had discarded and
- thought to be washed up. But my intelligence source had previ-
- ously told me that Mitterand was in the process of being picked
- up, dusted off and returned to power, so what he said carried a
- good deal of weight for me:
- "Industrial capitalist development is the opposite of freedom
- We must put an end to it. The economic systems of the 20th and
- 21st century will use machines to crush man, first in the domain
- of nuclear energy which is already producing formidable results.
- Mitterand's return to the Elysee Palace was a great triumph for
- socialism. It proved that the Committee of 3OO was powerful
- enough to predict happenings and then make them happen, by
- force, or by whatever means it took to make its point that it
- could crush any and all opposition even if, as in the case of
- Mitterand, he had been totally rejected a few short days before
- by a discerning political power group in Paris.
- Another group representative at the December 1980 Wash-
- ington meetings with "observer status" was John Graham, also
- known as "Irwin Suall," head of the fact-finding committee of
- the Anti-Defamation League (ADL). The ADL is an outright
- British intelligence operation run by all three branches of Brit-
- ish intelligence, that is, M16 and the JIO. Suall's extensive bag
- of dirty tricks was garnered from the sewers of the East End of
- London. Suall is still a member of the super-secret SIS, an elite
- James Bond type of operation. Let nobody underestimate the
- power of the ADL, nor its long reach.
- Suall works closely with Hall and other Fabianists. He was
- singled out as useful to British intelligence while at Ruskir
- Labour College at Oxford University in England, the same
-
- 37
-
- communist education center that gave us Milner, Rhodes, Bur-
- gess, McLean and Kim Philby. Oxford and Cambridge Univer-
- sities have long been the province of the sons and daughters of
- the elite, those whose parents belong to the "upper crust" of
- British high society. While at Oxford, Suall joined the Young
- People's Socialist League, and was recruited by British intelli-
- gence shortly thereafter.
- Suall was posted to the United States where he came under
- the protection and sponsorship of one of the most insidious
- leftists in the country, Walter Lippmann. Lippmann founded and
- ran the League for Industrial Democracy, and Students for
- Democratic Society, both leftist spoiler operations to set indus-
- trial workers at variance with what it called "the Capitalist
- class" and management. Both of Lippmann's projects were an
- integral part of the Committee of 300 apparatus that stretched
- right across America, of which Lippmann was a most important
- member.
- Suall has strong connections with the Justice Department
- and can secure FBI profiles of any person he targets. The Justice
- Department has orders to give Suall everything he wants when
- he wants it. Most of Suall's activities center around "keeping an
- eye on rightwing groups and individuals." The ADL has an open
- door to the State Department and makes good use of State's
- impressive intelligence agency.
- The State Department has a layer of agents in the right wing,
- posing as "fearless anti-Semitic fighters." There are four leaders
- in this group of informers, three of whom are discreet Jewish
- homosexuals. This spy group has been in operation for the past
- two decades. They publish virulently anti-Jewish "newspapers"
- and sell a wide variety of anti-Semitic books. One of the principal
- operators works out of Louisiana. A member of this group is a
- writer who is dearly beloved in Christian rightwing circles. The
- group and the individuals who go to make it up are under the
- protection of the ADL. Suall was deeply involved in ABSCAM
- and is often called upon by law enforcement agencies to assist
-
- 38
-
- them in investigations and sting operations.
- Suall was assigned to "dog Reagan," in terms of the course
- laid out for the newly-elected President by the Heritage Foun-
- dation, and to figuratively fire a few warning shots if Reagan
- looked like deviating or taking off his blinders at any time. Suall
- helped to get rid of any troublesome rightwing advisor not
- beholden to Heritage for his or her job with the Reagan admin-
- istration. Such a person was Ray Donovan, Reagan's Secretary
- of Labor, who was eventually removed from his post thanks to
- the Dirty Tricks department of the ADL. James Baker III, one of
- those on the list of 3000 recommendations made by the Heritage
- Foundation, was the go-between who carried Suall's messages
- of hate about Donovan to the President.
- Another important conspirator was Philip Agee, the so-
- called CIA "defector." Although not a member of the Commit-
- tee, he was nevertheless its case officer for Mexico, and run by
- the Royal Institute for International Affairs (RIIA) and the
- Council on Foreign Relations. For the record, nothing that
- happens in the U.S. happens without the sanction of the RIIA. It
- is a continuing and ongoing agreement first OPENLY entered
- into (there were many such secret agreements before that) by
- Churchill and Roosevelt in 1938, under the terms of which U.S.
- intelligence services are obliged to share intelligence secrets
- with British intelligence.
- This is the basis of the so-called "special relationship" be-
- tween the two countries about which Churchill and Lord Halifax
- boasted and which "special relationship" was responsible for
- the U.S. fighting the Gulf War against Iraq for and on behalf of
- British interests, more especially British Petroleum, one of the
- most important companies in the Committee of 300 in which
- Queen Elizabeth's immediate family has a big stake.
- No intelligence activity has taken place since 1938 except
- through this special joint command structure. Philip Agee joined
- the CIA after graduating from Notre Dame where he was in-
- ducted into its Jesuit Freemason ring. Agee first came to my
-
- 39
-
- attention in 1968 as the intelligence officer behind the riots at
- the University of Mexico. One of the most important things
- about the Mexican student riots was that they occurred at the
- same time as student rioting in New York, Bonn, Prague and
- West Berlin.
- With the coordination expertise and its special intelligence
- network of which INTERPOL is an integral part, it is not as
- difficult as it might seem at first sight for the Committee to set in
- motion carefully timed global actions, whether they be student
- rioting or deposing leaders of supposedly sovereign nations. It
- is all in a day's work for the "Olympians." From Mexico, Agee
- moved on to align himself with Puerto Rican terrorist groups.
- During this time he became a trusted confidant of the Cuban
- dictator, Fidel Castro.
- It should not be imagined that while Agee was carrying out
- these operations, he was doing so as a "rogue" agent. On the
- contrary, he was working for the CIA all during these assign-
- ments. Trouble came when Castro's DGI (Cuban intelligence
- service) was able to "turn" him. Agee continued to work in his
- capacity as a member of the CIA until his double role was
- uncovered. This involved the biggest Soviet listening post in the
- West located at Lourdes, Cuba. Staffed by 3000 Soviet special-
- ists in signals monitoring and deciphering, Lourdes has the
- capability of monitoring thousands of electronic signals simul-
- taneously. Many a private phone conversation between a mem-
- ber of Congress and his mistress was picked up at Lourdes and
- used to telling effect.
- Although we are told today in 1991 that "Communism is
- dead," the United States has done nothing to close down the
- vast spy operation which sits on our doorstep. Incidentally
- Lourdes has the capability of picking up even the weakest
- "tempest" signal, which is the type given off by a fax machine or
- an electric typewriter which, when deciphered, will give the
- contents of whatever is being typed or faxed. Lourdes remains
- dagger in the heart of the United States. There is absolutely no
-
- 40
-
- reason for its continued existence. If the U.S. and USSR are
- truly at peace with each other, why the continued need for so
- massive a spy operation? The simple truth is that, rather than
- retrenching personnel as we are led to believe, the KGB has
- taken on additional recruits during 1990 and 1991.
- Bernard Levin is probably not a name that is well-known in
- the United States. Unlike decadent "pop stars" or Hollywood's
- latest miserable "discovery," academics seldom if ever come
- before the public eye. Of the hundreds of academics in the
- United States working under the Control of the Club of Rome,
- Levin is worthy of special mention, if for no reason other than
- his role in undermining Iran, the Philippines, South Africa,
- Nicaragua and South Korea. The demise of the Shah of Iran was
- run to a plan devised by Bernard Levin and Richard Falk, and
- supervised by Robert Anderson's Aspen Institute.
- Levin was the author of a work entitled "Time Perspective
- and Morale" which is a Club of Rome publication concerning
- how to break down the morale of nations and individual leaders.
- Here is an extract of the document:
- "One of the main techniques for breaking morale through a
- strategy of terror consists in exactly this tactic: keep the person
- hazy as to where he stands and just what he may expect. In
- addition, if frequent vacillations between severe disciplinary
- measures and promise of good treatment together with the
- spreading of contradictory news make the structure of the situ-
- ation unclear, then the individual may cease to know whether a
- particular plan would lead toward or away from his goal. Under
- these conditions, even those individuals who have definite goals
- and are ready to take risks are paralyzed by the severe inner
- conflict in regard to what to do."
- This Club of Rome blueprint applies to COUNTRIES as
- well as to individuals, particularly the government leaders of
- those countries. We in the U.S. need not think that "Oh well, this
- is America, and those kinds of things just do not happen here."
- Let me assure you that they ARE happening in the U.S., and
-
- 41
-
- perhaps more so than in any other country.
- The Levin-Club of Rome plan is designed to demoralize us
- all so that in the end we feel we should follow whatever it is that
- is planned for us. We WILL follow Club of Rome orders like
- sheep. Any seemingly strong leader who SUDDENLY APPEARS
- to "rescue" the nation must be regarded with the utmost suspicion.
- Remember that Khomeini was groomed for years by British
- intelligence, especially during his time in Paris, before he sud-
- denly appeared as the savior of Iran. Boris Yeltsin is from the
- same M16-SIS stable.
- The Club of Rome feels confident that it has carried out it
- Committee of 300 mandate to "soften up" the United States.
- After 45 years of waging war on the people of this nation, who
- will doubt that it has indeed accomplished its task? Look around
- and see how we have been demoralized. Drugs, pornography
- rock and roll "music," free sex, the family unit all but totally
- undermined, lesbianism, homosexuality and finally the ghastly
- murder of millions of innocent babies by their own mothers.
- Has there ever been a crime so vile as mass abortion?
- With the U.S. spiritually, morally bankrupted, with our in-
- dustrial base destroyed throwing 30 million people out of work
- with our big cities ghastly cesspools of every imaginable crime
- with a murder rate almost three times higher than any other
- country, with 4 million homeless, with corruption in government
- reaching endemic proportions, who will gainsay that the United
- States is ready to collapse from within, into the waiting arms of
- the New Dark Age One World Government?
- The Club of Rome has succeeded in splitting the Christian
- churches; it has succeeded in building up an army of charismatics
- fundamentalists and evangelicals who will fight for the Zionist
- State of Israel. During the Gulf War of genocide I received
- scores of letters asking me how I could oppose "a just Christian
- war against Iraq." How could I doubt that Christian fundamen-
- talist support for the (Committee of 300's) war against Iraq was
- not Biblical--after all didn't Billy Graham pray with President
-
- 42
-
- Bush just before the shooting started? Doesn't the Bible speak
- of "wars and rumors of wars" ?
- These letters give an insight into just how well the Tavistock
- Institute has done its work. The Christian fundamentalists will
- be a formidable force behind the state of Israel, exactly as
- planned. How sad that these fine people do not realize that they
- have been GROSSLY MISUSED by the Club of Rome and that
- their opinions and beliefs are NOT THEIR OWN, but those
- created for them by the hundreds of Committee of 300 "think
- tanks" that dot the American landscape. In other words, like any
- other segment of the United States population, the Christian
- fundamentalists and evangelicals have been thoroughly
- brainwashed.
- We as a nation are ready to accept the demise of the United
- States of America and the American way of life, once the envy
- of the entire world. Do not think this has happened on its own--
- the old "times are changing" syndrome. Time does not change
- anything, PEOPLE do. It is a mistake to think of the Committee
- of 300 and the Club of Rome as European institutions. The Club
- of Rome exercises great influence and power in the United
- States, and has its own chapter based in Washington D.C.
- Senator Claiborne Pell is its leader, and one of its members
- is Frank M. Potter, a one-time staff director of the House Sub-
- committee on Energy. It is not difficult to see how the Club of
- Rome has maintained its grip on U.S. energy policies and where
- "environmentalist" opposition to nuclear energy is coming from.
- Perhaps the Club's greatest success story is its hold over Con-
- gress in regard to nuclear energy which has had the effect of
- preventing the U.S. from entering the 21st century as a strong
- industrial nation. The effect of the anti-nuclear policy of the
- Club of Rome can be measured in terms of silent blast furnaces.
- derelict railroad yards, rusting steel mills, shipyards long since
- closed down and a valuable trained work force scattered across
- the United States, which may never again be assembled.
- Other Club of Rome members in the U.S. are Walter A.
-
- 43
-
- Hahn of the Congressional Research Service, Ann Cheatham
- and Douglas Ross, both senior economists. Ross's task, in his
- own words, was to "translate Club of Rome perspectives into
- legislation to help the country get away from the illusion of
- plenty. " Ann Cheatham was the director of an organization
- called "Congressional Clearing House For The Future."
- Her task was to profile members of Congress who would be
- susceptible to astrology and New Age mumbo-jumbo. At one
- stage she had in excess of 100 Congressmen in her classes.
- Daily sessions were held in which a variety of astrological
- "forecasts" were made based on her "occult perceptions." Besides
- Congressmen, other prominent people who attended her sessions
- were Michael Walsh, Thornton Bradshaw--A LEADING
- MEMBER OF THE COMMITTEE OF 300--and David
- Sternlight, a senior vice-president of Allstate Insurance Company.
- Some of the more important members of the Committee of
- 300 are also members of NATO, a fact which we ought to
- remember. These Committee of 300 members often hold several
- offices. Among the NATO-Club of Rome membership are found
- Harland Cleveland, a former U.S. ambassador to NATO, Joseph
- Slater, a director of the Aspen Institute, Donald Lesh, a former
- staffer in the U.S. National Security Agency, George McGhee
- and Claiborne Pell, to name a few examples.
- It is important that we remember these names, make a list of
- them if you wish, so as to recall who they are and what they stand
- for when their names come up in television programs and news
- services. Following intelligence modus vivendi, leaders of the
- Committee often appear on television, usually in the most innocent
- of guises. We ought to be aware that nothing they do is innocent.
- The Committee of 300 has planted its agents in the muscle
- and sinew of the United States, in its government, in Congress, in
- advisory posts around the President, as ambassadors and as
- Secretaries of State. From time to time the Club of Rome holds
- gatherings and conferences which, although they appear under
- innocuous titles, break up into action committees, each of which
-
- 44
-
- is assigned a specific task and a specific target date by which time
- their assignments must be completed. If it does nothing else, the
- Committee of 300 is working to a very specific time-table.
- The first Club of Rome conference in the United States was
- called by the Committee of 300 in 1969 under the title: "The
- Association of the Club of Rome." The next meeting was held in
- 1970 under the title "Riverdale Center of Religious Research"
- and was directed by Thomas Burney. Then followed the Wood-
- lands Conference held in Houston, Texas, starting in 1971
- Thereafter, regular conferences have been held at Woodlands
- every year.
- Also in 1971, at a later date, the Mitchell Energy and Devel-
- opment Corporation held its energy strategy meeting for the
- Club of Rome: The recurring theme: LIMIT THE GROWTH
- OF THE U.S.A. Then to crown it all, the First Global Conference
- on the Future was held in July of 1980, attended by 4000 social
- engineers and members of think tanks, all of whom were men-
- bers of or affiliated with various institutions operating under
- Club of Rome umbrella organizations.
- The First Global Conference on the Future had the blessing
- of the White House which held its own conference based on the
- transcripts of the First Global Conference forum. It was called
- the "White House Commission on the 1980's" and OFFICIALLY
- recommended the policies of the Club of Rome "as a guide to
- future U.S. policies" and even went so far as to say that the
- United States economy is moving out of the industrial phase
- This echoed the theme of Sir Peter Vickers Hall and Zbibniew
- Brzezinsky and provides further proof of the control exercised
- by the Committee of 300 over U.S. affairs, both domestic and
- foreign.
- As I said in 1981, we are set up, politically, socially and
- economically so that we remain locked into the Club of Rome's
- plans. Everything is RIGGED against us. If we are to survive
- then we must break the stranglehold the Committee of 300 has
- on our government. In every election since Calvin Coolidge ran
-
- 45
-
- for the White House, the Committee of 300 has been able to
- plant its agents in key positions in government so that it matters
- not who gets the White House post. For example, every one of
- the candidates who ran for the Presidency, from the time of
- Franklin D. Roosevelt, were selected, some like to call it "hand
- picked," by the Council on Foreign Relations acting on the
- instructions of the RIIA.
- Especially in the 1980 election, every candidate for the
- highest office in the United States was run by the CFR. Therefore
- it was of no consequence to the conspirators who won the
- presidential race. Through such Trojan Horses as the Heritage
- Foundation and the CFR, ALL key policy making positions in
- the new administrations were filled by the Council on Foreign
- Relations nominees, and before that, since the 1960's, by NATO-
- Club of Rome yes-men, thereby ensuring that key policy deci-
- sions bore the indelible stamp of the Club of Rome and the CFR,
- acting as the executive arms of the Committee of 300.
- Both the 1984 and 1988 elections followed this long-
- established pattern. Secretary of State George Schultz was the
- perfect choice of the Committee of 300 for the office of Secretary
- of State. Schultz was always a creature of Henry Kissinger, the
- ruling order-giver for the CFR. Moreover, his position with
- Bechtel, a key Committee of 300 company of global dimensions,
- gave him access to countries that might otherwise have been
- suspicious of his Kissinger connection. The Carter Administration
- accelerated the process of key pro-conspiracy personnel in key
- positions. Before Carter was elected, his key campaign strategist,
- Hamilton Jordan, said that if Cyrus Vance or Brzezinski received
- appointments in the Carter cabinet, he, Jordan, would resign.
- They did. Jordan did not resign.
- Carter's choice of Paul Volcker (in fact he was told to
- appoint Volcker by David Rockefeller) started the collapse of
- the U.S. economy according to the plan laid down by the Club
- of Rome. We are up against powerful forces who are dedicated
- to the goal of a One World Government. We have been engaged
-
- 46
-
- in a devastatingly crippling war for the past 45 years, only it is
- not perceived as such. We are brainwashed, methodically and
- systematically, without ever being aware of it. The Tavistock
- Institute provided the system for this to take place, and then set
- its operations in motion.
- The only way we can fight back is by exposing the conspira-
- tors and their multiplicity of front organizations. We need men
- with experience who can formulate strategy to defend our
- priceless heritage which, once lost, will never again reappear.
- We need to learn the methods the conspirators use; learn them
- and adopt counter-measures. Only a crash program will stop the
- rot which is consuming our nation.
- Some may have difficulty in accepting the idea of a global
- conspiracy because so many writers have made financial gain
- from it. Others doubt that activity on a global scale can be
- successfully advanced. They see the huge bureaucracy of our
- government and then say, "Well, how are we supposed to believe
- that private people can do more than the government does?
- This overlooks the fact that government is part of the conspiracy.
- Hard evidence is what they want and hard evidence is difficult
- to come by.
- Others say, "So what. What do I care about a conspiracy, I
- don't even bother to vote." That is exactly the way the general
- population of America was profiled to react. Our people have
- become discouraged and confused, the results of 45 years of
- warfare conducted against us. How this is done is explained in
- Bernard Lewin's book, but how many people would bother to
- read an academic's non-fiction book? We are reacting exactly as
- we were profiled to act. Demoralized and confused people will
- be far more ready to welcome the sudden appearance of a great
- man who promises to solve every problem and guarantee a well-
- ordered society in which people are fully employed and domes-
- tic strife is minimal. Their dictator, for that is who it will be, will
- be welcomed with open arms.
- Knowing WHO the enemy is a vital necessity. No one can
-
- 47
-
- fight and against an unidentified enemy. This book could be
- used as a military field manual. Study its content and memorize
- all names. I have mentioned profiling techniques quite frequently
- in this chapter. A full explanation of "profiling" is contained in
- the next chapter. One of the most profound pieces of information
- to come out of the science of profiling is the relative ease in
- which this can be accomplished in individuals, party groups,
- political entities and so on right on down the line. Once we wake
- up as to how easy this is to do, the conspiracy will no longer be
- more than we can comprehend. The assassination of President
- Kennedy and the attempt on the life of President Reagan become
- easy to understand.
-
- 48
-
-
- <<<<<< cont in Committee of 300 - part 3 >>>>>>
-
-
- --
- <*> Don Allen <*> 1:363/81.1 - Fidonet #1 - Homebody BBS
- dona@bilver.uucp - Internet 1:363/29.8 - Fidonet #2 - Gourmet Delight
- 88:4205/1.1 - MUFON Network 1:3607/20.2 -- Odyssey - Alabama UFO Net
- NSA grep food: Aviary, Ed Dames, Los Alamos - Majestic - Jason - RIIA - UN
-
- Path: igor.rutgers.edu!rutgers!cs.utexas.edu!uunet!peora!tarpit!tous!bilver!dona
- From: dona@bilver.uucp (Don Allen)
- Newsgroups: alt.conspiracy
- Subject: FILE: Committee of 300 - Part 3
- Message-ID: <1992Nov15.194515.26701@bilver.uucp>
- Date: 15 Nov 92 19:45:15 GMT
- Organization: W. J. Vermillion - Winter Park, FL
- Lines: 1037
-
-
- ----- Committee of 300 - Part 3 ----------------------------------------
-
-
- Copyright (C) 1992 by Dr. John Coleman
-
- "Conspirators' Hierarchy: The Story of the Committee of 300", by
- Dr. John Coleman, is reproduced here with the permission of the
- publisher: America West Publishers.
-
-
- INSTITUTlONS THROUGH WHICH
-
- CONTROL IS EXERCISED
-
- Profiling is a technique developed in 1922 on command of
- the Royal Institute for International Affairs (RIIA). Major John
- Rawlings Reese, a British Army technician, was instructed to
- set up the largest brainwashing facility in the world at the
- Tavistock Institute for Human Relations as a part of Sussex
- University. This became the core of Britain's Psychological
- Warfare Bureau. When I first introduced the names of Reese and
- Tavistock into the United States in 1970, very little interest was
- shown. But over the years, as I revealed more and more about
- Tavistock and its vital role in the conspiracy, it has become
- popular to imitate my earlier research.
- Britain's Psychological Warfare Bureau made extensive use
- of the work done by Reese on his 80,000 British Army guinea
- pigs, captive soldiers who underwent many forms of testing. It
- was Tavistock-designed methods that got the United States into
- the Second World War and which, under the guidance of Dr.
- Kurt Lewin, established the OSS, the forerunner of the CIA.
- Lewin became the director of the Strategic Bombing Survey,
-
- 48
-
- which was a plan for the Royal Air Force to concentrate on
- bombing German worker housing while leaving military tar-
- gets, such as munition plants, alone. The munition plants on
- both sides belonged to the international bankers who had no
- wish to see their assets destroyed.
- Later, after the war was over, NATO ordered Sussex Univer-
- sity to establish a very special brainwashing center which became
- part of Britain's Psychological Warfare Bureau, only now, its
- research was directed toward civilian rather than military ap-
- plications. We shall return to that super secret unit which was
- called Science Policy Research Institute (SPRI) under our
- chapters on drugs.
- The idea behind saturation bombing of civilian worker
- housing was to break the morale of the German worker. It was
- not designed to affect the war effort against the German military
- machine. Lewin and his team of actuaries reached a target
- figure, that if 65% of German worker housing was destroyed by
- nightly RAF bombing, the morale of the civilian population
- would collapse. The actual document was prepared by the Pru-
- dential Assurance Company.
- The RAF, under the command of "Bomber" Harris, carried
- out Lewin's plans, culminating in the terror firestorm bombing
- of Dresden, in which over 125,000, mainly old men, women and
- children, were killed. The truth of "Bomber" Harris's horror
- raids on German civilians was a well kept secret until long after
- the end of WW II.
- Tavistock provided most of the detailed programs that led to
- the establishing of the Office of Naval Intelligence, (ONI) the
- number one intelligence service in the United States, one which
- dwarfs the CIA in size and scope. Contracts worth billions of
- dollars were given to Tavistock by the United States Government
- and Tavistock's strategic planners provide most of what the
- Pentagon uses for our defense establishment, even today. Here
- again is illustrated the grip the Committee of 300 has on the
- United States, and the majority of our institutions. Tavistock
-
- 49
-
- runs over 30 research institutions in the United States, all of
- which we will name in our charts at the end of the book.
- These Tavistock-U.S. institutions have in many cases grown
- into gargantuan monsters, penetrating every aspect of our gov-
- ernment agencies and taking command of all policy making.
- One of Tavistock's chief wreckers of our way of life was Dr.
- Alexander King, a founder member of NATO and a favorite
- with the Committee of 300, as well as an outstanding member of
- the Club of Rome. Dr. King was assigned by the Club of Rome
- to destroy America's education by taking control of the National
- Teachers Association and working in close conjunction with
- certain law makers and judges. If it was not generally known
- how all-pervading is the influence of the Committee of 300, this
- book should dispel every vestige of that doubt.
- The trial run for the Federal Emergency Management Agency
- (FEMA) a Club of Rome creation came in a test run against
- the nuclear power station at Three Mile Island, Harrisburg,
- Pennsylvania. Termed "an accident" by the hysterical media,
- this was not an accident but a deliberately designed crisis test
- for FEMA. An additional benefit was the fear and hysteria
- created by the news media which had people fleeing the area
- when in fact they were never in any danger.
- It was considered a success by FEMA and it scored a lot of
- points for the anti-nuclear forces. TMI became the rallying
- point for the so-called "environmentalists," a highly financed and
- controlled group run out of Aspen Institute on behalf of the Club
- of Rome. Coverage was provided free of charge by William
- Paley of CBS television, a former British intelligence agent.
- FEMA is a natural successor to the Strategic Bombing Survey
- of WW II. Dr. Kurt Lewin, theoretician for what the Tavistock
- conspirators called crisis management, was deeply involved in
- the study. There is an unbroken chain between Lewin and
- Tavistock that stretches back for thirty-seven years. Lewin in-
- corporated the Strategic Bombing Survey into FEMA, with only
- a few small adjustments proving necessary, one of the changes
-
- 50
-
- being the target, WHICH WAS NO LONGER GERMANY BUT
- THE UNITED STATES OF AMERICA. Forty-five years after
- the end of WW II it is still Tavistock that has its hands on the
- trigger, and the weapon is pointed at the United States.
- The late Margaret Mead conducted an intensive study of the
- German and Japanese population, under the aegis of Tavistock,
- on how they reacted to stress caused by aerial bombardment.
- Irving Janus was an associate professor on the project which
- was supervised by Dr. John Rawlings Reese, promoted to
- Brigadier-General in the British Army. The test results were
- given to FEMA. The Irving Janus report was of great value in
- formulating FEMA policies. Janus used it in a book which he
- later wrote entitled AIR WAR AND STRESS. The ideas in his book
- were followed TO THE LETTER BY FEMA DURING THE
- THREE MILE ISLAND "CRISIS." Janus had a really simple
- idea: Simulate a succession of crises and manipulate the popu-
- lation following the Lewin terror tactics and they will do exactly
- as required.
- In carrying out this exercise, Lewin discovered something
- new, that social control on a wide scale can be achieved by using
- the news media to bring home the horrors of a nuclear war via
- the television media. It was discovered that women's magazines
- were very effective in dramatizing the terrors of a nuclear war. A
- trial run conducted by Janus had Betty Bumpers, wife of Sena-
- tor Dale Bumpers of Arkansas, "writing" for McCalls magazine
- on that subject.
- The article appeared in McCalls January 1983 issue. Actu-
- ally, Mrs. Bumpers did not write the article, it was created for
- her by a group of writers at Tavistock whose speciality such
- subject matters are. It was a collection of untruths, non-facts,
- innuendoes and conjectures based entirely upon false premises.
- The Bumpers article was typical of the kind of psychological
- manipulation at which Tavistock is so very good. Not one of the
- ladies who read McCalls could have failed to be impressed by
- the terror-horror story of what a nuclear war looks like.
-
- 51
-
- The Committee of 300 has a major bureaucracy at its dis-
- posal made up of hundreds of think tanks and front organizations
- that run the whole gamut of private business and government
- leaders. I will mention as many as I can fit in, starting with the
- German Marshall Fund. Its members, and remember they are
- also members of NATO and the Club of Rome, consist of David
- Rockefeller of Chase Manhattan Bank, Gabriel Hague of the
- prestigious Manufactures Hanover Trust and Finance Corpora-
- tion, Milton Katz of the Ford Foundation, Willy Brandt, leader
- of Socialist International, KGB agent and member of the Com-
- mittee of 300, Irving Bluestone, chairman of the United Auto
- Workers Executive Board, Russell Train, U.S. president of the
- Club of Rome and Prince Philip's World Wildlife Fund, Elizabeth
- Midgely, CBS programs producer, B. R. Gifford, director of the
- Russell Sage Foundation, Guido Goldman of the Aspen Institute
- the late Averill Harriman, Committee of 300 extraordinary
- member, Thomas L. Hughes of the Carnegie Endowment Fund,
- Dennis Meadows and Jay Forrestor of MIT "world dynamics."
- The Committee of 300, although in existence for over 150
- years, did not take on its present form until around 1897. It was
- always given to issuing orders through other fronts, such as the
- Royal Institute for International Affairs. When it was decided
- that a super-body would control European affairs, the RIIA
- founded the Tavistock Institute, which in turn created NATO.
- For Five years NATO was financed by the German Marshall
- Fund. Perhaps the most important member of the Bilderbergers,
- a foreign policy body of the Committee, was Joseph Rettinger,
- said to have been its founder and organizer, whose annual
- meetings have delighted conspiracy hunters for several decades.
- Rettinger was a well-trained Jesuit priest and a 33rd Degree
- Freemason. Mrs. Katherine Meyer Graham who is suspected of
- having murdered her husband in order to get control of the
- Washington Post, was another ranking member of the Club of
- Rome, as was Paul G. Hoffman of the New York Life Insurance
- Company, one of the largest insurance companies in the United
-
- 52
-
- States and a leading Rank company, with ties directly to Queen
- Elizabeth of England's immediate family. John J. McCloy, the
- man who attempted to wipe post-World War II Germany off the
- map and last but not least, James A. Perkins of the Carnegie
- Corporation, were also founding members of the Bilderbergers
- and the Club of Rome.
- What a star-studded cast! Yet strangely enough, few if any
- outside of genuine intelligence agencies had ever heard of this
- organization until recent times. The power exercised by these
- important personages and the corporations, television stations
- newspapers, insurance companies and banks they represent
- matches the power and prestige of at least two European coun-
- tries, and still this is only the tip of The Committee of 300's
- enormous cross-gridding and interfaced interests.
- Not mentioned in the foregoing line-up is Richard Gardner
- who, although an early member of the Committee of 300, was
- sent to Rome on a special assignment. Gardner married into one
- of the oldest Black Nobility families of Venice, thus providing
- the Venetian aristocracy a direct line to the White House. The
- late Averill Harriman was another of the committee's direct
- links with the Kremlin and the White House, a position which
- Kissinger inherited after the death of Harriman.
- The Club of Rome is indeed a formidable agency of the
- Committee of 300. Although ostensibly working on American
- affairs, the group overlaps other Committee of 300 agencies and
- its United States members are often found working with "prob-
- lems" in Japan and Germany. Some of the front organizations
- operated by the above committee include the following, although
- not limited to them:
-
- LEAGUE OF INDUSTRIAL DEMOCRACY
- Officials: Michael Novak, Jeane Kirkpatrick, Eugene
- Rostow, IRWIN SUALL, Lane Kirkland, Albert Schenker.
- Purpose: To disrupt and disturb normal labor relations be-
- tween workers and employees by brain washing labor unions to
-
- 53
-
- make impossible demands with special attention to steel, auto-
- mobile and housing industries.
-
- FREEDOM HOUSE
- Officials: Leo Churn and Carl Gershman.
- Purpose: To spread socialist disinformation among Ameri-
- can blue collar workers, spread dissension and dissatisfaction.
- Now that these objectives have been largely realized, Gershman
- has been drafted by Lawrence Eagleburger to CEDC, a newly
- created body to stop a united Germany from expanding its trade
- into the Danube Basin.
-
- COMMITTEE FOR A DEMOCRATIC MAJORITY
- Officials: Ben Wattenburg, Jean Kirkpatrick, Elmo Zumwa
- and Midge Dector.
- Purpose: To provide a connecting link between the edu-
- cated socialist class and minority groups with the intent of
- setting up a solid block of voters who can be counted on to vote
- for leftwing candidates at election time. It was really a Fabianist
- operation from start to finish.
-
- FOREIGN POLICY RESEARCH INSTITUTE
- Officials: Robert Strausz Hupe.
- Purpose: To undermine and eventually end NASA space
- program.
-
- SOCIAL DEMOCRATS U.S.A.
- Officials: Bayard Rustin, Lane Kirkland, Jay Lovestone,
- Carl Gershman, Howard Samuel, Sidney Hook.
- Purpose: To spread radical socialism, especially among
- minority groups, and forge links between similar organizations
- in socialist countries. Lovestone was for decades the leading
- advisor to U.S. presidents on Soviet affairs and a strong direct
- link with Moscow.
-
- 54
-
- INSTITUTE FOR SOCIAL RELATIONS
- Officials: Harland Cleveland, Willis Harmon.
- Purpose: Change the way America thinks.
-
- THE CITIZENS LEAGUE
- Officials: Barry Commoner.
- Purpose: To bring "common cause" legal suits against vari-
- ous government agencies, especially in the defense industries.
-
- WAR RESISTERS LEAGUE
- Officials: Noam Chomsky and David McReynolds.
- Purpose: To organize resistance to the Vietnam War among
- leftwing groups, students and the Hollywood "in crowd."
-
- THE DEMOCRATIC SOCIALIST ORGANIZING
- COMMITTEE OF THE INSTITUTE FOR
- DEMOCRATIC SOCIALISM
- Officials: Frank Zeider, Arthur Redier and David
- McReynolds.
- Purpose: A clearing house for leftwing socialist ideas and
- activities in the U.S and Europe.
-
- ANTI-DEFAMATION LEAGUE FACT FINDING
- DIVISION
- Officials: IRWIN SUALL, also known as John Graham.
- Purpose: A joint FBI-British intelligence operation designed
- to single out rightwing groups and their leaders and put them out
- of business before they grow too large and too influential.
-
- INTERNATIONAL ASSOCIATION OF MACHINISTS
- Purpose: A labor oriented front for the Socialist Interna-
- tional and a hot-bed of organized labor unrest polarizing work-
- ers and management.
-
- 55
-
- AMALGAMATED CLOTHING WORKERS
- Officials: Murray Findley, IRWIN SUALL and Jacob
- Scheinkman.
- Purpose: Much the same as the Machinists Union, to so-
- cialize and polarize workers in the garment trade.
-
- A. PHILIP RANDOLPH INSTITUTE
- Officials: Bayard Rustin.
- Purpose: To provide a means of coordinating organizations
- with a common purpose, an example of which would be the
- spread of socialist ideas among college students and workers.
-
- CAMBRIDGE POLICY STUDIES INSTITUTE
- Officials: Gar Apelrovitz.
- Purpose: To expand on the work being done at the Institute
- for Policy Studies. Founded in February 1969 by international
- socialist, Gar Apelrovitz, former assistant to Senator Gaylord
- Nelson. Apelrovitz wrote the controversial book ATOMIC DI-
- PLOMACY for the Club of Rome which work was financed by
- the German Marshall Fund. It concentrates on research and
- action projects, with a stated goal of fundamentally changing
- American society, i.e., to create a Fabianist United States in
- preparation of the coming One World Government.
-
- ECONOMIC COMMITTEE OF THE NORTH
- ATLANTIC INSTITUTE
- Officials: Dr. Aurellio Peccei.
- Purpose: NATO think-tank on global economic issues.
-
- CENTER FOR THE STUDY OF DEMOCRATIC
- INSTITUTIONS
- Officials: Founder Robert Hutchins of the Committee of
- 300, Harry Ashmore, Frank Kelly and a large group of "Fellows."
- Purpose: To spread ideas that will bring on social reforms
-
- 56
-
- of the liberal kind with democracy as an ideology. One of its
- activities is to draft a new constitution for the U.S. which will be
- strongly monarchical and socialistic as found in Denmark.
- The Center is an "Olympian" stronghold. Located in Santa
- Barbara, it is housed in what is affectionately called "the
- Parthenon." Former Representative John Rarick called it "an
- outfit loaded with Communists." By 1973 work on a new United
- States Constitution was in its thirty-fifth draft which proposes
- an amendment guaranteeing "environmental right," the thrust of
- which is to reduce the industrial base of the U.S. to a mere
- whisper of what it was in 1969. In other words, this institution is
- carrying out Club of Rome zero-growth post-industrial policies
- laid down by the Committee of 300.
- Some of its other aims are control of economic cycles,
- welfare, regulation of business and national public works, con-
- trol of pollution. Speaking on behalf of the Committee of 300,
- Ashmore says the function of the CSDI is to find ways and
- means of making our political system work more effectively.
- "We must change education and we must consider a new U.S
- Constitution and a Constitution for the world," Ashmore says.
- Further goals enunciated by Ashmore are as follows:
- (1) Membership of the U.N. must be made universal.
- (2) The U.N. must be strengthened.
- (3) South East Asia must be neutralized. (For neutralized,
- read "Communized.")
- (4) Cold War must be ended.
- (5) Racial discrimination must be abolished.
- (6) Developing nations must be assisted. (Meaning assisted
- to destruct.)
- (7) No military solutions to problems. (Pity they didn't tell
- George Bush that before the Gulf War.)
- (8) National solutions are not adequate.
- (9) Coexistence is necessary.
-
- 57
-
- HARVARD PSYCHOLOGICAL CLINIC
- Officials: Dr. Kurt Lewin and staff of 15 new-science
- scientists.
- Purpose: To create a climate where the Committee of 300
- can take unlimited power over the U.S.
-
- INSTITUTE FOR SOCIAL RESEARCH
- Officials: Dr. Kurt Lewin and staff of 20 new-science
- scientists.
- Purpose: To devise a whole new set of social programs to
- steer America away from industry.
-
- SCIENCE POLICY RESEARCH UNIT
- Officials: Leland Bradford, Kenneth Dam, Ronald Lippert.
- Purpose: A "Future Shocks" research institution at Sussex
- University in England and part of the Tavistock network.
-
- SYSTEMS DEVELOPMENT CORPORATION
- Officials: Sheldon Arenberg and a staff of hundreds, too
- numerous to mention here.
- Purpose: To coordinate all elements of the intelligence
- communities of the U.S.A. and Britain. It analyzes what "play-
- ers" have to be assigned the role of a national entity; for example,
- Spain would come under a supine watered-down Catholic
- Church, the U.N. under the Secretary General and so forth. It
- developed the system of "X RAY 2" where think tank personnel,
- military installations and law enforcement centers are all linked
- to the Pentagon through a nation-wide network of Teletypes and
- computers: To apply surveillance techniques on a nation-wide
- scale. Arenberg says his ideas are non-military, but his techniques
- are mainly those he learned from the military. He was responsible
- for the New York State Identification and Intelligence System, a
- typical George Orwell "1984" project, which is completely
- illegal under our Constitution. The NYSIIS system is in the
- process of being adopted nationwide. It is what Brzezinsk
-
- 58
-
- referred to as the ability to almost instantaneously retrieve data
- about any person.
- NYSIIS shares data with all law enforcement and govern-
- ment agencies in the state. It provides storage and rapid retrieval
- of individual records, criminal and social. It is a TYPICAL
- Committee of 300 project. There is a crying need for a full
- investigation to be conducted into just what it is that Systems
- Development Corporation is doing, but that is beyond the scope
- of this book. One thing is sure, SDC is not there to preserve
- freedom and liberty guaranteed by the U.S. Constitution. How
- convenient that it should be located in Santa Barbara in easy
- reach of Robert Hutchins "Parthenon." Some publications put
- out by these Club of Rome institutions are as follows:
- "Center Magazine"
- "Counterspy"
- "Coventry"
- "Covert Action Information Bulletin"
- "Dissent"
- "Human Relations"
- "Industrial Research"
- "Inquiry"
- "Mother Jones"
- "One"
- "Progressive"
- "Raconteur"
- "The New Republic"
- "Working Papers for a New Society"
- These are by no means all of the publications issued under
- the auspices of the Club of Rome. There are many hundreds
- more, in fact each of the foundations puts out its own publication.
- Given the number of foundations run by the Tavistock Institute
- and the Club of Rome, a partial listing is all we can include here.
- Some of the more important foundations and think tanks are in
- the following list, which includes Army think tanks.
- The American public would be astounded if it only knew
-
- 59
-
- how deeply the Army is involved in "new war tactics" research
- with Committee of 300 "think tanks." Americans are not aware
- that in 1946 the Club of Rome was ordered by the Committee of
- 300 to further the progress of think tanks which it said offered a
- new means of spreading the Committee's philosophy. The impact
- of these think tanks upon our military, just since 1959 when they
- suddenly proliferated, is truly astounding. There is no doubt that
- they will play an even greater role in the daily affairs of this
- nation as we come to the close of the 20th century.
-
- THE MONT PELERIN SOCIETY
- Mont Pelerin is an economic foundation devoted to issuing
- misleading economic theories and influencing economists in the
- Western world to follow models it lays out from time to time. Its
- leading practitioners are Von Hayek and Milton Friedman.
-
- THE HOOVER INSTITUTION
- Founded originally to fight Communism, the institution has
- slowly but surely turned toward Socialism. It has an annual
- budget of $2 million, funded by companies under the umbrella
- of the Committee of 300. It now concentrates on "peaceful
- changes" with emphasis on arms control and domestic U.S.
- problems. It is Frequently used by the news media as a "conser-
- vative" organization whose views they seek when a conservative
- viewpoint is needed. The Hoover Institution is far from that, and
- following the 1953 take-over of the Institution by a group allied
- to the Club of Rome, it has become a One World-New World
- Order outlet for "desirable" policies.
-
- HERITAGE FOUNDATION
- Founded by brewery magnate Joseph Coors to act as a
- conservative think tank, Heritage was soon taken over by
- Fabianists Sir Peter Vickers Hall, Stuart Butler, Steven Ayzlei,
- Robert Moss and Frederich Von Hayek under the direction of
- the Club of Rome. This institute played a major role in carrying
-
- 60
-
- out British Labour leader Anthony Wedgewood Benn's order to
- "Thatcherize Reagan." Heritage is certainly not a conservative
- operation although at times it may look and sound like one.
-
- HUMAN RESOURCES RESEARCH OFFICE.
- This is an Army research establishment dealing in
- "psychotechnology." Most of its personnel are Tavistock-trained.
- "Psychotechnology" covers GI motivation, morale and music
- used by the enemy. In fact a lot of what George Orwell wrote
- about in his book "1984" appears to be remarkably similar to
- what is taught at HUMRRO. In 1969, the Committee of 300
- took over this important institution and turned it into a private
- non-profit organization run under the auspices of the Club of
- Rome. It is the largest behavioral research group in the U.S.
- One of its specialities is the study of small groups under
- stress and HUMRRO teaches the Army that a soldier is merely
- an extension of his equipment and has brought great influence
- to bear on the "man/weapon" system and its "human quality
- control," so widely accepted by the United States Army.
- HUMRRO has had a very pronounced effect on how the Army
- conducts itself. Its mind-bending techniques are straight out of
- Tavistock. HUMRRO'S applied psychology courses are sup-
- posed to teach Army brass how to make the human weapon
- work. A good example of this is the manner in which soldiers in
- the war against Iraq were willing to disobey their field manual
- standing orders and bury 12,000 Iraqi soldiers alive.
- This type of brainwashing is terribly dangerous because
- today, it is applied to the Army, the Army applies it to brutally
- destroy thousands of "enemy" soldiers, and tomorrow the Army
- could be told that civilian population groups opposed to gov-
- ernment policies are "the enemy." We are already a mindless
- brainwashed flock of sheep, yet it seems that HUMRRO can
- take mind bending and mind control a step further. HUMRRO is
- a valuable adjunct to Tavistock and many of the lessons taught
- at HUMRRO were applied in the Gulf War, which makes it a
-
- 61
-
- little easier to understand how it came to be that American
- soldiers behaved as ruthless and heartless killers, a far cry from
- the concept of the traditional American fighting man.
-
- RESEARCH ANALYSlS CORPORATION.
- This is HUMRRO'S sister "1984" organization situated in
- McLean, Virginia. Established in 1948, it was taken over by the
- Committee of 3OO in 1961 when it became part of the Johns
- Hopkins bloc. It has worked on over 600 projects, including
- integrating Negroes into the Army, the tactical use of nuclear
- weapons, psychological warfare programs and mass population
- control.
- Obviously there are many more major think tanks, and we
- shall come to most of them in this book. One of the most
- important areas of cooperation between what think tanks turn
- out and what becomes government and public policy are the
- "pollsters." It is the job of the polling companies to mold and
- shape public opinion in the way that suits the conspirators. Polls
- are constantly being taken by CBS-NBC-ABC, the New York
- Times, the Washington Post. Most of these efforts are coordi-
- nated at the National Opinion Research Center where, as much
- as it will amaze most of us, a psychological profile was developed
- for the entire nation.
- Findings are fed into the computers of Gallup Poll and
- Yankelovich, Skelley and White for comparative evaluation.
- Much of what we read in our newspapers or see on television
- has first been cleared by the polling companies. WHAT WE
- SEE IS WHAT THE POLLSTERS THINK WE SHOULD SEE.
- This is called "public opinion making." The whole idea behind
- this bit of social conditioning is to find out how responsive the
- public is to POLICY DIRECTIVES handed down by the Com-
- mittee of 300. We are called "targeted population groups" and
- what is measured by the pollsters is how much resistance is
- generated to what appears in the "Nightly News." Later, we
- shall learn exactly how this deceptive practice got started and
-
- 62
-
- who is responsible for it.
- It is all part of the elaborate opinion-making process created
- at, Tavistock. Today our people believe they are well-informed
- but what they do not realize is that the opinions they believe are
- their own were in fact created in the research institutions and
- think tanks of America and that none of us are free to form our
- own opinions because of the information we are provided with
- by the media and the pollsters.
- Polling was brought to a fine art just before the United
- States entered the Second World War. Americans, unbeknown to
- themselves, were conditioned to look upon Germany and Japan
- as dangerous enemies who had to be stopped. In a sense, this
- was true, and that makes conditioned thinking all the more
- dangerous, because based on the INFORMATlON fed to them,
- the enemy did indeed appear to be Germany and Japan. Just
- recently we saw how well Tavistock's conditioning process
- works when Americans were conditioned to perceive Iraq as a
- threat and Saddam Hussein as a personal enemy of the United
- States.
- Such a conditioning process is technically described as "the
- message reaching the sense organs of persons to be influenced."
- One of the most respected of all pollsters is Committee of 300
- member Daniel Yankelovich, of the company, Yankelovich,
- Skelley and White. Yankelovich is proud to tell his students that
- polling is a tool to change public opinion, although this is not
- original, Yankelovich having drawn his inspiration from David
- Naisbett's book "TREND REPORT" which was commissioned
- by the Club of Rome.
- In his book Naisbett describes all of the techniques used by
- public opinion makers to bring about the public opinion desired
- by the Committee of 300. Public opinion making is the jewel in
- the crown of the OLYMPIANS, for with their thousands of new-
- science social scientists at their beck and call, and with the news
- media firmly in their hands, NEW public opinions on almost
- any subject can be created and disseminated around the world in
-
- 63
-
- a matter of two weeks.
- This is precisely what happened when their servant George
- Bush was ordered to make war on Iraq. Within two weeks, not
- only the U.S. but almost the entire world public opinion was
- turned against Iraq and its President Saddam Hussein. These
- media change artists and news manipulators report directly to
- the Club of Rome which in turn reports to the Committee of 300
- at whose head sits the Queen of England ruling over a vast
- network of closely-linked corporations who never pay taxes and
- are answerable to no one, who fund their research institutions
- through foundations whose joint activities have almost total
- control over our daily lives.
- Together with their interlocking companies, insurance busi-
- ness, banks, finance corporations, oil companies, newspapers,
- magazines, radio and television, this vast apparatus sits astride
- the United States and the world. There is not a politician in
- Washington D.C. who is not, somehow, beholden to it. The Left
- rails against it, calling it "imperialism" which indeed it is, but
- the left is run by the same people, the very same ones who
- control the right, so that the left is no more free than we are!
- Scientists engaged in the process of conditioning are called
- "social engineers" or "new-science social scientists" and they
- play an integral part in what we see, hear and read. The "old
- school" social engineers were Kurt K. Lewin, Professor Hadley
- Cantril, Margaret Meade, Professor Derwin Cartwright and
- Professor Lipssitt who, together with John Rawlings Reese,
- made up the backbone of new-science scientists at Tavistock
- Institute.
- During the Second World War, there were over 100 re-
- searchers at work under the direction of Kurt Lewin, copying
- slavishly the methods adopted by Reinhard Heydrich of the S.S.
- The OSS was based on Heydrich's methodology and, as we
- know, the OSS was the forerunner of the Central Intelligence
- Agency. The point of all this is that the governments of Britain
- and the United States already have the machinery in place to
-
- 64
-
- bring us into line in a New World Order with only a slight
- modicum of resistance materializing, and this machinery has
- been in place since 1946. Each passing year has added new
- refinements.
- It is this Committee of 300 which has established control
- networks and mechanisms far more binding than anything ever
- seen in this world. Chains and ropes are not needed to restrain
- us. Our fear of what is to come does that job far more efficiently
- than any physical means of restraint. We have been brainwashed
- to give up our Constitutional right to bear arms; to give up our
- Constitution itself; to allow the United Nations to exercise
- control over our foreign policies and the IMF to take control of
- our fiscal and monetary policies; to permit the President to
- break United States law with impunity and to invade a foreign
- country and kidnap its head-of-state. In short we have been
- brainwashed to the extent where we, as a nation, will accept
- each and every lawless act carried out by our government
- almost without question.
- I for one know that we will soon have to fight to reclaim
- our country from the Committee, or lose it forever. BUT when
- it comes right down to it, how many will actually take up arms?
- In 1776 only 3% of the populace took up arms against King
- George III. This time around, 3% will be woefully inadequate.
- We should not allow ourselves to be led down dead-end roads,
- for that is what our mind controllers have planned for us by
- confronting us with such a complexity of issues that we simply
- succumb to long range penetration and make no decisions at all
- on many vital issues.
- We shall be looking at the names of those who make up the
- Committee of 300 but, before we do that, we should examine
- the massive interfacing of all important institutions, companies
- and banks under the Committee's control. We must mark them
- well because these are the people who are deciding who shall
- live and who shall be eliminated as "useless eaters"; where we
- will worship God, what we must wear and even what we shall
-
- 65
-
- eat. According to Brzezinski, we shall be under endless surveil-
- lance around the clock for 365 days a year ad infinitum.
- That we have been betrayed from within is being accepted
- by more and more people each year, and that is good, because it
- is through knowledge, a word translated from the word BE-
- LIEF, that we shall be able to defeat the enemies of all mankind.
- While we were being distracted by the bogeymen in the Krem-
- lin, the Trojan Horse was moved into position in Washington
- D.C. The greatest danger free people face today is not from
- Moscow but from Washington D.C. We need first to conquer the
- DOMESTIC ENEMY, and after that we will be strong enough
- to mount an offensive to remove Communism from the earth
- together with all of its attendant "isms."
- The Carter Administration accelerated the collapse of our
- economy and our military strength, the latter begun by Club of
- Rome and Lucis Trust member Robert Strange McNamara. In
- spite of his promises, Reagan continued to undermine our in-
- dustrial base, starting where Carter left off. While we need to
- keep our defenses strong, we cannot do that from a weak in-
- dustrial base for, without a well-run military-industrial complex,
- we cannot have a viable defense system. The Committee of 300
- recognizes this and planned from 1953 its zero-growth post-
- industrial policies now in full flower.
- Thanks to the Club of Rome our technology potential has
- dropped below that of Japan and Germany, nations we are
- supposed to have defeated in the Second World War. How has
- this come about? Because of men like Dr. Alexander King and
- our blindfolded state of mind, we have failed to recognize the
- destruction of our educational institutions and systems of
- teaching. As a result of our blindness, we are no longer training
- engineers and scientist in sufficient numbers to keep us among
- the industrialized nations of the world. Thanks to Dr. King, a
- man very few people in America know about, education in the
- U.S. is at its lowest level since 1786. Statistics produced by the
- Institute for Higher Learning show that the reading and writing
-
- 66
-
- capabilities of high school children the United States are
- LOWER than they were among high school children in 1786.
- What we face today is not only the loss of our freedom and
- the very fabric of our nation, but far worse, the possibility of the
- loss of our souls. The steady chipping away at the foundation
- upon which this republic rests has left an empty void, which
- satanists and cultists are rushing to fill with their synthetic soul
- material. This truth is difficult to accept and appreciate because
- there was nothing SUDDEN about these events. If a sudden
- shock were to hit us, a cultural and religious shock, we would be
- shaken out of our apathy.
- But gradualism--which is what Fabianism is, does nothing
- to raise the alarm. Because the vast majority of Americans can
- see no MOTIVATION for the things I have described, they
- cannot accept it, and so the conspiracy is scorned and often
- mocked. By creating chaos through presenting hundreds of
- daily choices our people have to make, we have come down to a
- position where, unless motivation can be clearly shown, all
- information is rejected.
- This is both the weak and the strong link in the conspirato-
- rial chain. Most thrust aside anything that has no motive, so the
- conspirators feel safe behind the ridicule poured upon those
- who point to the coming crisis in our nation and our individual
- lives. However, if we can get enough people to see the truth, the
- motivation block gets weaker until it will eventually be forced
- aside as more and more people become enlightened and the
- notion that "this cannot happen in America" is dispensed with.
- The Committee of 300 is counting on our maladaptive re-
- sponses to govern our reaction to created events, and it will not
- be disappointed as long as we as a nation continue in the present
- way we respond. We must turn responses to created crises into
- ADAPTIVE responses by identifying the conspirators and ex-
- posing their plans for us, so that these things become public
- knowledge. The Club of Rome has already made THE TRAN-
- SITION TO BARBARISM. Instead of waiting to be "raptured,"
-
- 67
-
- we must stop the Committee of 300 before it can accomplish its
- goal of making us prisoners of the" New Dark Age" planned for
- us. It is not up to God, IT IS UP TO US. We have to take the
- necessary action.
- All information that I provide in this book comes from years
- of research backed up by impeccable intelligence sources.
- Nothing is exaggerated. It is factual and precise so do not fall
- into the trap set by the enemy that this material is "disinforma-
- tion." For the past two decades I have provided information
- which has proved to be highly accurate and which has explained
- a lot of puzzling events. My hope is that through this book, a
- better, clearer and wider understanding of the conspiratorial
- forces ranged against this nation will come about. That hope is
- being realized as more and more young people are beginning to
- ask questions and seek information about what is REALLY
- going on.
- It is difficult for people to comprehend that these conspira-
- tors are real and that they have the power I and many others
- have attributed to them. Many have written to ask how it is that
- our government does nothing about the terrible threat to civili-
- zation? The problem is that our government is PART of the
- problem, part of the conspiracy, and nowhere and at no time has
- this become more clearly evident than during the Bush Presi-
- dency. Of course President Bush knows precisely what the
- Committee of 300 is doing to us. HE WORKS FOR THEM.
- Others have written to say, "We thought we were fighting the
- government." Of course we are, but behind government stands a
- force so powerful and all-encompassing that intelligence agen-
- cies are even afraid to mention the name "Olympians."
- Proof of the Committee of 300 is found in the vast number of
- powerful institutions owned and controlled by it. Listed here are
- some of the more important ones, all of which come under the
- MOTHER OF ALL THINK TANKS AND RESEARCH INSTI-
- TUTIONS, THE TAVISTOCK INSTITUTE OF HUMAN RE-
- LATIONS with its far-flung network of hundreds of "branches."
-
- 68
-
- STANFORD RESEARCH CENTER
- Stanford Research Center (SRC) was founded in 1946 by
- the Tavistock Institute For Human Relations. Stanford was cre-
- ated to help Robert 0. Anderson and his ARCO oil company,
- who had secured for the Committee of 300 the oil rights on the
- North Slope of Alaska. Basically, the job was too large for
- Anderson's Aspen Institute to handle, so a new center had to be
- founded and funded. That new center was Stanford Research
- Center. Alaska sold its rights on a downpayment of $900 million,
- a relatively small amount for the Committee of 300. The governor
- of Alaska was steered to SRI for help and advice. This was no
- accident but the result of judicious planning and a process of
- long-range conditioning.
- Following the governor's call for help, three SRI scientists
- set up shop in Alaska where they met with the Alaskan Secretary
- of State and the State Planning Office. Francis Greehan, who
- headed the SRI team, assured the Governor that his problem of
- how to handle the rich oil find would be safe in the hands of
- SRI. Naturally Greehan did not mention the Committee of 300
- or the Club of Rome. In less than a month Greehan assembled a
- team of economists, petroleum scientists and new-science sci-
- entists numbering in the hundreds. The report SRI gave to the
- Governor ran to eighty-eight pages.
- The proposal was adopted virtually without change by the
- Alaska legislature in 1970. Greehan had indeed done a remark-
- able job for the Committee of 300. From this beginning SRI
- developed into an institution employing 4000 people with an
- annual budget of $160 million plus. Its President, Charles A.
- Anderson, has seen much of this growth during his tenure, as
- has Professor Willis Harmon, director of the SRI Center for the
- Study of Social Policies, employing hundreds of new-science
- scientists, many of the top staffers having been transferred from
- Tavistock's London base. One of those was RCA board chair-
- man and former British intelligence agent, David Sarnoff, who
- was closely involved with Harmon and his team for twenty-five
-
- 69
-
- years. Sarnoff was something of a "watchdog" for the mother
- institute in Sussex.
- Stanford claims to make no moral judgments on projects it
- accepts, working for Israel and the Arabs, South Africa and
- Libya but, as one would imagine, by adopting this attitude it
- ensures an "inside edge" with foreign governments that the CIA
- has found most useful. In Jim Ridgeway's book, "THE CLOSED
- CORPORATION," SRI spokesman Gibson brags about SRI's
- non-discriminatory stance. Although not on the Federal Contract
- Research Center lists, SRI is today the largest military think tank,
- dwarfing Hudson and Rand. Among SRl's speciality depart-
- ments are chemical and biological warfare experimental centers.
- One of Stanford's more dangerous activities is counter-
- insurgency operations aimed at civilian populations--just the
- sort of "1984" things government is already using against its
- own people. The U.S. government pays SRI millions of dollars
- each year for this kind of highly controversial "research." Fol-
- lowing student protests against chemical warfare experiments
- conducted at Stanford, SRI "sold" itself to a private group for
- just $25 million. Of course nothing really changed, SRI was still
- a Tavistock project and the Committee of 300 still owned it, but
- the gullible appeared to be satisfied by this meaningless cosmetic
- change.
- In 1958 a startling new development arose. Advanced Re-
- search Products Agency (ARPA), a contracting agency for the
- Defense Department, approached SRI with a top secret pro-
- posal. John Foster at the Pentagon told SRI that what was
- needed was a program to insure the United States against
- "technological surprise." Foster wanted to perfect a condition
- where the environment became a weapon; special bombs to
- trigger volcanos and/or earthquakes, behavioral research on
- potential enemies and minerals and metals with potential for
- new weapons. The project was accepted by SRI and code-
- named "SHAKY."
- The massive electronic brain in SHAKY was capable of
-
- 70
-
- carrying out many commands, its computers having been con-
- structed by IBM for SRI. Twenty-eight scientists worked on
- what is called "Human Augmentation." The IBM computer
- even has the capability to solve problems by analogy and rec-
- ognizes and identifies scientists who work with it. The "special
- applications" of this tool can be better imagined than described.
- Brzezinski knew what he was talking about when he wrote
- "THE TECHNOTRONIC ERA."
- Stanford Research Institute works closely with scores of
- civilian consulting firms, trying to apply military technology to
- domestic situations. This has not always been a success, but as
- techniques improve, the prospects for massive all-pervading
- surveillance, as described by Brzezinski, daily becomes more
- real. IT ALREADY EXISTS AND IS IN USE, EVEN THOUGH
- SLIGHT MALFUNCTIONS FROM TIME TO TIME HAVE
- TO BE IRONED OUT. One such civilian consulting firm was
- Schriever McKee Associates of McLean, Virginia, run by retired
- General Bernard A. Schriever, a former chief of the Air Force
- Systems Command, who developed the Titan, Thor, Atlas and
- Minuteman rockets.
- Schriever put together a consortium of Lockheed, Emmerson
- Electric, Northrop, Control Data, Raytheon and TRW under the
- name of URBAN SYSTEMS ASSOCIATES, INC. The purpose
- of the consortium? To solve social and psychological "urban
- problems" by means of military techniques using advanced
- electronic systems. It is interesting to note that TRW became the
- largest credit information collecting company in the credit-
- reporting business as a result and an outcome of its work with
- Urban Systems Associates, Inc.
- This should tell us a great deal about just how far this nation
- is already under TOTAL SURVEILLANCE, which is the first
- requirement of the Committee of 300. No dictatorship, espe-
- cially not one on a global scale, can function without total
- control over each and every individual. SRI was well on its way
- to becoming a key Committee of 300 research organization.
-
- 71
-
- By the 1980's, 60% of SRl's contracts were devoted to
- "Futurism" with both military and civilian applications. Its ma-
- jor clients were the U.S. Department of Defense-Directorate of
- Defense Research and Engineering, Office of Aerospace Re-
- search which dealt with "Applications of the Behavioral Sciences
- to Research Management," Executive Office of the President,
- Office of Science and Technology, U.S. Department of Health.
- On behalf of the Department of Health, SRI ran a program
- called "'Patterns in ESDEA Title I Reading Achievement Tests."
- Other clients were the U.S. Department of Energy, the U.S.
- Department of Labor, U.S. Department of Transportation and
- the National Science Foundation (NSF). Of significance was the
- paper developed for NSF, entitled "Assessment of Future and
- International Problems."
- Stanford Research, under the tutelage of Tavistock Institute
- in London, put together a far reaching and chilling system it
- called "Business Intelligence Program." In excess of 600 com-
- panies in the U.S. and abroad became subscribers. The program
- covered research in Japanese Foreign Business Relations, Con-
- sumer Marketing in a Period of Change, The Mounting Challenge
- of International Terrorism, Sensory Evaluation in Consumer
- Products, Electronic Funds Transfer System, Opto-Electric
- Sensing, Exploratory Planning Methods, the U.S. Defense In-
- dustry and Capital Availability. Among the TOP Committee of
- 300 companies who became clients of this program were Bechtel
- Corporation (George Schultz was on its board), Hewlett Packard,
- TRW, Bank of America, Shell Company, RCA, Blyth, Eastman
- Dillon, Saga Foods Corporation, McDonnell Douglas, Crown
- Zellerbach, Wells Fargo Bank and Kaiser Industries.
- But one of the most sinister of all SRI programs with the
- possibilities of doing tremendous damage in altering the direc-
- tion in which the United States will go, socially, morally and
- religiously, was Stanford's Charles F. Kettering Foundation's
- "CHANGING IMAGES OF MAN" under Stanford official
- reference "Contract Number URH (489)-2150 Policy Research
-
- 72
-
- Report Number 4/4/74, Prepared by the SRI Center for the Study of
- Social Policy, Director Willis Harmon." This is probably one of
- the most far-reaching investigations into how man might be
- changed that has ever been conducted.
- The report, covering 319 pages, was written by 14 new
- science scientists under the supervision of Tavistock and 23 top
- controllers including B. F. Skinner, Margaret Meade, Ervin
- Lazlo and Sir Geoffrey Vickers, a high-level British intelligence
- officer in M16. It will be recalled that his son-in-law, Sir Peter
- Vickers Hall, was a founding member of the so-called conser-
- vative "Heritage Foundation." Much of the 3000 pages of "rec-
- ommendations" given to the Reagan administration in January
- 1981 were based upon material taken from Willis Harmon's
- "CHANGING IMAGES OF MAN."
- I was privileged to receive a copy of "THE CHANGING
- IMAGES OF MAN" from my intelligence colleagues five days
- after it was accepted by the United States government. What I
- read shocked me, as I realized I was looking at a blueprint for a
- future America, unlike anything I had ever seen before. The
- nation was to be programmed to change and become so accus-
- tomed to such planned changes that it would hardly be noticeable
- when profound changes did occur. We have gone downhill so
- fast since "THE AQUARIAN CONSPIRACY" (the book title
- of Willis Harmon's technical paper) was written, that today,
- divorce draws no stigma, suicide is at an all time high and raises
- few eyebrows, social deviations from the norm and sexual
- aberrations, once unmentionable in decent circles, are now
- commonplace and excite no special protest.
- As a nation we have not noticed how "CHANGING IMAGES
- OF MANKIND" has radically altered our American way of life
- forever. Somehow we were overcome by the "Watergate Syn-
- drome." For a while we were shocked and dismayed to learn
- that Nixon was nothing but a cheap crook who hobnobbed with
- Earl Warren's Mafia friends at the beautiful home they built for
- him adjoining the Nixon estate. When too many "future shocks"
-
- 73
-
- and news headlines demanded our attention, we lost our way, or
- rather, the huge number of choices with which we were and still
- are daily confronted, confused us to such a degree that we were
- no longer able to make the necessary choices.
- Worse yet, having been subjected to a barrage of crimes in
- high places, plus the trauma of the Vietnam War, our nation
- seemed no longer to want truths. Such reaction is carefully
- explained in Willis Harmon's technical paper, in short, the
- American nation was reacting exactly as profiled. Worse yet, in
- not wishing to accept truth, we took matters a step further: We
- looked to government to shield us from the truth.
- The corrupt stench of the Reagan-Bush Administrations we
- wanted covered with six feet of earth. The crimes committed
- under the title of Iran/Contra affair (or scandals), we didn't want
- uncovered. We let our President lie to us regarding his where
- abouts in the period October 20-23rd, 1980. Yet these crimes far
- exceed in quantity and scope anything Nixon did while he was
- in office. Do we as a nation recognize it as going downhill with
- our brakes off?
- No, we do not. When those whose business it is to bring the
- truth to the American people that a private, well-organized little
- government inside the White House was busy committing one
- crime after another, crimes which attacked the very soul of this
- nation and the republican institutions upon which it rested, we
- were told not to bother the public with such things. "We really
- don't want to know about all this speculation," became a stan-
- dard response.
- When the highest elected official of the land blatantly put
- U.N. law above the Constitution of the United States--an im-
- peachible offense, the majority accepted it as "normal." When
- the highest elected official of the land went to war without a
- Congressional declaration of war, the fact was censored out by the
- news media and, again, we accepted it rather than face the truth.
- When the Gulf War, which our President plotted and planned,
- began, not only were we happy with censorship of the most
-
- 74
-
- blatant kind, we even took it to our hearts, believing that it was
- "good tor the war effort." Our President lied, April Glaspie lied,
- the State Department lied. They said the war was justified
- because President Hussein had been warned to leave Kuwait
- alone. When Glaspie's cables to the State Department were
- finally made public, one United States Senator after another
- went charging to defend Glaspie, the harlot. It mattered not that
- they came from both the Democrats and the Republicans. We,
- the people, let them get away with their vile lies.
-
-
- <<<<< cont in Committee of 300 - part 4 >>>>>
-
-
- --
- <*> Don Allen <*> 1:363/81.1 - Fidonet #1 - Homebody BBS
- dona@bilver.uucp - Internet 1:363/29.8 - Fidonet #2 - Gourmet Delight
- 88:4205/1.1 - MUFON Network 1:3607/20.2 -- Odyssey - Alabama UFO Net
- NSA grep food: Aviary, Ed Dames, Los Alamos - Majestic - Jason - RIIA - UN
-
- Path: igor.rutgers.edu!rutgers!jvnc.net!darwin.sura.net!haven.umd.edu!uunet!peora!tarpit!tous!bilver!dona
- From: dona@bilver.uucp (Don Allen)
- Newsgroups: alt.conspiracy
- Subject: FILE: Committee of 300 - Part 4
- Message-ID: <1992Nov15.194745.26863@bilver.uucp>
- Date: 15 Nov 92 19:47:45 GMT
- Organization: W. J. Vermillion - Winter Park, FL
- Lines: 1030
-
-
- --- Committee of 300 - Part 4 ---------------------------------------------
-
-
- In this public attitude of the American people, the wildest
- dreams of Willis Harmon and his teams of scientists became a
- reality. The Tavistock Institute was elated at its success in
- destroying the self respect and self esteem of this once great
- nation. We are told that we won the Gulf War. What is not yet
- perceived by the vast majority of Americans is that, in winning
- the war, it cost the self respect and honor of our nation. That lies
- rotting in the desert sands of Kuwait and Iraq, alongside the
- corpses of the Iraqi soldiers we butchered in the agreed retreat
- from Kuwait and Basra--we could not keep our word that we
- would abide by the Geneva Conventions and not attack them.
- "What do you want," our controllers asked us, "victory or self
- respect? You can't have both."
- One hundred years ago, this could not have happened, but
- now it has happened and excites no comment. We have suc-
- cumbed to the long range penetration warfare waged against
- this nation by Tavistock. Like the German nation, defeated by
- the Prudential Bombing Survey, enough of us have succumbed
- to make this nation the kind that totalitarian regimes of the past
- would have only envisaged in their dreams. "Here," they would
- say, "is a nation, one of the largest in the world, that doesn't
- want the truth. All of our propaganda agencies can be dispensed
- with. We don't have to struggle to keep the truth from this
- nation, they have willingly rejected it of their own volition. This
- nation is a pushover."
- Our once proud Republic of the United States of America
-
- 75
-
- became no more than a series of criminal front organizations,
- which history shows is always the start of totalitarianism. This
- is the stage of permanent alteration we are at in America as 1991
- drew to a close. We live in a throw-away society, programmed
- not to last. We do not even flinch at the 4 million homeless nor
- the 30 million jobless, nor the 15 million babies murdered thus
- far. They are "throw-aways" of the Age of Aquarius, a conspiracy
- so damnable that, when first confronted with it, the majority
- will disavow its existence, rationalizing these events as "times
- have changed."
- This is how the Tavistock Institute and Willis Harmon pro-
- grammed us to react. Dismantling of our ideals goes on without
- protest. The spiritual and intellectual drive of our people has
- been destroyed! On May 27th, 1991, President Bush made a very
- profound statement, the thrust of which appears to have been
- totally misused by most political commentators:
-
- "The moral dimension of American policy requires us to
- chart a moral course through a world of lesser evils. That
- is the real world, not black and white. Very few moral
- absolutes."
-
- What else could we expect from a President who is most
- probably the most evil man ever to occupy the White House?
- Consider this in the light of his order to the military to bury
- alive 12,000 Iraqi soldiers. Consider this in the light of his
- ongoing war of genocide against the Iraqi people. President
- Bush was delighted to characterize President Saddam Hussein
- as the "Hitler of our times." He never bothered to offer a single
- scrap of proof. It was not needed. Because President Bush made
- the statement, we accepted it without question. Consider this in
- the bright light of truth, that he did all of these things in the
- name of the American people while secretly taking his orders
- from the Committee of 300.
- But, more than anything else, consider this: President Bush
-
- 76
-
- and his controllers feel so secure that they no longer deem it
- necessary to hide their evil control of the American people, or to
- lie about it. This is self-evident in the statement that he, as our
- leader, will make all manner of compromises with truth, hon-
- esty and decency if his controllers (and ours) deem it necessary.
- On May 27th, 1991, the President of the United States abandoned
- each and every principle embodied in our Constitution and
- boldly proclaimed that he was no longer bound by it. This is a
- great victory for the Tavistock Institute and the Prudential
- Bombing Survey, whose target changed from German worker
- housing in 1945 to the soul of the American people in a war that
- began in 1946 and runs through to 1992.
- Increased pressure on this nation for change was applied by
- Stanford Research Institute in the early 1960's. SRl's offensive
- gathered power and momentum. Switch on your television set
- and you will see Stanford's victory in front of your very eyes:
- talk shows featuring heavy sexual details, special video channels
- where perversion, rock and roll and drugs reign supreme. Where
- once John Wayne ruled, we now have a made-over apology for a
- man (or is he?) called Michael Jackson, a parody of a human
- being who is held up as a hero, as he gyrates, shuffles, mumbles
- and screams his way across television screens in millions of
- American homes.
- A woman who has been through a series of marriages gets
- national coverage. One filthy, half-washed drug-ridden deca-
- lent rock band after another has hours of air time devoted to its
- inane sounds and mad gyrations, clothes fashions and language
- aberrations. Soap operas showing as near as "dammit" is to
- wearing pornographic scenes draw no comment. Whereas in
- early 1960 this would never have been tolerated, today it is
- accepted as normal. We have been subjected and we have
- succumbed to what Tavistock Institute calls "future shocks"
- whose future is NOW and we are so numbed by one cultural
- shock after another that to protest seems like a futile gesture
- and, therefore, logically we think, it does no good to protest.
-
- 77
-
- In 1986 the Committee of 300 ordered the pressure turned
- up. The U.S. was not going down fast enough. The United States
- began the process of "recognizing" the butchers of Cambodia,
- the criminal Pol Pot regime, self confessors to the murder of 2
- million Cambodian citizens. In 1991, the wheel turned the full
- circle. The United States went to war against a friendly nation
- that had been programmed to trust the Washington traitors. We
- accused President Hussein of the small nation of Iraq of all
- manner of evil, NONE OF WHICH WAS EVEN REMOTELY
- TRUE. We killed and maimed its children, we left them to
- starve and to die of all manner of diseases.
- In the same breath we sent the Bush emissaries of the
- Committee of 300 to Cambodia to RECOGNIZE THE EVIL
- MASS MURDERERS OF 2 MILLION CAMBODIANS, who
- were sacrificed by the Committee of 300's depopulation of
- cities experiment, which the big cities of the United States will
- experience in the not too distant future. Now, President Bush
- and his Committee of 300-ridden administration say, in effect,
- "Look people, what do you want from me? I told you that I will
- compromise where I see fit, even when that means sleeping with
- the Pol Pot murderers. SO WHAT--KISS MY HIPS."
- The level of pressure for change will reach its peak in 1993
- and we shall witness scenes such as we would never have
- thought possible. Punch drunk America will react, but ever so
- slightly. Not even the latest threat to our freedom, the personal
- computer card disturbs us. Willis Harman's "CHANGING IM-
- AGES OF MAN" would have been too technical for most so the
- service of Marilyn Ferguson was obtained to make it more
- easily understood. "THE AGE OF AQUARIUS" heralded nude
- stage shows and a song which made the top of the charts: "The
- Dawning of the Age of the Aquarius" swept the globe.
- The personal computer card which, when fully distributed,
- will deprive us of our familiar environment and, as we shall see,
- environment means a lot more than the usually accepted mean-
- ing of the word. The United States has gone through a period of
-
- 78
-
- intense trauma such as has never been visited on any other
- nation in the history of the world, and the worst is yet to come.
- Everything is going according to what Tavistock ordered
- and what the social scientists at Stanford mapped out. Times do
- not change; they are made to change. All changes are preplanned
- and come as the result of careful action. We have been changed
- gradually at first, but now the pace of change is picking up. The
- United States is being transformed from One Nation Under God
- to a polyglot of nations under several gods. The U.S. is no
- longer One nation under God. The framers of the Constitution
- have lost the battle.
- Our forebears spoke a common language and believed in a
- common religion Christianity, and held common ideals. There
- were no aliens in our midst; that came later in a deliberately
- planned attempt to break up the United States into a series of
- fragmented nationalities, cultures and beliefs. If you doubt this,
- go down to the East Side of New York, or the West Side of Los
- Angeles on any given Saturday and look around you. The
- United States has become several nations struggling to coexist
- under a common system of government. When the floodgates of
- immigration were opened wide by Franklin D. Roosevelt, a
- cousin of the head of the Committee of 300, the cultural shock
- caused great confusion and dislocation and made "One Nation"
- an unworkable concept. The Club of Rome and NATO have
- exacerbated the situation. "Love thy neighbor" is an ideal that
- will not work unless your neighbor "is as yourself."
- To the framers of our Constitution, the truths they laid out
- For future generations were "self evident"--to themselves Be-
- ing unsure that future generations would also find the truths to
- which they bound this nation self evident, THEY SET ABOUT
- SPELLlNG THEM OUT. IT SEEMS THAT THEY WERE
- AFRAID OF A TIME THAT MIGHT COME WHEN THE
- TRUTHS THEY ESPOUSED WOULD NO LONGER BE
- SELF-EVIDENT. The Tavistock Institute for Human Relations
- has made sure that what the framers feared might come to pass
-
- 79
-
- has indeed come to pass. That time has arrived with Bush and
- his "no absolutes" and his New World Order under the Committee
- of 300.
- This is part of the concept of social changes forced upon
- Americans which Harmon and the Club of Rome said would
- make for severe trauma and a great building up of pressure. The
- social upheavals that have taken place since the advent of
- Tavistock, the Club of Rome and NATO will continue in the U.S.
- for as long as the limit of absorption is ignored. Nations are made
- up of individuals and, like individuals, there is a limit to their
- ability to absorb changes, no matter how robust they may be.
- This psychological truth was well proven by the Strategic
- Bombing Survey which called for saturation bombing of Ger-
- man worker housing. As mentioned earlier, the project was the
- work of the Prudential Insurance Company and no one doubts
- today that Germany suffered its defeat because of this operation.
- Many of the scientists who worked on that project are working
- on saturation bombing of America, or else they have passed on,
- leaving their skilled techniques in the hands of others who
- followed behind them.
- The legacy they left behind them can be found in the fact
- that we have not so much lost our way as a nation, but that we
- have been steered in a direction opposite to that which the
- framers of the Declaration guided us for over 200 years. We
- have, in short, lost contact with our historical genes, our faith,
- which inspired countless generations of Americans to move
- forward as a nation, benefiting from the patrimony left to us by
- the framers of the Declaration of Independence and the United
- States Constitution. That we are lost is clear to all who seek the
- truth, as unpleasant as it may be.
- With President Bush and his "no absolute morals" guiding
- us, we blunder ahead as lost nations and individuals tend to do.
- We are collaborating with the Committee of 300 for our own
- downfall and our own enslavement. Some sense it--and feel a
- strong sense of unease. The various conspiracy theories they are
-
- 80
-
- familiar with do not seem to cover it all. This is because they
- know nothing of the Conspirators'Hierarchy, The Committee
- of 300.
- These souls who feel a deep sense of unease and that some-
- thing is radically wrong, yet cannot put their collective fingers
- on the problem, walk in darkness. They look to a future they see
- slipping away from them. The American dream has become a
- mirage. They place their faith in religion but take no steps to
- help that faith along by ACTION. Americans will never experi-
- ence a retracing of steps such as the Europeans experienced
- when at the height of the Dark Ages. By determined ACTlON,
- they awoke in themselves a spirit of renewal which resulted in
- the glorious Renaissance.
- The enemy that has directed them to this point decided to
- make a strong move against the United States in 1980, so that
- Renaissance of America would be impossible. Who is the enemy?
- The enemy is no faceless "they." The enemy is clearly identifi-
- able as the Committee of 300, the Club of Rome, NATO and all
- of its affiliated organizations, the think tanks and research in-
- stitutions controlled by Tavistock. There is no need to use
- "they" or "the enemy" except as shorthand. WE KNOW WHO
- "THEY," THE ENEMY, IS. The Committee of 300 with its
- Eastern Liberal Establishment "aristocracy," its banks, insurance
- companies, giant corporations, foundations, communications
- networks, presided over by a HIERARCHY OF CONSPIRA-
- TORS--THIS IS THE ENEMY.
- This is the power that brought to life the reign of terror in
- Russia, the Bolshevik Revolution, World Wars I and II, Korea,
- Vietnam, the fall of Rhodesia, South Africa, Nicaragua, and the
- Philippines. This is the secret upper-level government that
- brought into existence the controlled disintegration of the U.S.
- economy and deindustrialized what was once the greatest indus-
- rial power, for good, that the world had ever known.
- America today can be compared with a soldier who falls
- asleep in the thick of battle. We Americans have fallen asleep,
-
- 81
-
- given way to apathy caused by being confronted with a mult-
- plicity of choices which has confused us. These are the changes
- that alter our environment, break down our resistance to change
- so that we become dazed, apathetic and eventually fall asleep in
- the thick of battle.
- There is a technical term for this condition. It is called "long
- range penetration strain." The art of subjecting a very large
- group of people to continued long range penetration strain was
- developed by scientists working out of the Tavistock Institute of
- Human Relations and their U. S. subsidiaries, Stanford Research
- and Rand Corporation, and at least another 150 research institu-
- tions here in the U.S.
- Dr. Kurt Lewin, the scientist who developed this fiendish
- warfare, has caused the average American patriot to fret over
- various conspiracy theories, leaving him or her with a feeling of
- uncertainty and insecurity, isolated and perhaps even afraid, as
- he searches, but fails to understand the decay and rot caused by
- "THE CHANGING IMAGES OF MANKIND," unable to
- identify or combat the social, moral, economic and political
- changes he deems undesirable and does not want, yet which
- increase in intensity on every hand.
- Dr. Lewin's name will not be found in any of our establish-
- ment history books which, in any event, are a record of events
- mostly from the side of the ruling class or the victors of wars.
- Therefore, it is with pride that I introduce his name to you. As
- mentioned before, Dr. Lewin organized the Harvard Psycho-
- logical Clinic and the Institute for Social Research under the
- auspices of the Tavistock Institute. The names do not give much
- indication of the purpose of the two organizations.
- This reminds me of the infamous bill to reform coinage and
- mint laws passed in 1827. The title of the bill was harmless
- enough or sounded harmless, which was the intention of its
- backers. Through this Act, Senator John Sherman betrayed the
- nation into the hands of the international bankers. Sherman
- allegedly sponsored the bill "without reading it." As we know,
-
- 82
-
- the bill's true purpose was to demonetize silver and give the
- thieving bankers unlimited power over the credit of our nation;
- powers to which the bankers were clearly not entitled under the
- clear and unmistakable terms of the U.S. Constitution.
- Kurt Lewin gave the Tavistock Institute, the Club of Rome
- and NATO unlimited power over America, to which no organi-
- zation, entity or society is entitled. These institutions have used
- the usurped powers to destroy the will of the nation to resist the
- plans and intentions of the conspirators to rob us of the fruits of
- the American Revolution and steer us on a course leading
- directly to a New Dark Ages under a One World Government.
- Lewin's colleagues in this long range penetration objective
- were Richard Crossman, Eric Trist, H. V. Dicks, Willis Harmon,
- Charles Anderson, Garner Lindsay, Richard Price and W. R.
- Bion. Again, these names never appear in the evening news; in
- fact, they only appear in scientific journals--so very few Ameri-
- cans are aware of them and not at all aware of what the men
- behind the names have done and are doing to the United States.
- President Jefferson once said he pitied those who thought
- they knew what was taking place through reading the newspaper.
- Disraeli, the British prime minister, said much the same thing.
- Indeed, down through the ages, rulers have delighted in running
- things from behind the scenes. Man has always felt the need to
- dominate and nowhere and at no time is the desire more preva-
- lent than in this modern era.
- If it were not so, why all the need for secret societies? If we
- are ruled by an open system run by democratically elected
- officials, why the need for a secret Masonic order in every
- village, town and city across the United States? How is it that
- Freemasonry can operate so openly and yet keep its secrets so
- well hidden? We can't ask the Nine Unknown Men of the Nine
- Sisters Lodge in Paris that question, nor can we ask it of their
- nine fellows in the Quatuar Coronati Lodge in London. Yet
- these eighteen men form part of an even more secret govern-
- ment, the RIIA, and beyond that, the Committee of 3OO.
-
- 83
-
- How is it that the Scottish Rite of Freemasonry could brain-
- wash John Hinckley to shoot President Reagan? Why do we
- have such secret orders as the Knights of St. John of Jerusalem,
- the Round Table, the Milner Group and so on down line upon
- line of secret societies? They form part of a world-wide chain of
- command and control running through the Club of Rome, NATO,
- the RIIA and finally right up to the Conspirators' Hierarchy,
- The Committee of 300. Men need these secret societies because
- their deeds are evil and must be hidden. Evil cannot stand in the
- light of truth.
- In this book we shall find an almost complete list of the
- conspirators, their institutions, fronts and publications. In 1980
- the Aquarian Conspiracy was in full swing and its success can
- be seen in every facet of our private and national life. The
- overwhelming rise in mindless violence, serial killers, teenage
- suicides, the unmistakable signs of lethargy--"long range pen-
- etration" is a part of our new environment, as dangerous, if not
- more so, than the polluted air that we breathe.
- The coming of the Age of Aquarius caught America totally
- unprepared. We as a nation were not prepared for the changes
- about to be forced upon us. Who ever had heard of Tavistock,
- Kurt Lewin, Willis Harmon and John Rawlings Reese? They
- were not even on the American political scene. What we would
- have noticed, if we bothered to look at all, was a falling off of
- our ability to withstand futuristic shock as we became more
- fatigued, distressed and eventually entered a period of psycho-
- logical shock followed by widespread apathy as an outward
- manifestation of long range penetration warfare.
- The Age of Aquarius was best described by Tavistock Institute
- as the vehicle for delivering turbulence: "There are three distinct
- phases in the response and reaction to stress displayed by large
- social groups. First, there is superficiality; the population under
- attack will defend itself with slogans; this does not identify the
- source of the crisis and therefore does nothing to address it,
- hence the crisis will persist. The second is fragmentation. This
-
- 84
-
- occurs as the crisis continues and social order breaks down.
- Then, there is the third phase where the population group goes
- into 'self realization' and turns away from the induced crisis and
- there follows a maladaptive response, accompanied with active
- synoptic idealism and disassociation."
- Who can deny that with the huge increase in drug usage--
- "crack" making thousands of instant new addicts each day--the
- shocking rise in the murder of infants each day (aborticide),
- which by now far exceeds casualties suffered by our armed
- forces in both World Wars, Korea and Vietnam, the open accep-
- tance of homosexuality and lesbianism whose "rights" are pro-
- tected by more and more laws each year, the terrible plague we
- call "AIDS" washing over our towns and cities, total failure of
- our education system, the stunning increase in the divorce rate, a
- murder rate that shocks the rest of the world into disbelief,
- satanic serial killings, the disappearance of thousands of young
- children, snatched off our streets by perverts, a virtual tidal wave
- of pornography accompanied by "permissiveness" on our tele-
- vision screens--who can deny that this nation is in crisis, which
- we are not addressing and from which we are turning away.
- Well-meaning people who specialize in these things blame a
- lot of the problem on education, or what passes for it in the
- United States. Criminals now abound in the age groups 9-15.
- Rapists are quite commonly as young as 10. Our social special-
- ists, our teacher's unions, our churches say it is all due to a
- faulty education system. Witness how test scores keep drop-
- ping. The specialists bewail the fact that the United States now
- ranks around 39th in the level of education in the world.
- Why do we bemoan what is so obvious? OUR EDUCATlON
- SYSTEM WAS PROGRAMMED TO SELF-DESTRUCT.
- THAT WAS WHAT DR. ALEXANDER KING WAS SENT
- HERE BY NATO TO ARRANGE. THAT IS WHAT JUSTICE
- HUGO BLACK WAS ORDERED TO ARRANGE. THE FACT
- IS, THE COMMITTEE OF 300, WITH THE APPROVAL OF
- OUR GOVERNMENT, DOES NOT WANT OUR YOUTH TO
-
- 85
-
- BE PROPERLY EDUCATED. The education that Freemason
- Justice Hugo Black, Alexander King, Gunnar Myrdal and his
- wife came to give the children of the United States is that
- CRIME PAYS, EXPEDIENCY IS WHAT COUNTS.
- They taught our children that United States law is unequally
- applied, and that is perfectly in order. Our children were properly
- educated by a decade of corrupt examples; Ronald Reagan and
- George Bush were ruled by greed and became totally corrupted
- by it. Our education system hasn't failed. Under the guidance of
- King, Black and the Myrdals it is actually a great success, but it
- all depends from whose point of view we look at it. The Com-
- mittee of 300 is DELIGHTED with our education system, and
- will not allow one comma of it to be changed.
- According to Stanford and Willis Harmon, the induced trauma
- of long range penetration of which our education is a part, has
- been going on for 45 years, yet how many are aware of the
- insidious pressures being applied to our society and the constant
- exposure to brainwashing that goes on every day? The mysterious
- gang wars that broke out in New York in the 1950's is an
- example of how the conspirators can create and stage-manage
- any type of disruptive elements they like. Where those gang
- wars came from nobody knew until the 1980's when researchers
- uncovered the hidden controllers who directed the so-called
- "social phenomena."
- Gang wars were carefully planned at Stanford, deliberately
- designed to shock society and cause ripples of disturbances. By
- 1958 there were in excess of 200 of these gangs. They were
- made popular by a musical and a Hollywood movie, "West Side
- Story." After making the news for a decade, suddenly, in 1966,
- they disappeared off the streets of New York, Los Angeles
- New York, New Jersey, Philadelphia and Chicago.
- Throughout the near decade of gang violence, the public
- reacted according to the profiled response Stanford expected;
- society as a whole could not comprehend gang warfare and the
- public responded in a maladaptive manner. Had there been
-
- 86
-
- those wise enough to recognize in gang wars a Stanford experi-
- ment in social engineering and brainwashing, the conspirator's
- plot would have been exposed. Either we did not have trained
- specialists who could see what was going on--which is highly
- unlikely--or else they were threatened and remained silent. The
- cooperation with Stanford by the news media brought to light a
- "new age" attack on our environment just as predicted by the
- social engineers and new-science scientists at Tavistock.
- In 1989 gang warfare, as a social conditioning to change,
- was reintroduced to the streets of Los Angeles. Within a few
- short months of the first incidents, gangs began to proliferate--
- first in the scores, then in the hundreds on the streets of the East
- Side of Los Angeles. Crack houses and rampant prostitution
- proliferated; drug dealers dominated the streets. Anybody who
- got in their way was gunned down. The outcry in the press was
- loud and long. Stanford's targeted large population group began
- defending itself with slogans. This is what Tavistock called the
- first phase, with the targeted group failing to identify the source
- of the crisis.
- The second phase of the gang war crisis was "fragmentation."
- People not living in the areas frequented by gangs said, "Thank
- God they are not in our neighborhood." This ignored the fact
- that the crisis continued with or without recognition and that
- social order in Los Angeles had begun to break down. As
- profiled by Tavistock, those groups not affected by gang war
- "broke away to defend themselves" because the source of the
- crisis was not identified, the so called "maladaptation" process
- the period of disassociation.
- Apart from the proliferation of drug sales, what is the purpose
- of gang wars? First, it is to show the targeted group that they are
- not safe, i.e., insecurity is generated. Secondly, it is to show that
- organized society is helpless in the face of such violence and
- thirdly to bring about a recognition of the fact that our social
- order is collapsing. The present wave of gang violence will go
- away just as quickly as it started, once the three phases of the
-
- 87
-
- Stanford program are completed.
- An outstanding example of social conditioning to accept
- change, even when it is recognized as unwelcome change by the
- large population group in the sights of Stanford Research Insti-
- tute, was the "advent" of the BEATLES. The Beatles were
- brought to the United States as part of a social experiment which
- would subject large population groups to brainwashing of which
- they were not even aware.
- When Tavistock brought the Beatles to the United States
- nobody could have imagined the cultural disaster that was to
- follow in their wake. The Beatles were an integral part of "THE
- AQUARIAN CONSPIRACY," a living organism which sprang
- From "THE CHANGING IMAGES OF MAN," URH (489)-
- 2150-Policy Research Report No. 4/4/74. Policy Report pre-
- pared by SRI Center for the study of Social Policy, Director,
- Professor Willis Harmon.
- The phenomenon of the Beatles was not a spontaneous
- rebellion by youth against the old social system. Instead it was a
- carefully crafted plot to introduce by a conspiratorial body
- which could not be identified, a highly destructive and divisive
- element into a large population group targeted for change against
- its will. New words and new phrases--prepared by Tavistock--
- were introduced to America along with the Beatles. Words such
- as "rock" in relation to music sounds, "teenager," "cool," "dis-
- covered" and "pop music" were a lexicon of disguised code
- words signifying the acceptance of drugs and arrived with and
- accompanied the Beatles wherever they went, to be "discovered"
- by "teenagers." Incidentally, the word "teenagers" was never
- used until just before the Beatles arrived on the scene, courtesy
- of the Tavistock Institute for Human Relations.
- As in the case of gang wars, nothing could or would have
- been accomplished without the cooperation of the media, espe-
- cially the electronic media and, in particular, the scurrilous Ed
- Sullivan who had been coached by the conspirators as to the role
- he was to play. Nobody would have paid much attention to the
-
- 88
-
- motley crew from Liverpool and the 12-atonal system of "music"
- that was to follow had it not been for an overabundance of press
- exposure. The 12-atonal system consisted of heavy, repetitive
- sounds, taken from the music of the cult of Dionysus and the
- Baal priesthood by Adorno and given a "modern" flavor by this
- special friend of the Queen of England and hence the Committee
- of 300.
- Tavistock and its Stanford Research Center created trigger
- words which then came into general usage around "rock music"
- and its fans. Trigger words created a distinct new break-away
- largely young population group which was persuaded by social
- engineering and conditioning to believe that the Beatles really
- were their favorite group. All trigger words devised in the
- context of "rock music" were designed for mass control of the
- new targeted group, the youth of America.
- The Beatles did a perfect job, or perhaps it would be more
- correct to say that Tavistock and Stanford did a perfect job, the
- Beatles merely reacting like trained robots "with a little help
- from their friends"--code words for using drugs and making it
- "cool." The Beatles became a highly visible "new type"--more
- Tavistock jargon--and as such it was not long before the group
- made new styles (fads in clothing, hairstyles and language
- usage) which upset the older generation, as was intended. This
- was part of the "fragmentation-maladaptation" process worked
- out by Willis Harmon and his team of social scientists and
- genetic engineering tinkerers and put into action.
- The role of the print and electronic media in our society is
- crucial to the success of brainwashing large population groups.
- Gang wars ended in Los Angeles in 1966 as the media withdrew
- its coverage. The same thing will happen with the current wave
- of gang wars in Los Angeles. Street gangs will wither on the
- vine once media saturation coverage is toned down and then
- completely withdrawn. As in 1966, the issue would become
- "burned out." Street gangs will have served their purpose of
- creating turbulence and insecurity. Exactly the same pattern will
-
- 89
-
- be followed in the case of "rock" music. Deprived of media
- attention, it will eventually take its place in history.
- Following the Beatles, who incidentally were put together
- by the Tavistock Institute, came other "Made in England" rock
- groups, who, like the Beatles, had Theo Adorno write their cult
- lyrics and compose all the "music." I hate to use these beautiful
- words in the context of "Beatlemania"; it reminds me of how
- wrongly the word "lover" is used when referring to the filthy
- interaction between two homosexuals writhing in pigswill. To
- call "rock" music, is an insult, likewise the language used in
- "rock lyrics."
- Tavistock and Stanford Research then embarked on the
- second phase of the work commissioned by the Committee of
- 300. This new phase turned up the heat for social change in
- America. As quickly as the Beatles had appeared on the American
- scene, so too did the "beat generation," trigger words designed
- to separate and fragment society. The media now focused its
- attention on the "beat generation." Other Tavistock-coined words
- came seemingly out of nowhere: "beatniks," "hippies," "flower
- children" became part of the vocabulary of America. It became
- popular to "drop out" and wear dirty jeans, go about with long
- unwashed hair. The "beat generation" cut itself off from main-
- stream America. They became just as infamous as the cleaner
- Beatles before them.
- The newly-created group and its "lifestyle" swept millions
- of young Americans into the cult. American youth underwent a
- radical revolution without ever being aware of it, while the older
- generation stood by helplessly, unable to identify the source of
- the crisis, and thus reacting in a maladaptive manner against its
- manifestation, which were drugs of all types, marijuana, and
- later Lysergic acid, "LSD," so conveniently provided for them
- by the Swiss pharmaceutical company, SANDOZ, following the
- discovery by one of its chemists, Albert Hoffman, how to make
- synthetic ergotamine, a powerful mind-altering drug. The
- Committee of 300 financed the project through one of their
-
- 90
-
- banks, S. C. Warburg, and the drug was carried to America by
- the philosopher, Aldous Huxley.
- The new "wonder drug" was promptly distributed in "sample"
- size packages, handed out free of charge on college campuses
- across the United States and at "rock" concerts, which became the
- leading vehicle for proliferating the use of drugs. The question
- that cries out for an answer is, what was the Drug Enforcement
- Agency (DEA) doing at the time? There is compelling circum-
- stantial evidence that would appear to indicate that the DEA knew
- what was going on but was ordered not to take any action.
- With very substantial numbers of new British "rock" bands
- arriving in the U.S., rock concerts began to become a fixture on
- the social calender of American youth. In tandem with these
- "concerts," the use of drugs among the youth rose in proportion.
- The devilish bedlam of discordant heavy beat sounds numbed
- the minds of listeners so that they were easily persuaded to try
- the new drug on the basis that "everybody is doing it." Peer
- pressure is a very strong weapon. The "new culture" received
- maximum coverage from the jackal media, which cost the con-
- spirators not one single thin dime.
- Great anger was felt by a number of civic leaders and
- churchmen over the new cult but their energies were misdirected
- against the RESULT of what was going on and not against the
- CAUSE. Critics of the rock cult made the same mistakes that had
- been made in the prohibition era, they criticized law enforce-
- ment agencies, teachers, parents anybody but the conspirators.
- Because of the anger and resentment I feel toward the great
- drug plague, I make no apology for using language which is not
- customary for me to use. One of the worst drug slobs ever to
- walk the streets of America was Alan Ginsberg. This Ginsberg
- pushed the use of LSD through advertising which cost him
- nothing, although under normal circumstances it would have
- cost millions of dollars in TV advertising revenues. This free
- advertising for drugs, and LSD in particular, reached a new high
- in the late 1960's, thanks to the ever-willing cooperation of the
-
- 91
-
- media. The effect of Ginsberg's mass advertising campaign was
- devastating; the American public was subjected to one cultural
- future shock after another in rapid succession.
- We became over-exposed and over stimulated and, again,
- may I remind you that this is Tavistock jargon, lifted from the
- Tavistock training manual, overwhelmed by its new develop-
- ment and, when we reached that point, our minds began to lapse
- into apathy; it was just too much to cope with, that is to say,
- "long range penetration had taken hold of us." Ginsberg claimed
- to be a poet but no greater rubbish was ever written by anyone
- who ever aspired to becoming a poet. Ginsberg's designated
- task had little to do with poetry; his main function was to push
- the new subculture and force acceptance of it upon the large
- targeted population group.
- To assist him in his task, Ginsberg coopted the services of
- Norman Mailer, a writer of sorts who had spent some time in a
- mental institution. Mailer was a favorite of the leftwing Holly-
- wood crowd and so had no problem with getting maximum
- television time for Ginsberg. Naturally Mailer had to have a
- pretext--not even he could blatantly come out with the true
- nature of Ginsberg's television appearances. So a charade was
- adopted: Mailer would talk "seriously" on camera with Ginsberg
- about poetry and literature.
- This method of getting wide television coverage at no cost
- to themselves was followed by every rock group and concert
- promoter who followed the example set by Ginsberg. The elec-
- tronic media moguls had big hearts when it came to giving free
- time to these dirty verminous creatures and their even dirtier
- products and filthy ideas. Their promotion of horrible garbage
- spoke volumes and, without abundant help from the print and
- electronic media, the drug trade could not have spread as rapidly
- as it did in the late 1960's-early 197O's, and probably would
- have been confined to a few small local areas.
- Ginsberg was able to give several nationally televised per-
- formances extolling the virtues of LSD and marijuana, under
-
- 92
-
- the guise of "new ideas" and "new cultures" developing in the
- art and music world. Not to be outdone by the electronic media,
- Ginsberg's admirers wrote glowing articles about "this colorful
- man" in the art and social columns of all of America,s largest
- newspapers and magazines. There had never been such an across-
- the-media-board free advertising campaign in the history of
- newspaper, radio and television and it cost the promoters of the
- Aquarian conspiracy, NATO and the Club of Rome not one red
- cent. It was all absolutely free advertising for LSD, only thinly
- disguised as "art" and "culture."
- One of Ginsberg's closest friends, Kenny Love, published a
- Five-page report in the New York Times. This is in accordance
- with the methodology used by Tavistock and Stanford Re-
- search: If something is to be promoted which the public has not
- yet been fully brainwashed to accept, then have someone write
- an article, covering all sides of the subject matter. The other
- method is to have live television talk shows in which a panel of
- experts promotes the product and or idea under the pretext of
- "discussing", it. There are point and counter-point, both pro and
- con participants airing their support or opposition. When it is all
- over, the subject to be promoted has been dinned into the public
- mind. While this was new in the early 1970's, today it is
- standard practice on which talk shows thrive.
- Love's Five-page pro LSD pro Ginsberg article was duly
- printed by the New York Times. Had Ginsberg tried to buy the
- same amount of space in an advertisement, it would have cost
- him at least $50,000. But Ginsberg didn't have to worry; thanks
- to his Friend Kenny Love, Ginsberg got the massive advertising
- all for free. With newspapers like the New York Times and the
- Washington Post under the control of the Committee of 300, this
- kind of free advertising is given to any subject matter, and more
- especially to those promoting decadent life styles--drugs-hedo-
- nism--anything that will confuse the American people. After
- the trial run with Ginsberg and LSD, it became standard Club of
- Rome practice to call upon major newspapers in America to
-
- 93
-
- give free advertising on demand to people and ideas they were
- promoting.
- Worse yet--or better yet, depending upon the viewpoint--
- United Press (UP) picked up Kenny Love's free advertising for
- Ginsberg and LSD and telexed it to HUNDREDS of newspa-
- pers and magazines around the country under the guise of a
- "news" story. Even such highly respectable establishment
- magazines as "Harpers Bazaar" and "TIME" made Mr. Ginsberg
- respectable. If a nation-wide campaign of this magnitude were
- presented to Ginsberg and the promoters of LSD by an advertising
- agency, the price tag would have run into at least $1 million in
- terms of 1970 dollars. Today the price tag would be nothing less
- than $15-$16 million dollars. It is no wonder that I refer to the
- news media as "jackals."
- I suggest that we try to find any media outlet to do an expose
- on the Federal Reserve Board, which is what I did. I took my
- article, which was a good expose of the greatest swindle on
- earth, to every major newspaper, radio and television station,
- magazine house and several talk-show hosts. A few made
- promises that sounded good--they would definitely air the
- article and have me discuss it--give them about a week and they
- would get back to me. Not one of them ever did, nor did my
- article ever appear in the pages of their newspapers and journals.
- It was as if a blanket of silence had been thrown over me and the
- subject I was endeavoring to promote, and indeed that was
- precisely what had happened.
- Without massive media hype, and without almost around
- the clock coverage, the hippy-beatnik rock, drug cult would
- never have gotten off the ground; it would have remained a
- localized oddity. The Beatles, with their twanging guitars, silly
- expressions, drug language and weird clothes, would not have
- amounted to a hill of beans. Instead, because the Beatles were
- given saturation coverage by the media, the United States has
- suffered one cultural shock after another.
- The men buried in the think tanks and research institutions,
-
- 94
-
- whose names and faces are still not known to but a few people,
- made sure that the press played its part. Conversely, the media's
- important role in not exposing the power behind the future
- cultural shocks made certain that the source of the crisis was
- never identified. Thus was our society driven mad through
- psychological shocks and stress. "Driven mad" is taken from
- Tavistock's training manual. From its modest beginnings in
- 1921, Tavistock was ready in 1966 to launch a major irrevers-
- ible cultural revolution in America, which has not yet ended.
- The Aquarian Conspiracy is part of it.
- Thus softened up, our nation was now deemed ripe for the
- introduction of drugs which was to rival the prohibition era in
- scope and the huge amounts of money to be made. This too was
- an integral part of the Aquarian Conspiracy. The proliferation of
- drug usage was one of the subjects under study at the Science
- Policy Research Unit (SPRU) at Tavistock's Sussex University
- facility. It was known as the "future shocks" center, a title given
- to so-called future oriented psychology designed to manipulate
- whole population groups to induce "future shocks." It was the
- first of several such institutions set up by Tavistock.
- "Future shocks" is described as a series of events which
- come so fast that the human brain cannot absorb the information.
- As I said earlier, science has shown that there are clearly marked
- limits to the amount of changes and the nature of them that the
- mind can deal with. After continuous shocks, the large targeted
- population group discovers that it does not want to make choices
- any more. Apathy takes over, often preceded by mindless violence
- such as is characteristic of the Los Angeles street gangs, serial
- killers, rapists and child kidnapers.
- Such a group becomes easy to control and will docilely
- follow orders without rebelling, which is the object of the
- exercise. "Future shocks," says SPRU, "is defined as physical
- and psychological distress arising from the excess load on the
- decision-making mechanism of the human mind." That is
- Tavistock jargon lifted straight from Tavistock manuals--which
-
- 95
-
- they don't know I have.
- Just as an overloaded electrical circuit will activate a trip
- switch, so do humans "trip out," which is a syndrome that
- medical science is only now beginning to understand, although
- John Rawlings Reese conducted experiments in this field as far
- back as the 1920's. As can be appreciated, such a targeted group
- is ready to "trip out" and take to drugs as a means of escape from
- the pressures of so many choices having to be made. This is how
- Drug usage was spread so rapidly through America's "beat
- generation." What started with the Beatles and sample packages
- of LSD has grown into a flood-tide of drug usage which is
- swamping America.
- The drug trade is controlled by the Committee of 300 from
- the Top down. The drug trade started with the British East India
- Company and was closely followed by the Dutch East India
- Company. Both were controlled by a "Council of 300." The list
- of names of members and stockholders of the BEIC read like
- something out of Debretts Peerage. BEIC established the "China
- Inland Mission," whose job it was to get The Chinese peasants,
- or coolies, as they were called, addicted to opium. This created
- the market for opium which the BEIC then filled.
- In much the same way the Committee of 300 used "The
- "Beatles" to popularize "social drugs" with the youth of America
- and The Hollywood "in-crowd." Ed Sullivan was sent to England
- To become acquainted with The first Tavistock Institute "rock
- group" to hit the shores of the United States. Sullivan then
- returned to the United States to draft the strategy for the electronic
- media on how to package and sell the group. Without the full
- cooperation of the electronic media and Ed Sullivan, in particular,
- "The Beatles" and their "music" would have died on the vine.
- Instead, our national life and the character of the United States
- was forever changed.
- Now that we know, it is all too clear how successful the
- "Beatles" campaign to proliferate the use of drugs became. The
- fact that "The Beatles" had their music and lyrics written for
-
- 96
-
- them by Theo Adorno was concealed from public view. The
- prime function to "The Beatles" was to be discovered by teen-
- agers, who where then subjected to a non-stop barrage of
- "Beatle music," until they became convinced that they liked the
- sound and adopted it, along with all that accompanied it. The
- Liverpool group performed up to expectations, and with "a little
- help from their friends," i.e., illegal substances we call drugs
- created a whole new class to young Americans in the precise
- mold ordained by the Tavistock Institute.
- Tavistock had created a highly visible "new type" to act as
- their drug-runners. The China Inland Mission "Christian mis-
- sionaries" would not have fitted in with the 1960's. "New type"
- is social-science scientist jargon; what it meant was that the
- Beatles created new social patterns, first and foremost being to
- normalize and popularize the use of drugs, new tastes in clothes
- and hair styles which really distinguished them from the older
- generation as was intended by Tavistock.
- It is important to note the deliberate fragmentation-inducing
- language used by Tavistock. The "teenagers" never once dreamed
- that all the "different" things they aspired to were the product
- of older scientists working in think tanks in England and Stanford
- Research. How mortified they would have been if they had
- discovered that most of their "cool" habits and expressions were
- deliberately created for their use by a group of older social
- science scientists!
- The role of the media was, and remains, very important in
- promoting the use of drugs on a nation-wide scale. When cov-
- erage of the street warfare gangs was abruptly terminated by the
- media, they became "burned out" as a social phenomena; the
- "new age" of drugs followed. The media has always served as a
- catalyst and has always pushed "new causes" and now media
- attention was focused on drug usage and its supporters, the
- "beat generation," yet another phrase fashioned at Tavistock, in
- its determined efforts to bring about social changes in The
- United States.
-
- 97
-
- Drug usage now became an accepted part of everyday life in
- America. This Tavistock-designed program took in millions of
- American youth, and the older generation began to believe that
- America was undergoing a natural social revolution, failing all
- the while to realize that what was happening to their children
- was not a spontaneous movement, but a highly artificial creation
- designed to force changes in America's social and political life.
- The descendants of the British East India Company were
- delighted with the success of their drug pushing program. Their
- disciples became adept in the use of lysergic acid (LSD) so
- conveniently made available by patrons of the drug trade like
- Aldous Huxley, courtesy of the highly respected Sandoz company
- of Switzerland and financed by the great Warburg banking
- dynasty. The new "wonder drug" was promptly distributed at all
- rock concerts and on college campuses in free sample packages.
- The question that begs to be asked is, "What was the FBI doing
- while all this was going on?"
- The purpose of the Beatles had become abundantly clear.
- The British East India Company's descendants in the upper-
- class society in London must have felt very good about the
- billions of dollars that began rolling in. With the coming of
- "rock" which shall henceforth be used as shorthand to describe
- Adorno's fiendish satanic music, a tremendous increase in the
- use of social drugs, especially marijuana, was observed. The
- entire dope business was expanded under the control and direction
- of the Science Policy Research Unit (SPRU).
- SPRU was run by Leland Bradford, Kenneth Damm and
- Ronald Lippert, under whose expert guidance a large number of
- new-science scientists were trained to promote "future shocks,"
- one of the chief being the dramatic increase in the use of drugs
- by America's teenagers. SPRU's policy papers, planted in vari-
- ous government agencies, including the Drug Enforcement
- Agency (DEA), dictated the course of the disastrous "drug war"
- allegedly waged by the Reagan and Bush Administrations.
- This was the forerunner of how the United States is run
-
- 98
-
- today, by one committee and/or council after another, by an
- inner-government fed on Tavistock papers which they firmly
- believe are their own opinions. These virtual unknowns are
- making decisions that will forever change our form of govern-
- ment and the quality of life here in the United States. Through
- "crisis adaptation" we have already been changed so much as to
- barely compare with what we were in the 1950's. Also, our
- environment has been changed.
- There is much talk about environment these days and, while
- it mostly refers to green surroundings, pure rivers and fresh air,
- there is another, equally important environment, namely, the
- drug environment. The environment of our life style has become
- polluted; our thinking has become polluted. Our ability to con-
- trol our destiny has become polluted. We are confronted by
- changes that pollute our thinking to the extent that we do not
- know what to make of it all. The "Environment of Change" is
- crippling the nation; we appear to have so little control that it
- has produced anxiety and confusion.
- We now look to group solutions instead of individual solu-
- tions to our problems. We do not make use of our own resources
- to solve problems. In this the prolific rise in drug usage is playing
- a leading role. The strategy is a deliberate one, devised by the
- new-science scientists, the social engineers and tinkerers, aimed
- at the most vulnerable of all areas, our self-image, or how we
- perceive ourselves, which leads us eventually to become like
- sheep being led to the slaughter. We have become confused by the
- many choices we have to make, and we have become apathetic.
- We are manipulated by unscrupulous men without ever
- being aware of it. This is particularly true of the drug trade and
- we are now in the transition stage where we can be set up for a
- change from the present constitutional form of government,
- which has taken a giant step forward under the Bush administra-
- tion. While there are those who still persist, in the face of all of
- the evidence to the contrary in saying, "It can't happen in
- America," the fact is: IT HAS ALREADY HAPPENED. Our
-
- 99
-
- will to resist events not to our liking has been steadily eroded
- and undermined. We will resist, some of us say, but not so many
- of us will do that, and we will be in the minority.
- The drug trade has insidiously changed our environment.
- The alleged "war on drugs" is a farce; it does not exist in
- qualitative measure to make the slightest difference to the de-
- scendants of the British East India Company. Combined with
- computerization, we are almost fully brainwashed, robbed of
- our ability to resist forced changes. Which brings us to another
- environment, PEOPLE CONTROL, also known as personal
- information control, without which governments cannot play
- their numbers game.
- As matters stand, we the people have absolutely no way of
- knowing just what government does or does not know about us.
- Government computer files are not subject to scrutiny by the public
- at large. Do we foolishly believe that personal information
- sacrosanct? Remember, in every society there are rich and power-
- ful families who control law enforcement agencies. I have proved
- the existence of such families. Do not think that if these families
- wanted to find out about us, they could not do so. These are the
- families who often have a member in the Committee of 300.
- Take Kissinger, for instance, who has his own private dos-
- siers on hundreds of thousands of people, not only in the U.S.
- but all over the world. Are we on Kissinger's enemy list? Is this
- far fetched? Not at all. Take P2 Masonic and Committee Monte
- Carlo who have such lists which run into tens of thousands of
- names. Incidentally, Kissinger is one of them. There are other
- "private" intelligence agencies, such as INTEL, whom we shall
- meet later.
- One of the ways heroin is moved into Europe is through the
- Principality of Monaco. The heroin comes from Corsica carried
- in ferries that ply a busy trade between Corsica and Monte Carlo
- during the summer. There is no check of what goes on or comes
- off these ferries. As there is no border between France and
- Monaco, drugs, and more especially heroin (partly processed
-
- 100
-
- opium), flows through the open border of Monaco into laborato-
- ries in France, or else if it has already been processed into
- heroin, it goes directly to the distributors.
- The Grimaldi family has been in the drug smuggling busi-
- ness for centuries. Because Prince Ranier got greedy and began
- skimming heavily and would not desist after three warnings, his
- wife, Princess Grace, was murdered in a car "accident." Ranier
- underestimated the power of the Committee of which he is a
- member. The Rover car in which she was traveling had the
- brake fluid chambers tampered with in such a way that each
- time the brakes were depressed, fluid was released in measured
- amount, until by the time the car reached the most dangerous of
- several hairpin bends, there was no stopping power, and it sailed
- over a stone wall, hitting the ground fifty feet below in a
- sickening smash.
- Everything possible was done by the Committee of 300
- operatives to conceal the truth about the murder of Princess
- Grace. To this day the Rover car remains in the custody of
- French police, shrouded under a cover on a trailer which no one
- is allowed to approach, let alone examine. The signal for the
- execution of Princess Grace was picked up by the British Army
- listening post in Cyprus and it is believed by well placed source
- that the Committee Monte Carlo and P2 gave the order.
- The drug trade, controlled by the Committee of 300, is a
- crime against humanity, but having been conditioned and softened
- up by years of incessant bombardment by Tavistock Institute,
- we have more or less accepted our changed environment, re-
- garding the drug trade as a problem that is "too big" to handle.
- This is not the case. If we could marshal an entire nation, equip
- and send millions of American soldiers to fight in a war in
- Europe in which he had no business intervening, if we could
- defeat a major power, then we can smash the drug trade, using
- the same WW II tactics.
- The logistical problems that had to be solved when we
- entered the Second World War are even today still mind-boggling.
-
- 101
-
-
- <<<<< cont in Committee of 300 - Part 5 >>>>>
-
-
- --
- <*> Don Allen <*> 1:363/81.1 - Fidonet #1 - Homebody BBS
- dona@bilver.uucp - Internet 1:363/29.8 - Fidonet #2 - Gourmet Delight
- 88:4205/1.1 - MUFON Network 1:3607/20.2 -- Odyssey - Alabama UFO Net
- NSA grep food: Aviary, Ed Dames, Los Alamos - Majestic - Jason - RIIA - UN
-
- Path: igor.rutgers.edu!rutgers!sun-barr!cs.utexas.edu!uunet!peora!tarpit!tous!bilver!dona
- From: dona@bilver.uucp (Don Allen)
- Newsgroups: alt.conspiracy
- Subject: FILE: Committee of 300 - Part 5
- Message-ID: <1992Nov15.195028.27028@bilver.uucp>
- Date: 15 Nov 92 19:50:28 GMT
- Organization: W. J. Vermillion - Winter Park, FL
- Lines: 1017
-
-
- --- Committee of 300 - Part 5 ----------------------------------------
-
-
- Copyright (C) 1992 by Dr. John Coleman
-
- "Conspirators' Hierarchy: The Story of the Committee of 300", by
- Dr. John Coleman, is reproduced here with the permission of the
- publisher: America West Publishers.
-
- INSTITUTIONS THROUGH WHICH
-
- CONTROL IS EXERCISED
- (Cont.)
-
- Yet we successfully overcame all problems. Why then is it
- impossible to defeat a well-defined enemy, far smaller and
- weaker than Germany, given the immensely improved weapons
- and surveillance equipment we have today? The real reason that
- the drug problem is not eradicated is because it is being run by
- the highest families in the entire world as part of a coordinated
- gigantic money-making machine.
- In 1930, British capital invested in South America greatly
- exceeded capital investment in British "dominions." Graham, an
- authority on British investments abroad, stated that British in-
- vestment in South America "exceeded one trillion pounds."
- Remember, this was 1930, and one trillion pounds was a stagger-
- ing sum of money in those days. What was the reason for such
- heavy investment in South America? In a word it was drugs.
- The plutocracy controlling British banks held the purse
- strings and then, as now, put up a most respectable facade to
- cover their true business. No one ever caught them with dirtied
- hands. They always had front men, even as they do today,
- willing to take the blame if things went awry. Then as now the
- connections with the drug trade were tenuous at best. No one
- was ever able to lay a finger on the respectable and "noble"
- banking families of Britain, whose members are on the Com-
- mittee of 300.
- There is great significance in that only 15 members of
- Parliament were the controllers of that vast empire, of which the
- most prominent were Sir Charles Barry and the Chamberlain
- family. These overlords of finance were busy in places like
- Argentina, Jamaica and Trinidad, which became big money-
- spinners for them through the drug trade. In these countries,
- British plutocrats kept "the locals" as they were contemptuously
- called, at bare subsistence levels, hardly above slavery. The
- fortunes extracted from the drug trade in the Caribbean were vast.
- The plutocrats hid behind faces like Trinidad Leaseholds
- Limited, but the REAL MEAT, then as now, was drugs. This is
- true of today where we find that Jamaica's Gross National
-
- 102
-
- Product (GNP) is made up almost entirely of sales of ganja, a
- very potent form of marijuana. The mechanism for handling the
- ganja trade was set up by David Rockefeller and Henry Kissinger
- under the title "Caribbean Basin Initiative."
- Up until a relatively short time ago, the true history of the
- China opium trade was quite unknown, having been as well
- covered up as it is possible to do. Many of my former students
- in the days when I was lecturing, would come and ask me why
- the Chinese were so fond of smoking opium? They were puzzled
- as are many still today, over contradictory accounts of what had
- actually taken place in China. Most thought it was merely a case
- of the Chinese workers buying opium on an open market and
- smoking it, or going to some of the thousands of opium dens and
- forgetting their terrible existence for a while.
- The truth is that the supply of opium to China was a British
- monopoly, an OFFICIAL monopoly of the British government
- and official British policy. The Indo-British opium trade in
- China was one of the best kept secrets, around which many
- misleading legends grew up, such as "Clive of India" and the
- tales of derring-do by the British Army in India for the glory of
- "the Empire," so well written by Rudyard Kipling, and tales of
- "Tea Clippers" racing across the oceans with their cargoes of
- China tea for the high society drawing rooms of Victorian
- England. In reality, the history of British occupation of India
- and Britain's Opium Wars are some of the most dastardly blots
- on Western civilization.
- Almost 13% of the income of India under British rule was
- derived from the sale of good quality Bengal opium to the
- British-run opium distributors in China. "The Beatles" of the
- day, the China Inland Mission, had done a great job in prolifer-
- ating the use of opium among the poor Chinese laborers (coolies,
- as they were called). These addicts did not suddenly materialize
- out of thin air, any more than did teenager addicts in the U.S.
- THE POINT TO REMEMBER IS THAT BOTH WERE CRE-
- ATED. In China a market for opium was first created and then
-
- 103
-
- filled by opium for Bengal. In the same way, a market for
- marijuana and LSD was first created in the United States by
- methods already described, and then filled by British plutocrats
- and their American cousins with the help of the overlords of the
- British banking establishment.
- The lucrative drug trade is one of the worst examples of
- making money out of human misery; the other being the legal
- drug trade run by the pharmaceutical drug houses under
- Rockefeller ownership, in the U.S. for the most part, but with
- substantial companies operating in Switzerland, France and
- Britain and fully backed by the American Medical Association
- (AMA). The dirty dope transactions and the money it generates
- flows through the City of London, together with Hong Kong,
- Dubai and latterly, Lebanon, thanks to the invasion of that
- country by Israel.
- There will be those who doubt this statement. "Look at this
- business columns of the Financial Times," they will tell us. "Don't
- tell me that this is all related to drug money"? OF COURSE IT
- IS, but don't imagine for one minute that the noble lords and
- ladies of England are going to advertise the fact. Remember the
- British East India Company? Officially, its business was trading
- in tea!
- The London "Times" never dared tell the British public the
- it was impossible to make VAST PROFITS from tea, nor did the
- illustrious paper even hint at a trade in opium being plied by those
- who spent their time in London's fashionable clubs or playing a
- chukka of polo at the Royal Windsor Club, or that the gentlemen
- officers who went out to India in the service of the Empire were
- financed SOLELY by the enormous income derived from the
- misery of the millions of Chinese coolies addicted to opium.
- The trade was conducted by the illustrious British East India
- Company, whose meddling in political, religious and economic
- affairs of the United States has cost us very dearly for over 200
- years. The 300 members of the British East India Company's
- board were a cut above the common herd. They were so mighty,
-
- 104
-
- as Lord Bertrand Russell once observed, "They could even give
- God advice when he had trouble in Heaven." Nor should we
- imagine that anything has changed in the intervening years.
- EXACTLY the same attitude prevails today among members of
- the Committee of 300, which is why they often refer to them-
- selves as the "Olympians."
- Later the British Crown, i.e., the Royal Family, joined the
- British East India Company's trade, and used it as a vehicle to
- produce opium in Bengal, and elsewhere in India, controlling
- exports through what was called "transit duties," that is, the
- Crown levied a tax on all producers of opium duly registered
- with the state authority, who were sending their opium to China.
- Prior to 1896, when the trade was still "illegal"--a word
- used to extract greater tribute from the producers of opium--
- there never having been the slightest attempt to stop the trade,
- colossal amounts of opium were shipped out of India on board
- "China Tea Clippers," those sailing ships around which legend
- and lore were built, which supposedly carried chests of tea from
- India and China to the London exchanges.
- So audacious did the British East India Company lords and
- ladies become that they tried to sell this lethal substance to the
- Union and Confederate Armies in pill form as a pain killer. Is it
- difficult to imagine just what would have happened had their
- plan succeeded? All those hundreds of thousands of soldiers
- would have left the battlefields totally hooked on opium. "The
- Beatles" were much more successful in turning out millions of
- teenage addicts in later years.
- The Bengal merchants and their British controllers and
- bankers grew fat and intolerant on the enormous amounts of
- money that poured into the coffers of the British East India
- Company from the wretched Chinese coolies opium trade. BEIC
- profits, even in those years, far exceeded the combined profits
- made in a single year by General Motors, Ford and Chrysler in
- their heydays. The trend in making huge profits out of drugs was
- carried over into the 1960's by such "legal" drug death mer-
-
- 105
-
- chants as Sandoz, the makers of LSD and Hoffman la Roche,
- manufacturers of Valium. The cost of the raw material and
- manufacturing of Valium to Hoffman la Roche is $3 per kilo
- (2.2 pounds). It is sold to their distributors for $20,000 per kilo.
- By the time it reaches the consumer, the price of Valium has
- risen to $50,000 per kilo. Valium is used in huge quantities in
- Europe and the United States. It is possibly the most used drug
- of its kind in the world.
- Hoffman la Roche does the same thing with Vitamin C,
- which costs them less than 1 cent a kilo to produce. It is sold for
- a profit of 10,000 percent. When a friend of mine blew the
- whistle on this criminal company, which had entered into a
- monopoly agreement with other producers, in contravention of
- European Economic Community laws, he was arrested on the
- Swiss-Italian border and hustled into prison; his wife was
- threatened by the Swiss police until she committed suicide. As a
- British national he was rescued by the British consul in Berne as
- soon as word of his plight was received, removed from prison
- and flown out of the country. He lost his wife, his job and his
- pension because he dared to disclose Hoffman La Roche secrets.
- The Swiss take their Industrial Espionage law very seriously.
- Remember this the next time you see those lovely advertise-
- ments of Swiss ski slopes, beautiful watches, pristine mountains
- and cuckoo clocks. That is not what Switzerland is about. It is
- about dirty multi-billion dollar money laundering which is car-
- ried out by major Swiss banking houses. It is about the Committee
- of 300 "legal" drug manufacturers. Switzerland is the
- Committee's ultimate "safe haven" for money and protection of
- their bodies in time of global calamity.
- Now mind you, one could get into serious trouble with the
- Swiss authorities for giving out any information on these ne-
- farious activities. The Swiss regard it as "industrial espionage"
- which usually carries a 5-year term in prison. It is safer to
- pretend that Switzerland is a nice clean country rather than look
- under the covers or inside its garbage can banks.
-
- 106
-
- In 1931 the managing directors of the so-called "big Five"
- British companies were rewarded by being made Peers of the
- Realm for their activities in drug money laundering. Who decided
- such matters and bestows such honors? It is the Queen of
- England who bestows honors upon the men in the top positions
- in the drug trade. British banks engaged in this terrible trade are
- too numerous to mention, but a few of the top ones are:
- The British Bank of the Middle East.
- Midland Bank.
- National and Westminster Bank.
- Barclays Bank.
- Royal Bank of Canada.
- Hong Kong and Shanghai Bank.
- Baring Brothers Bank.
- Many of the merchant banks are up to their hocks in pigswill
- drug trade profits, banks such as Hambros for example, run by
- Sir Jocelyn Hambro. For a really interesting major study of the
- Chinese opium trade, one would need access to India Office in
- London. I was able to get in there because of my intelligence
- service and received great assistance from the trustee of the
- papers of the late Professor Frederick Wells Williamson, which
- provided much information on the opium trade carried on by the
- British East India Company in India and China in the 18th and
- 19th centuries. If only those papers could be made public, what a
- storm would burst over the heads of the crowned vipers of Europe.
- Today the trade has shifted somewhat in that less expensive
- cocaine has taken over a good part of the North American
- market. In the 1960's the flood of heroin coming from Hong
- Kong, Lebanon and Dubai threatened to engulf the United
- States and Western Europe. When demand outpaced supply
- there was a switch to cocaine. But now, at the end of 1991, that
- trend has been reversed; today it is heroin that is back in favor,
- although it is true that cocaine still enjoys great favor among the
- poorer classes.
- Heroin, we are told, is more satisfying to addicts; the effects
-
- 107
-
- are far more intense and last longer than the effects of cocaine
- and there is less international attention on heroin producers than
- there is on Colombian cocaine shippers. Besides which, it is
- hardly likely that the U.S. would make any real effort to stop the
- production of opium in the Golden Triangle which is under the
- control of the Chinese military, a serious war would erupt if any
- country tried to interdict the trade. A serious attack on the opium
- trade would bring Chinese military intervention.
- The British know this; they have no quarrel with China,
- except for an occasional squabble over who gets the larger share
- of the pie. Britain has been involved in the China opium trade
- for over two centuries. No one is going to be so foolish as to
- rock the boat when millions upon millions of dollars flow into
- the bank accounts of the British oligarchists and more gold is
- traded on the Hong Kong gold market than the combined total
- traded in London and New York.
- Those individuals who fondly imagine they can do some
- kind of a deal with a minor Chinese or Burmese overlord in the
- hills of the Golden Triangle apparently have no idea of what is
- involved. If they had known, they would never have talked
- about stopping the opium trade. Such talk reveals little knowl-
- edge of the immensity and complexity of China's opium trade,
- British plutocrats, the Russian KGB, the CIA, and U.S.
- bankers are all in league with China. Could one man stop or
- even make a small dent in the trade? It would be absurd to
- imagine it. What is heroin and why is it favored over cocaine
- these days? According to the noted authority on the subject
- Professor Galen, heroin is a derivative of opium, a drug that
- stupefies the senses and induces long periods of sleep. This is
- what most addicts like, it is called "being in the arms of
- Morpheus." Opium is the most habit-forming drug known to
- man. Many pharmaceutical drugs contain opium in various
- degrees, and it is believed that paper used in the manufacture of
- cigarettes is first impregnated with opium, which is why smok-
- ers become so addicted to their habit.
-
- 108
-
- The poppy seed from which it is derived was long known to
- the Moguls of India, who used the seeds mixed in tea offered to
- a difficult opponent. It is also used as a pain-killing drug which
- largely replaced chloroform and other older anesthetics of a
- bygone era. Opium was popular in all of the fashionable clubs of
- Victorian London and it was no secret that men like the Huxley
- brothers used it extensively. Members of the Orphic-Dionysus
- cults of Hellenic Greece and the Osiris-Horus cults of Ptolemaic
- Egypt which Victorian society embraced, all smoked opium; it
- was the "in" thing to do.
- So did some of those who met at St. Ermins Hotel in 1903 to
- decide what sort of a world we would have. The descendants of
- the St. Ermins crowd are found today in the Committee of 300.
- It is these so-called world leaders who brought about such a
- change in our environment that enabled drug usage to prolifer-
- ate to the point where it can no longer be stopped by regular law
- enforcement tactics and policies. This is especially true in big cities
- where big populations can conceal a great deal of what transpires.
- Many in the circles of royalty were regular opium users. One
- of their favorites was the writer Coudenhove-Kalergi who wrote
- a book in 1932 entitled "REVOLUTION THROUGH TECH-
- NOLOGY which was a blueprint for the return of the world to
- a medieval society. The book, in fact, became a working paper for
- the Committee of 300's plan to deindustrialize the world, starting
- with the United States. Claiming that pressures of over-population
- are a serious problem, Kalergi advised a return to what he called
- "open spaces." Does this sound like the Khmer Rouge and Pol
- Pot? Here are some extracts from the book:
-
- "In its facilities, the city of the future will resemble
- the city of the Middle Ages...and he who is not con-
- demned to live in a city because of his occupation, will
- go to the countryside. Our civilization is a culture of the
- major cities; therefore it is a marsh plant, born by de-
- generated, sickly and decadent people, who have vol-
-
- 109
-
- untarily, or involuntarily, ended up in this dead-end
- street of life." Isn't that very close to what "AnkarWat"
- gave as "his" reasons for depopulating Phnom Penh?
-
- The first opium shipments reached England from Bengal in
- 1683, carried in British East India Company "Tea Clippers."
- Opium was brought to England as a test, an experiment, to see
- whether the common folk of England, the yeomen and the lower
- classes, could be induced into taking the drug. It was what we
- could call today "test marketing" of a new product. But the
- sturdy yeomen and the much derided "lower classes" were
- made of stern stuff, and the test marketing experiment was a
- total flop. The "lower classes" of British society firmly rejected
- opium smoking.
- The plutocrats and oligarchists in high society in London
- began casting about for a market that would not be so resistant,
- so unbending. They found such a market in China. In the papers
- I studied at the India Office under the heading "Miscellaneous
- Old Records," I found all the confirmation I could have wished
- for in proving that the opium trade in China really took off
- following the founding of the British East India Company-
- funded "China Inland Mission," ostensibly a Christian missionary
- society but in reality the "promotion" men and women for the
- new product being introduced into the market, that new product
- being OPIUM.
- This was later confirmed when I was given access to the
- papers of Sir George Birdwood in India Office records. Soon
- after the China Inland Mission missionaries set out to give away
- their sample packages and show the coolies how to smoke
- opium, vast quantities of opium began to arrive in China. "The
- Beatles" could not have done a better job. (In both cases the
- trade was sanctioned by the British royal family, who openly
- supported the Beatles.) Where the British East India Company
- had failed in England, it now succeeded beyond its wildest
- expectations in China, whose teeming millions of poor looked
-
- 110
-
- upon smoking opium as an escape from their life of misery.
- Opium dens began proliferating all across China, and in the
- big cities like Shanghai and Canton, hundreds of thousands of
- miserable Chinese found that a pipe of opium seemingly made
- life bearable. The British East India Company had a clear run
- for over a 100 years before the Chinese government woke up to
- what was happening. It was only in 1729 that the first laws
- against opium smoking were passed. The 300 board members of
- BEIC did not like it one bit and, never one to back down, the
- company was soon engaged in a running battle with the Chi-
- nese government.
- The BEIC had developed poppy seeds that brought the
- finest quality opium from the poppy fields of Benares and Bihar
- in the Ganges Basin in India, a country they fully controlled
- this fetched top price, while the lower grades of opium from
- other areas of India were sold for less. Not about to lose their
- lucrative market, the British Crown engaged in running battles
- with Chinese forces, and defeated them. In the same manner, the
- U.S. government is supposedly fighting a running battle against
- today's drug barons and, like the Chinese, are losing heavily.
- There is however one big difference: The Chinese government
- fought to win whereas the United States government is under no
- compunction to win the battle which explains why staff turnover
- n the Drug Enforcement Agency (DEA) is so high.
- Latterly, high grade quality opium has come out of Pakistan
- via Makra on the desolate coastline of the country from whence
- ships take the cargo to Dubai where it is exchanged for gold.
- This is said to account in part for heroin being favored over
- cocaine today. The heroin trade is more discreet, there is no
- murder of prominent officials such as became an almost daily
- occurrence in Colombia. Pakistani opium does not sell for as
- much as Golden Triangle or Golden Crescent (Iranian ) opium.
- This has greatly spurred heroin production and sales which
- threaten to overtake cocaine as the number one seller.
- The vile opium trade was talked about in the upper-crust
-
- 111
-
- circles of English society for many years as "the spoils of the
- Empire." The tall tales of valor in the Khyber Pass covered a
- vast trade in opium. The British Army was stationed in the
- Khyber Pass to protect caravans carrying raw opium from being
- pillaged by hill tribesmen. Did the British royal family know
- this? They must have, what else would induce the Crown to
- keep an army in this region where there was nothing of much
- worth other than the lucrative opium trade? It was very expen-
- sive to keep men under arms in a far away country. Her Majesty
- must have asked why these military units were there? Certainly
- not to play polo or billiards in the officers' mess.
- The BEIC was jealous of its monopoly in opium. Would-be
- competitors received short shrift. In a noted trial in 1791, a
- certain Warren Hastings was put on charges that he helped a
- Friend to get into the opium trade at the expense of the BEIC.
- The actual wording which I found in the records of the case
- housed in India Office gives some insight into the vast opium
- trade: "The charge is that Hastings has granted a contract for the
- Provision of Opium for four years to Stephen Sullivan, without
- advertising for the same, on terms glaringly obvious and wantonly
- profuse, for the purpose of creating an INSTANT FORTUNE
- for the said William Sullivan Esq." (Emphasis added.)
- As the BEIC-British government held the monopoly in opium
- trading, the only people allowed to make instant fortunes were
- the "nobility," the "aristocracy," the plutocrats and oligarchical
- families of England, many of whose descendants sit on the
- Committee of 300 just as their forbears sat on the Council of 300
- who ran the BEIC. Outsiders like Mr. Sullivan soon found
- themselves in trouble with the Crown if they were so bold as to
- try and help themselves get into the multi-billion pound Sterling
- opium business.
- The honorable men of the BEIC with its list of 300 counselors
- were members of all the famous gentlemen's clubs in London
- and they were for the most part members of parliament, while
- others, both in India and at home, were magistrates. Company
-
- 112
-
- passports were required to land in China. When a few busybod-
- ies arrived in China to investigate the British Crown's involve-
- ment in the lucrative trade, BEIC magistrates promptly revoked
- their passports, thus effectively denying them entry into China.
- Friction with the Chinese government was common. The
- Chinese had passed a law, the Yung Cheny Edict of 1729,
- forbidding the importation of opium, yet the BEIC managed to
- keep opium as an entry in the Chinese Customs Tariff books
- until 1753, the duty being three taels per chest of opium. Even
- when British special secret service (the 007 of the day) saw to it
- that troublesome Chinese officials were bought off, and in cases
- where that was not possible, they were simply murdered.
- Every British monarch since 1729 has benefited immensely
- from the drug trade and this holds good for the present occupant
- of the throne. Their ministers saw to it that wealth flowed into
- their family coffers. One such minister of Victoria's was Lord
- Palmerston. He clung obstinately to the belief that nothing
- should be allowed to stop Britain's opium trade with China.
- Palmerston's plan was to supply the Chinese government with
- enough opium to make individual members become greedy.
- Then the British would withhold supplies and when the Chinese
- government was on its knees, supplies would be resumed--but
- at a much higher price, thus retaining a monopoly through the
- Chinese government itself, but the plan failed.
- The Chinese government responded by destroying large
- cargoes of opium stored in warehouses, and British merchants
- were required to sign INDIVIDUAL agreements not to import
- any more opium into Canton. BEIC responded by sending scores
- of fully-loaded opium carrying ships to lie in the roads of
- Macao. Companies beholden to BEIC, rather than individuals,
- then sold these cargoes. Chinese Commissioner Lin said, "There
- is so much opium on board English vessels now lying in the
- roads of this place (Macao) which will never be returned to the
- country from which it came, and I shall not be surprised to hear
- of its being smuggled in under American colors." Lin's prophecy
-
- 113
-
- proved to be remarkably accurate.
- The Opium Wars against China were designed to "put the
- Chinese in their place" as Lord Palmerston once said, and the
- British Army did that. There was simply no stopping the vast,
- lucrative trade which provided the British oligarchical feudal
- lords with untold billions, while leaving China with millions of
- opium addicts. In later years the Chinese appealed to Britain for
- help with their immense problem and received it. Thereafter
- respective Chinese governments realized the value in cooperat-
- ing instead of fighting with Britain--and this held good during
- the bloody rule of Mao Tse Tung--so that today, as I have
- already mentioned, any quarrels that come about are only over
- the share of the opium trade each is entitled to.
- To advance to more modern history, the Chinese-British
- partnership was solidified by the Hong Kong agreement which
- established an equal partnership in the opium trade. This has
- proceeded smoothly, with an occasional ripple here and there, but
- while violence and death, robbery and murder marked the pro-
- gression of the Colombian cocaine trade, no such baseness was
- allowed to disturb the heroin trade, which, as I said earlier, is once
- again coming into the ascendancy as we near the end of 1991.
- The major problem that arose in Sino-British relations dur-
- ing the past 60 years concerned China's demand for a larger
- slice of the opium-heroin pie. This was settled when Britain
- agreed to hand Hong Kong over to full Chinese government
- control which will come into effect in 1997. Other than that, the
- partners retain their former equal shares of the lucrative opium
- trade based in Hong Kong.
- The British oligarchical families of the Committee of 300
- who were entrenched in Canton at the height of the opium trade
- left their descendants in position. Look at a list of prominent
- British residents in China and you will see the names of members
- of the Committee of 300 among them. The same holds good for
- Hong Kong. These plutocrats of a feudal era, that they seek to
- return to the world, control the gold and opium trade of which
-
- 114
-
- Hong Kong is THE center. Burmese and Chinese opium poppy
- growers get paid in gold; they do not trust the U.S. paper $100
- bill. This explains the very large volume of gold trade in the
- Hong Kong exchange.
- The Golden Triangle is no longer the largest producer of
- opium. That dubious title has since 1987 been shared by the
- Golden Crescent (Iran), Pakistan and Lebanon. These are the
- principle opium producers, although smaller quantities are once
- again coming out of Afghanistan and Turkey. The drug trade,
- and more: especially the opium trade, could not function without
- the help of banks as we shall demonstrate as we proceed.
- How do banks with their great air of respectability fit into
- the drug trade with all of its attendant filth? It is a very long and
- complicated story, which could be the subject of a book on its
- own. One way in which banks participate is by financing front
- companies importing the chemicals needed to process raw opium
- into heroin. The Hong Kong and Shanghai Bank with a branch
- office in London is right in the middle of such trade through a
- company called TEJAPAIBUL, which banks with Hong Kong and
- Shanghai Bank. What does this company do? It imports into Hong
- Kong most of the chemicals needed in the heroin refining process.
- It is also a major supplier of acetic anhydride For the Golden
- Crescent and the Golden Triangle, Pakistan, Turkey and Leba-
- non. The actual financing for this trading is hived off to the
- Bangkok Metropolitan Bank. Thus, the secondary activities
- connected with processing opium, while not in the same cat-
- egory us the opium trade, nevertheless generates substantial
- income for banks. But the real income of the Hong Kong and
- Shanghai Bank and indeed all banks in the region is financing
- the actual opium trade.
- It took a lot of research on my part to link the price of gold to
- the price of opium. I used to tell anyone who would listen, "If
- you want to know the price of gold find out what the price of a
- pound or a kilo of opium is in Hong Kong." To my critics I
- answered, "Take a look at what happened in 1977, a critical year
-
- 115
-
- for gold." The Bank of China shocked the gold pundits, and
- those clever forecasters who are to be found in great numbers in
- America, by suddenly and without warning, dumping 80 tons of
- gold on the market.
- That depressed the price of gold in a big hurry. All the experts
- could say was, "We never knew China had that much gold
- where could it have come from?" It came from the gold which is
- paid to China in the Hong Kong Gold Market for large purchases
- of opium. The current policy of the Chinese government toward
- England is the same as it was in the 18th and 19th centuries. The
- Chinese economy, tied to the economy of Hong Kong--and I
- don't mean television sets, textiles, radios, watches, pirated
- cassette and video tapes--I mean opium/heroin--would take a
- terrible beating if it were not for the opium trade it shares with
- Britain. The BEIC is gone but the descendants of the Council of
- 300 linger on in the membership of the Committee of 300.
- The oldest of the oligarchical British families who were
- leaders in the opium trade for the past 200 years are still in it
- today. Take the Mathesons, for instance. This "noble" family is
- one of the pillars of the opium trade. When things looked a bit
- shaky a few years ago, the Mathesons stepped in and gave China
- a loan of $300 million for real estate investment. Actually it was
- billed as a "joint venture between the People's Republic of
- China and the Matheson Bank." When researching India Office
- papers of the 1700's I came across the name of Matheson, and it
- kept on cropping up everywhere--London, Peking, Dubai, Hong
- Kong, wherever heroin and opium are mentioned.
- The problem with the drug trade is that it has become a threat
- to national sovereignty. Here is what the Venezuelan Ambassa-
- dor to the United Nations said about this world-wide threat:
-
- "The problem of drugs bas already ceased to be dealt
- with simply as one of public health or a social problem.
- It has turned into something far more serious and far-
- reaching which affects our national sovereignty; a prob-
-
- 116
-
- lem of national security, because it strikes at the indepen-
- dence of a nation. Drugs in all their manifestations of
- production, commercialization and consumption, de-
- naturalizes us by injuring our ethical, religious and politi-
- cal life, our historic, economic, and republican values."
-
- This is precisely the way the Bank of International Settle-
- ments and the IMF are operating. Let me say without hesitation
- that both these banks are nothing more than bully-boy clearing
- houses for the drug trade. The BIS undermines any country that
- the IMF wants to sink by setting up ways and means for the easy
- outflow of flight capital. Nor does BIS recognize nor make any
- distinction when it comes down to what is flight capital and
- what is laundered drug money.
- The BIS operates on gangster lines. If a country will not
- submit to asset-stripping by the IMF, then it says in effect, "Right,
- then we will break you by means of the huge cache of narco-dollars
- we are holding." It is easy to understand why gold was demonetized
- and substituted with the paper "dollar" as the world's reserve
- currency. It is not as easy to blackmail a country holding gold
- reserves as it is one having its reserves in paper dollars.
- The IMF held a meeting in Hong Kong a few years ago
- which was attended by a colleague of mine and he told me the
- seminar dealt with this very question. He informed me that the
- IMF agents told the meeting that they could literally cause a run
- on any country's currency, using narco-dollars, which would
- precipitate a flight of capital. Rainer-Gut, a Credit Suisse del-
- egate and member of the Committee of 300, said he foresaw a
- situation where national credit and national financing would be
- under one umbrella organization by the turn of the century.
- While Rainer-Gut did not spell it out, everybody at the seminar
- knew exactly what he was talking about.
- From Colombia to Miami, from the Golden Triangle to the
- Golden Gate, from Hong Kong to New York, from Bogota to
- Frankfurt, the drug trade, and more especially the heroin trade,
-
- 117
-
- is BIG BUSINESS and it is run from the top down by some of
- the most "untouchable" families in the world, and each of those
- families have at least one member who is on the Committee of
- 300. It is not a street corner business, and it takes a great deal of
- money and expertise to keep it flowing smoothly. The machin-
- ery under control of the Committee of 300 ensures this.
- Such talents are not found on the street corners and subways
- of New York. To be sure the pushers and peddlers are an integral
- part of the trade, but only as very small part-time salesmen. I say
- part-time because they are caught and rivalry gets some of them
- shot. But what does that matter? There are plenty of replace-
- ments available.
- No, it is not anything the Small Business Administration
- would be interested in. IT IS BIG BUSINESS, a vast empire,
- this dirty drug business. Of necessity, it is operated from the top
- down in every single country in the world. It is, in fact, the
- largest single enterprise in the world today, transcending all
- others. That it is protected from the top down is borne out by the
- fact that, like international terrorism, it cannot be stamped out
- which should indicate to a reasonable person that some of this
- biggest names in royal circles, the oligarchy, the plutocracy are
- running it, even if it is done through intermediaries.
- The main countries involved in growing poppies and the
- cocoa bush are Burma, Northern China, Afghanistan, Iran, Pa-
- Kistan, Thailand, Lebanon, Turkey, Peru, Ecuador, Bolivia. Co-
- lombia does not grow the cocoa bush but, next to Bolivia, is the
- main refiner of cocaine and the chief financial center of the
- cocaine trade which, since General Noriega was kidnaped and
- imprisoned by President Bush, is being challenged by Panama
- for first place in money laundering and capital financing of the
- cocaine trade.
- The heroin trade is financed by Hong Kong banks, London
- banks and some Middle East banks such as the British Bank of
- the Middle East. Lebanon is fast becoming the "Switzerland of
- the Middle East." Countries involved in the distribution and
-
- 118
-
- routing of heroin are Hong Kong, Turkey, Bulgaria, Italy, Mo-
- naco, France (Corsica and Marseilles) Lebanon and Pakistan.
- The United States is the largest consumer of narcotics, first
- place going to cocaine, which is being challenged by heroin.
- Western Europe and Southwest Asian countries are the biggest
- users of heroin. Iran has a huge heroin addict population--in
- excess of 2 million as of 1991.
- There is not a single government that does not know pre-
- cisely what is going on with regard to the drug trade, but
- individual members holding powerful positions are taken, but
- of by the Committee of 300 through its world-wide network of
- subsidiaries. If any government member is "difficult," he or she
- is removed, as in the case of Pakistan's Ali Bhutto and Italy's
- Aldo Moro. No one is beyond the reach of this all-powerful
- Committee, even though Malaysia has been successful in hold-
- ing out up until now. Malaysia has the strictest anti-drug laws in
- the world. Possession of even small amounts is punishable by
- the death penalty.
- Like the Kintex Company of Bulgaria, most smaller coun-
- tries have a direct hand in these criminal enterprises. Kintex
- trucks regularly ferried heroin through Western Europe in its
- own fleet of trucks bearing the EEC marker Triangle
- Internationale Routier (TIR). Trucks bearing this marker and the
- EEC recognition number are not supposed to be stopped at
- customs boarder posts. TlR trucks are allowed to carry only
- perishable items. They are supposed to be inspected in the
- country from whence they originated and documentation to this
- effect is supposed to be carried by each truck driver.
- Under international treaty obligations this is what happens,
- thus Kintex trucks were able load their cargoes of heroin and
- certify it as "fresh fruit and vegetables;" and then make their
- way through Western Europe, even entering high-security NATO
- bases in Northern Italy. In this manner, Bulgaria became one of
- the principal countries through which heroin was routed.
- The only way to stop the huge amounts of heroin and
-
- 119
-
- cocaine presently finding their way to markets in Europe is to
- end the TIR system. That will never happen. The international
- treaty obligations I have just mentioned were set up by the
- Committee of 300, using its amazing networks and control
- mechanisms, to facilitate passage of all manner of drugs to
- Western Europe. Forget perishable goods! A former DEA agent
- stationed in Italy told me, "TIR=DOPE."
- Remember this the next time you read in the newspapers
- that a big haul of heroin was found in a false-bottom suitcase at
- Kennedy Airport, and some unlucky "mule" pays the price for
- his criminal activity. This kind of action is only "small pota-
- toes," sand in the eyes of the public, to make us think our
- government is really doing something about the drug menace.
- Take for example, "The French Connection," a Nixon program
- embarked upon without the knowledge and consent of the
- committee of 300.
- The entire amount of opium/heroin seized in that massive
- effort is somewhat less than one quarter of what a single TIR
- truck carries. The Committee of 300 saw to it that Nixon paid a
- heavy price for a relatively small seizure of heroin. It was not
- the amount of heroin involved, but a matter of one whom they
- had helped up the ladder to the White House believing that he
- could now do without their help and backing, and even go
- against direct orders from above.
- The mechanics of the heroin trade go like this: wild Thai and
- Burmese Hill tribesmen grow the opium poppy. At harvest time,
- the seed-bearing pod is cut with a razor or sharp knife. A
- resinous substance leaks through the cut and starts to congeal.
- This is raw opium. The crop of raw opium is made up into sticky
- roundish balls. The tribesman are paid in 1 kilo gold bars--
- known as 4/10ths--which are minted by Credit Suisse. These
- small bars are used ONLY to pay the tribesman--the normal-
- weight gold bars are traded on the Hong Kong market by the big
- buyers of raw opium or partly processed heroin. The same
- methods are used to pay hill tribesman in India--the Baluchis--
-
- 120
-
- who have been in this business since the days of the Moguls.
- The "Dope Season," as it is called, sees a flood of gold traded on
- the Hong Kong market.
- Mexico has started producing relatively small amounts of
- heroin called "Mexican Brown" which is much in demand by
- the Hollywood crowd. Here again the heroin trade is run by top
- government officials who have the military on their side. Some
- producers of "Mexican Brown" are making a million dollars a
- month by supplying their U.S. clients. On occasions when a few
- Mexican Federal police are prodded into taking action against
- the heroin producers, they are "taken out" by military units who
- seem to appear as if from nowhere.
- Such an incident occurred in November 1991 at an isolated
- airstrip in Mexico's opium producing region. Federal narcotics
- agents surrounded the strip and were about to arrest people who
- were in the act of loading heroin when a squad of soldiers
- arrived. The soldiers rounded up the Federal narcotics police
- agents and systematically killed all of them. This action posed
- serious threat to Mexican President Goltarin, who is faced with
- loud demands for a full-scale investigation into the murders.
- Goltarin is over a barrel; he can't back off from calling for an
- inquiry, and neither can he afford to offend the military. It is the
- first such crack in the tight chain of command in Mexico that
- stretches all the way back to the Committee of 300.
- Raw opium from the Golden Triangle is pipelined to the
- Sicilian Mafia and the French end of the business for refining in
- the laboratories that infest the French coastline from Marseilles
- to Monte-Carlo. Nowadays, Lebanon and Turkey are turning
- out increasing amounts of refined heroin and a large number of
- laboratories have sprung up in these two countries in the past
- four years. Pakistan also has a number of laboratories but it is
- not in the same league as France, for example.
- The route taken by the raw opium carriers of the Golden
- Crescent goes through Iran, Turkey and Lebanon. When the
- Shah of Iran was in control of the country, he refused to allow
-
- 121
-
- the heroin trade to continue and it was forcibly discontinued-
- up until the time that he was "dealt with" by the Committee of
- 300. Raw opium from Turkey and Lebanon finds it way to
- Corsica, from where it is shipped to Monte Carlo with the
- connivance of the Grimaldi family. Pakistani laboratories, under
- the guise of "military defense laboratories" are doing a bigger
- share of refining than they were two years ago, but the best
- refining is still done along the French Mediterranean coastline
- and in Turkey. Here again, banks play a vital role in financing
- these operations.
- Let us stop here for a moment. Are we to believe that with all
- the modern and vastly improved surveillance techniques, in-
- cluding satellite reconnaissance, available to law enforcement
- agencies in these countries, that this vile trade cannot be pin-
- pointed and stopped? How is it that law enforcement agencies
- cannot go in and destroy these laboratories once they are dis-
- covered? If this IS the case, and we still cannot interdict the
- heroin trade, then our anti-narcotics services ought to be known
- as "The Geriatrics" and not drug enforcement agencies.
- Even a child could tell our alleged "drug watchers" what to
- do. Simply keep a check on all factories making acetic anhy-
- dride, THE most essential chemical component needed by labo-
- ratories to refine heroin from raw opium. THEN FOLLOW
- THE TRAIL! It is as simple as that! I am reminded of Peter
- Sellers in the "Pink Panther" series when I think of law en-
- forcement efforts to locate heroin-refining laboratories. Even
- someone as bumbling as the imaginary inspector would have
- had no trouble in following the route taken by acetic anhydride
- shipments to their final destination.
- Governments could make laws that would oblige manufac-
- turers of acetic anhydride to keep scrupulous records showing
- who buys the chemical and for what purposes it is to be used.
- But do not hold your breath on this one, remember Dope=Big
- Business and Big Business is done by the oligarchical families
- of Europe and the United States Eastern Liberal Establishment.
-
- 122
-
- The drug business is not a Mafia operation, nor one run by the
- Colombian cocaine cartels. The noble families of Britain and
- America's top people are not going to advertise their role in the
- shop windows; they always have a layer of front men to do the
- dirty work.
- Remember British and AMERICAN "nobility" never dirt-
- ied their hands in the China opium trade. The lords and ladies
- were much too clever for that, as were the American elite: the
- Delanos, Forbes, Appletons, Bacons, Boylestons, Perkins,
- Russells, Cunninghams, Shaws, Coolidges, Parkmans,
- Runnewells, Cabots and Codmans, by no means a complete list
- of families in America who grew immensely wealthy from the
- China opium trade.
- Since this is not a book about the drug trade, I cannot of
- necessity, cover the subject in an in-depth manner. But its
- importance to the Committee of 300 must be emphasized.
- America is run not by 60 families but by 300 families and
- England is run by 100 families and, as we shall see, these
- families are intertwined through marriage, companies, banks,
- not to mention ties to the Black Nobility, Freemasonry, the
- Order of St. John of Jerusalem and so on. These are the people
- who, through their surrogates, find ways to protect huge ship-
- ments of heroin from Hong Kong, Turkey, Iran and Pakistan and
- ensure they reach the market places in the U.S. and Western
- Europe with the minimum cost of doing business.
- Shipments of cocaine are sometimes interdicted and seized
- That is mere window dressing. Often times the shipments seized
- belong to a new organization trying to break into the trade. Such
- competition is put out of business by informing the authorities
- exactly where it is going to enter the U.S. and who the owners
- are. The big stuff is never touched; heroin is too expensive. It is
- worthy of note that U.S. Drug Enforcement Agency operatives
- are not allowed into Hong Kong. They cannot examine any
- ship's manifest before it leaves the port. One wonders why, if
- there is so much "international cooperation" going on--what
-
- 123
-
- the media likes to characterize as "smashing the dope trade."
- Clearly the trade routes for heroin are protected by "a higher
- authority. "
- In South America, apart from Mexico, cocaine is king. The
- production of cocaine is very simple, unlike heroin, and great
- fortunes are to be made by those willing to take risks for and on
- behalf of the "higher ups." As in the heroin trade, interlopers are
- not welcome and often finish up as casualties, or victims of
- family feuds. In Colombia the drug mafia is a closely knit
- family. But such has been the bad publicity generated by the
- M19 guerrilla attack on the Justice Building in Bogota (M19 is
- the private army of the cocaine barons) and the murder of
- Rodrigo Lara Bonilla, a prominent prosecutor and a judge, that
- the "higher authority" had to rearrange matters in Colombia.
- Accordingly, the Ochoas of the Medellin Cartel turned
- themselves in after being assured that they would not suffer any
- loss of fortune, harm of any kind, nor would they be extradited
- to the United States. A deal was struck that, provided they
- repatriated the bulk of their huge narco-dollar fortunes to Co-
- lombian banks, no punitive action would be taken against them.
- The Ochoas--Jorge, Fabio, and their top man, Pablo Escobar,
- would be held in private jails that resemble a luxury-class motel
- room, and then be sentenced to a maximum term of two years--
- to be served in the same motel jail. This deal is ongoing. The
- Ochoas have also been guaranteed the right to continue to
- manage their "business" from their motel-prison.
- But that does not mean that the cocaine trade has come to a
- screeching halt. On the contrary, it has simply been transferred
- to the second-string Cali cartel, and it is business as usual. For
- some strange reason the Cali cartel, which is equal in size to the
- Medellin cartel, has been--at least up until now--largely ig-
- nored by the DEA. Cali differs from the Medellin cartel in that it
- is run by BUSINESSMEN, who eschew all forms of violence
- and never break agreements.
- Even more significant is that Cali does virtually no business
-
- 124
-
- in Florida. My source told me that the Cali cartel is run by
- shrewd businessmen unlike any seen in the cocaine business.
- He believes that they were "specially appointed," but does not
- know by whom. "They never call attention to themselves," he
- said. "They do not go around importing red Ferraris like Jorge
- Ochoa did, attracting immediate attention, because it is forbid-
- den to import such cars into Colombia."
- Cali cartel markets are in Los Angeles, New York and
- Houston, which closely parallel the heroin markets. Cali has not
- shown any signs of moving into Florida. A former DEA opera-
- tive who is a colleague of mine said recently, "These Cali people
- are sure smart. They are a different breed to the Ochoa brothers.
- They act like professional businessmen. They are now larger
- than the Medellin cartel and I think we are going to see a lot
- more cocaine get into the United States than ever before. The
- kidnaping of Manuel Noriega will facilitate an easier flow
- through Panama of cocaine and money, what with so many
- banks there. So much for President George Bush's Operation
- Just Cause. All it did was make life a great deal easier for
- Nicolas Ardito Barletta who used to be run by the Ochoa brothers
- and who is fixing to front for the Cali cartel."
- Based on my experience with the heroin trade I believe that
- the Committee of 300 has stepped in and taken over full control
- of the South American cocaine trade. There is no other expla-
- nation For the rise of the Cali cartel which is coupled with the
- kidnaping of Noriega. Did Bush take his orders from London
- regarding Noriega? There is every indication that he was literally
- PUSHED into invading Panama and kidnaping Noriega, who
- had become a serious impediment to "trade" in Panama, espe-
- cially in the banking business.
- Several former intelligence agents have given me their opin-
- ions which coincide with my own. Like the Gulf War that
- followed in the wake of Panama, it was only after several calls
- from the British Ambassedor in Washington that Bush finally
- plucked up enough courage to make his totally illegal move on
-
- 125
-
- General Noriega. That he was supported by the British press and
- the New York Times, a British intelligence run newspaper, speaks
- volumes.
- Noriega was formerly the darling of the Washington estab-
- lishment. He frequently hob-knobbed with William Casey and
- Oliver North and even met with President George Bush on at
- least two occasions. Noriega was often seen at the Pentagon
- where he was treated like one of those Arab potentates, and the
- red carpet was always laid out for him at CIA headquarters in
- Langley Virginia. U.S. Army Intelligence and the CIA are on
- record as having paid him $320,000.
- Then storm clouds began to appear on the horizon at about
- the same time the Cali cartel was taking over the cocaine trade
- from the Ochoa brothers and Pablo Escobar. Led by Senator
- Jesse Helms, who sold out to Ariel Sharon and the Israeli
- Histradut Party in 1985, there suddenly began an agitation for
- the removal of Noriega. Jesse Helms and those of a like mind
- were backed up by Simon Hersh, a British intelligence agent
- working for the New York Times, which has been a British intel-
- ligence mouthpiece in the U.S. since the time that M16 boss, Sir
- William Stephenson, occupied the RCA building in New York.
- It is very significant that Helms should have chosen to lead
- the charge against Noriega. Helms is the darling of the Sharon
- faction in Washington and Sharon was the principal gun-runner
- in Central America and Colombia. Moreover, Helms has the
- respect of the Christian fundamentalists who believe in the
- maxim: "Israel, my country, right or wrong." Thus a powerful
- momentum was created to "get Noriega." It is evident that
- Noriega could well prove a serious impediment to the interna-
- tional drug merchants and their Committee of 300 bankers, so he
- had to be removed before he could do some significant damage.
- Bush was pressured by his British masters to conduct an
- illegal search and seizure operation in Panama that resulted in
- the deaths of no less than 7,000 Panamanians and wanton de-
- struction of property. Nothing to implicate Noriega as a "drug
-
- 126
-
- dealer" was ever found, so he was kidnaped and brought to the
- U.S. in one of the most blatant examples of international
- brigandry in history. This illegal action probably best meets the
- Bush philosophy: "The moral dimensions of American (read
- British royal family-Committee of 300) foreign policy require
- us to chart a moral course through a world of lesser evils. That's
- the real world, not black and while. Very few absolutes."
- It was a "lesser evil" lo kidnap Noriega, rather than have
- him up-end the banks in Panama working for the Committee of
- 300. The Noriega case is a prototype of monstrous One World
- government actions waiting in the wings. An emboldened Bush
- came right out in the open, unafraid, because we, the people
- have put on a spiritual mantle that accommodates LIES and
- wants no part of TRUTH. This is the world we have decided to
- accept. If it were not so, a firestorm of anger would have swept
- the country over the invasion of Panama, which would not have
- stopped until Bush was hounded from office. Nixon's Watergate
- transgressions pale into insignificance next to the many im-
- peachable offenses committed by President Bush when he or-
- dered the invasion of Panama to kidnap General Noriega.
- The government case against Noriega is based upon perjured
- testimony by a group of big men, for the most part, already
- convicted and lying through their individual and collective teeth
- to gel their own sentences lightened. Their performance would
- have pleased Gilbert and Sullivan immensely, were they alive
- today. "They made them the rulers of DEA," might be apropos
- instead of, "They made them the rulers of Queen's Navy," from
- "HMS Pinafore." It is an altogether grotesque scene to see how
- these con-artists are performing like not-so-well-trained seals
- for the U.S. Justice Department; that is if we care to insult such
- a nice clean animal by such an unworthy comparison.
- Key dates conflict wildly, key details are altogether con-
- spicuous by their absence, lapses of memory on crucial points
- all add up to the obvious fact that the government has no case
- against Noriega, but that does not matter; the Royal Institute for
-
- 127
-
- International Affairs (RIIA) says "convict him anyway" and that
- is what poor Noriega can expect. One of the Justice Department's
- star witnesses is one Floyd Carlton Caceres, a former pilot for
- the Ochoa brothers. Following his arrest in 1986, Carlton tried
- to ease his position at the expense of Noriega.
-
- <<<<< cont in Committee of 300 - part 6 >>>>>
-
-
- --
- <*> Don Allen <*> 1:363/81.1 - Fidonet #1 - Homebody BBS
- dona@bilver.uucp - Internet 1:363/29.8 - Fidonet #2 - Gourmet Delight
- 88:4205/1.1 - MUFON Network 1:3607/20.2 -- Odyssey - Alabama UFO Net
- NSA grep food: Aviary, Ed Dames, Los Alamos - Majestic - Jason - RIIA - UN
-
- Path: igor.rutgers.edu!rutgers!jvnc.net!darwin.sura.net!wupost!uunet!peora!tarpit!tous!bilver!dona
- From: dona@bilver.uucp (Don Allen)
- Newsgroups: alt.conspiracy
- Subject: FILE: Committee of 300 - Part 6
- Message-ID: <1992Nov15.195249.27218@bilver.uucp>
- Date: 15 Nov 92 19:52:49 GMT
- Organization: W. J. Vermillion - Winter Park, FL
- Lines: 995
-
- --- Committee of 300 - Part 6 ---------------------------------------
-
-
- He told his DEA interrogators that the Ochoa brothers had
- paid Noriega $600,000 to allow three planes loaded with cocaine
- to land and refuel in Panama. But once in court in Miami, it soon
- became apparent that what was billed as the "star witness" for
- the prosecution was at best damp squib. Under cross-examination
- the true story emerged: Far from being paid to allow the flights,
- Noriega wasn't even approached by the Ochoas. Worse yet, in
- December of 1983, Noriega had ordered that all flights to Panama
- from Medellin be refused permission to land in Panama. Carlton
- is not the only discredited witness.
- One who is even a sorrier liar than Carlton is Carlos Lehder,
- who was a kingpin in the Medellin Cartel until he was arrested
- in Spain and sent to the U.S. Who gave the DEA the most vital
- information that Lehder was in Madrid? The DEA reluctantly
- concedes that they owe this important catch to Noriega. Now,
- however, the Justice Department is using Lehder as a witness
- against Noriega. If nothing else, this single witness demon-
- strates the wretchedness of the United States government's case
- against Manuel Noriega.
- In return for services rendered, Lehder has been granted an
- easing of his sentence and far nicer quarters--a room with a
- view and television--and his family was given permanent res-
- idence in the U.S. Robert Merkel, a former U.S. attorney who
- prosecuted Lehder in 1988 told the Washington Pose "I don't
- think the government should be in the business of dealing with
- Carlos Lehder, period. This guy is a liar from beginning to end.
- The Justice Department, purely a name which bears no
- resemblance to what it is supposed to stand for, has pulled out
- all its dirty tricks against Noriega: illegally wire-tapping his
- conversations with his lawyer; appointing a government lawyer
-
- 128
-
- to pretend he was serving Noriega but who quit in the middle of
- everything; freezing his bank accounts so that Noriega is unable
- to conduct a proper defense; kidnaping, illegal search and seizure.
- You name it, the government has broken more laws than Noriega
- has ever done--if indeed he has broken any laws at all.
- It is the U.S. Justice Department that is on trial tenfold more
- than General Noriega. The Noriega case shows the glaringly
- evil system that passes for "justice" in this country. The U.S.
- "war on drugs" is on trial as is the Bush Administration's so-
- called drug policy. The Noriega trial, although it will end in a
- violent and flagrant rape of justice, will nevertheless offer some
- compensation to those who are not blind, deaf and dumb. It
- proves for once and for all that Britain is in charge of our
- government and it will reveal the utterly bankrupt ideology of
- the Bush Administration which ought to have as its motto, "No
- Matter What, The End Always Justifies The Means. There Are
- Very Few Moral Absolutes." Like the majority of politicians, for
- Bush to have a standard of ABSOLUTE MORALITY WOULD
- BE SUICIDAL. Only in this climate could we have allowed
- President Bush to violate at least six United States laws and
- DOZENS OF INTERNATIONAL AGREEMENTS in going to
- war against Iraq.
- What we are witnessing in Colombia and Washington is a
- complete revision of how the cocaine trade is to be run; no more
- wild stuff, no more blazing guns. Let the gentlemen of the Cali
- cartel in pin-stripe suits conduct the business in a gentlemanly
- way In short, the Committee of 300 has taken a direct hand in
- the cocaine trade which henceforth will go as smoothly as the
- heroin trade. The new government of Colombia is geared to the
- change in tactics and direction. It is on notice to perform ac-
- cording to the Committee's game plan.
- There is need to mention U.S. participation in the China
- opium trade which began in the southern United States prior to
- the War Between The States. How can we tie the opium trade in
- with the great cotton plantations of the South? To do that, we
-
- 129
-
- have to start in Bengal, India, producers of the finest (if one can
- call such a foul substance fine) opium which was much in
- demand. Cotton was THE biggest trade in England, after opium
- sales through the BEIC.
- Most of the cotton from Southern plantations was worked in
- the slave mills of Northern England, where women and children
- earned a pittance for a 16-hour day's work. The cloth mills were
- owned by the wealthy socialites in London, the Barings,
- Palmerstons, Keswicks and most of all the Jardine Mathesons
- who owned the Blue Star Shipping Line, on which the finished
- cotton cloth goods were shipped to India. They could care less
- about the hapless conditions endured by Her Majesty's subject.
- After all, that is what they were for, and their husbands and sons
- were useful for fighting wars to preserve Her Majesty's far-
- flung empire as they had done for centuries, and latterly, in the
- bloody Boer War. That was British tradition, wasn't it?
- Cotton cloth finished goods exported to India undercut and
- destroyed the long-standing Indian producers of cotton finished
- goods trade. Terrible privation was endured by thousands of
- Indians thrown out of work as a result of cheaper British goods
- taking over their markets. India then became utterly dependent
- upon Britain to earn enough currency to pay for its railroads and
- finished cotton goods imports. There was only one solution to
- India's economic woes. Produce more opium and sell it for less
- to the British East India Company. This was the rock upon
- which British trade grew and flourished. Without its opium
- trade, Britain would have been as bankrupt.
- Did the Southern plantation owners know about the ugly
- secret of opium-for-cotton goods? It is unlikely that some of
- them didn't know what was going on. Take, for instance, the
- Sutherland family, one of the largest cotton plantation owners in
- the South. The Sutherlands were closely related to the Matheson
- family--Jardine Matheson--who in turn had as their business
- partners the Baring Brothers, founders of the famous Peninsular
- and Orient Navigation Line (P&O), the largest of Britain's many
-
- 130
-
- merchant shipping lines.
- The Barings were big investors in Southern plantations as
- they were in the U.S. Clipper ships which plowed through the
- seas between Chinese ports and all the important ports along the
- eastern seaboard of the United States. Today the Barings run a
- number of very substantial financial operations in the United
- States. All of those names mentioned were, and their descen-
- dants still are, members of the Committee of 300.
- The majority of families who go to make up the Eastern
- Liberal Establishment, among whom are the wealthiest to be
- found in this country, derived their fortunes from either the
- cotton trade or the opium trade and in some instances from both.
- Of these the Lehmans are an outstanding example. When it
- comes to fortunes made solely from the China opium trade, the
- first names that come to mind are the Astors and the Delanos.
- President Franklin D. Roosevelt's wife was a Delano.
- John Jacob Astor made a huge fortune out of the China
- opium trade and then he went respectable by buying up large
- tracts of Manhattan real estate with his dirty money. During his
- lifetime Astor played a big role in the Committee of 300s'
- deliberations. In fact, it was the Committee of 300 who chose
- who would be allowed to participate in the fabulously lucrative
- China opium trade, through its monopolist BEIC, and the ben-
- eficiaries of their largess remained forever wedded to the Com-
- mittee of 300.
- That is why, as we shall discover, most real estate in Man-
- hattan belongs to various Committee members, even as it has
- since the days when Astor began buying it up. With the benefit
- of access to records that would be closed to others outside of
- British intelligence, I discovered that Astor had long been an
- asset of British intelligence in the United States. Astor's financing
- of Aaron Burr, the murderer of Alexander Hamilton, proves the
- point beyond any reasonable doubt.
- John Jacob Astor's son, Waldorf Astor, had the additional
- honor bestowed upon him of being appointed to the Royal
-
- 131
-
- Institute for International Affairs (RIIA), through which organi-
- zation the Committee of 300 controls every facet of our lives in
- the United States. The Astor family is believed to have selected
- Owen Lattimore to carry on their association with the opium
- trade which he did through the Laura Spelman-funded Institute
- for Pacific Relations (IPR). It was the IPR that oversaw China's
- entry into the opium trade as an equal partner and not merely as
- a supplier. It was IPR that paved the way for the Japanese attack
- on Pearl Harbor. Attempts to turn the Japanese into opium
- addicts met with dismal failure.
- By the turn of the century the oligarchical plutocrats of
- Britain were like overgorged vultures on the Serengeti Plain at
- the time of the annual Wildebeest march. Their income from the
- China opium trade exceeded David Rockefeller's income by
- SEVERAL BILLION DOLLARS PER ANNUM. Historic
- records made available to me in the British Museum in London
- and from India Office and other sources--former colleagues in
- well-placed positions, proves this completely.
- By 1905, the Chinese government, deeply concerned about
- the rise in the number of opium addicts in China, tried to get
- help from the international community. Britain pretended to
- cooperate, but made no move whatsoever to abide by the 1905
- protocols it had signed. Later Her Majesty's government did an
- about-face after showing China that it was better to join them in
- the opium business rather than to try and end it.
- Even The Hague Convention was scoffed at by the British.
- Delegates to the convention had agreed that Britain must abide
- by the protocols it had signed, which was to drastically reduce
- the amount of opium sold in China and elsewhere. The British,
- while paying lip service, had no intention of giving up their
- trade in human misery, which included the so-called "pig trade."
- Their servant, President George Bush, in prosecution of the
- cruel war of genocide waged against the Iraqi nation SOLELY
- for and on behalf of British interests, likewise showed his
- contempt by flouting the Hague Agreement on Aerial Bombard-
-
- 132
-
- ment, and a whole slew of international conventions to which the
- U.S. is a signatory, including ALL of the Geneva Conventions.
- When evidence was produced two years later, notably by the
- Japanese, who were growing very concerned about British
- smuggling of opium into their country, that opium sales had
- increased instead of decreased, then Her Majesty's delegate to
- the Fifth Hague Convention produced a set of statistics which
- were at variance with those provided by Japan. The British
- delegate turned the tables by saying that it made a very strong
- case for legalizing the sale of opium which would have the
- effect of doing away with what he called "the black market."
- He suggested on behalf of Her Majesty's government that
- the Japanese government would then have a monopoly and full
- control of the trade. THIS IS PRECISELY THE SAME ARGU-
- MENT BEING ADVANCED BY THE FRONT MEN FOR
- THE BRONFMANS AND OTHER BIG-TIME DOPE DEAL-
- ERS--LEGALIZE COCAINE, MARIJUANA AND HEROIN,
- LET THE U.S GOVERNMENT HAVE THE MONOPOLY
- AND THEREBY STOP WASTING BILLIONS ON THE
- PHONY WAR ON DRUGS AND SAVE THE TAXPAYERS
- BILLIONS OF DOLLARS.
- In the period of 1791-1894, the number of licensed opium
- dens in the Shanghai International Settlement rose from 87 to
- 663. Opium flowing into the United States was also stepped up.
- Sensing that they might have some problems in China with the
- spotlight of world concern shining upon them, the plutocrats of
- the Knights of St. John and the Order of the Garter, transferred
- some of their attention to Persia (Iran).
- Lord Inchcape, who founded the biggest steamship company
- in the world at the turn of the 19th century, the legendary
- Peninsula and Orient Steam Navigation Company, was the
- principal mover and shaker in establishing the Hong Kong and
- Shanghai Bank, which remains the largest and least controlled
- clearinghouse bank for the opium trade, which also financed the
- "pig trade" with the United States.
-
- 133
-
- The British had set up a scam whereby Chinese "coolies"
- were sent to the U.S. as so-called indentured laborers. The
- rapacious Harriman family's railroad needed "coolies" to push
- the rail connection westward to the California coast, or so they
- said. Strangely enough, very few Negroes were given the manual
- labor jobs they were used to at that time and could have done a
- better job than the emaciated opium addicts who arrived from
- China.
- The problem was that there was no market for opium among
- the Negroes and, moreover, Lord Inchcape, son of the founder
- of P and O needed the "coolies" to smuggle in thousands of
- pounds of raw opium into North America, something the Negroes
- could not do. It was the same Lord Inchcape who in 1923
- warned that there must be no diminishing of opium poppy
- cultivation in Bengal. "This most important source of revenue
- must be safeguarded," he told the commission allegedly inves-
- tigating the production of opium gum in India.
- By 1846, some 120,000 "coolies" had already arrived in the
- U.S. to work on Harriman's railroad pushing westward. The
- "pig trade" was in full profitable swing because, of this number,
- it was estimated by the U.S. government 115,000 were opium
- addicts. Once the railroad was finished, the Chinese did not go
- back to where they came from, but settled in San Francisco, Los
- Angeles, Vancouver and Portland. They created a huge culture
- problem that has never ceased to exist.
- It is interesting to note that Cecil John Rhodes, a Committee
- of 300 member who fronted for the Rothschilds in South Africa
- followed the Inchcape pattern, bringing hundreds of thousand of
- Indian "coolies" to work on the sugar cane plantations in Natal
- province. Among them was Mahatma Ghandi, a Communist
- agitator and troublemaker. Like the Chinese coolies, they were
- not returned to their country of origin once their contracts
- expired. They, too, went on to create a massive social program,
- and their descendants became lawyers who spearheaded the
- drive to infiltrate the government on behalf of the Africa
-
- 134
-
- National Congress.
- By 1875 the Chinese "coolies" operating out of San Francisco
- had set up an opium supply ring that resulted in 129,000 American
- opium addicts. What with the known 115,000 Chinese addicts,
- Lord Inchcape and his family were raking in hundreds of thou-
- sands of dollars a year from this source alone which, in terms of
- today's dollar would represent at least a $100 million dollar
- income every year.
- The very same British and American families who had
- combined to wreck the Indian textile industry in the promotion
- of the opium trade, and who brought African slaves to the U.S.
- combined to make the "pig trade" a valuable source of revenue.
- Later they were to combine to cause and promote the terrible
- War Between The States, also known as the American Civil War.
- The decadent American families of the unholy partnership,
- thoroughly corrupted and wallowing in filthy lucre, went on to
- become what we know today as the Eastern Liberal Establishmemt
- whose members, under the careful guidance and direction of the
- Crown and subsequently its foreign policy executive arm, the
- Royal Institute of International Affairs (RIIA), ran this coun-
- ry--and still does--from top to bottom through their secret
- upper-level, parallel government, which is tightly meshed with
- the Committee of 300, the ULTIMATE secret society.
- By 1923, voices were being raised against this menace that
- had been allowed to be imported into the United States. Believ-
- ing the United States to be a free and sovereign nation, Con-
- gressman Stephen Porter, Chairman of the House of Represen-
- tatives Foreign Affairs Committee, introduced a bill which called
- for the British to account for their opium export-import business
- on a country-by-country basis. The resolution set up quotas for
- each country, which if observed, would have reduced the opium
- made by lO%. The resolution was passed into law and the bill
- accepted by the Congress of the United States.
- But the Royal Institute of International Affairs had other
- ideas. Founded in 1919 in the wake of the Paris Peace Conference
-
- 135
-
- held at Versailles, this was one of the earliest "foreign policy"
- executors of the Committee of 300. Research I have done on the
- Congressional Records, House, show that Porter was totally
- unaware of the powerful forces he was up against. Porter was
- not even aware of the existence of the RIIA, much less that its
- specific purpose was to control every facet of the United States.
- Apparently Congressman Porter received some kind of an
- intimation from the Morgan Bank on Wall Street that he should
- drop the whole affair. Instead, an enraged Porter took his case to
- the League of Nations Opium Committee. Porter's total un-
- awareness of who he was up against is demonstrated in some of
- his correspondence to colleagues on the House Foreign Affairs
- Committee in response to open British opposition to his proposals.
- Her Majesty's representative chided Porter and then, acting
- like a father toward an errant son, the British delegate--on
- instructions from the RIIA--presented Her Majesty's proposals
- to INCREASE opium quotas to account for an increase in the
- consumption of opium for medicinal purposes. According to
- documents that I was able to find in The Hague, Porter was at
- first confused, then amazed and then enraged. Joined by the
- Chinese delegate, Porter stormed out of the plenipotentiary
- session of the Committee session, leaving the field to the British.
- In his absence, the British delegate got the League to rubber
- stamp Her Majesty's government proposals for a creation of a
- tame-tiger Central Narcotics Board, whose chief function was
- information gathering, the terms of which were purposely vague.
- What was to be done with the "information" was never made
- clear. Porter returned to the U.S. a shaken and much wiser man.
- Another British intelligence asset was the fabulously rich
- William Bingham, into which family one of the Barings married.
- It was stated in papers and documents that I saw that the Baring
- Brothers ran the Philadelphia Quakers and owned half of the
- real estate of that city, all made possible because of the fortune
- the Baring Brothers had amassed from the China opium trade.
- Another beneficiary of the Committee of 300's largess was
-
- 136
-
- Stephen Girard, whose descendants inherited the Girard Bank
- and Trust.
- The names of the families, whose history is intertwined with
- that of Boston and who would never give us ordinary folk the
- time of day, were wrapped in the arms of the Committee of 300
- and its vastly lucrative BEIC China opium trade. Many of the
- famous families became associated with the notorious Hong
- Kong and Shanghai Bank which is still the clearing house for
- billions of dollars that flow from the opium trade in China.
- Such famous names as Forbes, Perkins and Hathaway ap-
- pear in the records of the British East India Company. These
- genuine American "bluebloods" created Russell and Company,
- whose main trade was in opium, but also ran other shipping
- enterprises from China to South America and all points in
- between. As a reward for their services to the British Crown and
- the BEIC, the Committee of 300 granted them a monopoly in the
- slave trade in 1833.
- Boston owes its celebrated past to the cotton-opium-slave
- trade granted to it by the Committee of 300 and it is stated in the
- records I was privileged to see in London that Boston's merchant
- families were the chief supporters of the British Crown in the
- United States. John Murray Forbes is mentioned as the major-
- domo of the "Boston Blue Bloods" in India House records and
- in bank records in Hong Kong.
- Forbe's son was the first American allowed by the Commit-
- tee of 300 to sit on the board of the most prestigious drug bank in
- the world--even today--the Hong Kong and Shanghai Bank.
- When I was in Hong Kong in the early 1960's as "an historian
- interested in the British East India Company," I was shown
- some old records, including past board members of this notori-
- ous drug bank, and sure enough, Forbes' name was among them.
- The Perkins family, so illustrious that their name is still
- mentioned in awed whispers, were deeply involved in the ne-
- farious filthy China opium trade. In fact Perkins the elder was
- one of the first Americans to be elected to the Committee of 3OO.
-
- 137
-
- His son, Thomas Nelson, was Morgan's man in Boston,
- and as such also an agent for British intelligence. His unsavory--
- I would say disgusting--past was not in question when he richly
- endowed Harvard University. After all, Canton and Tientsin are
- a long way from Boston, and who would have cared anyway?
- What helped The Perkinses a lot was that Morgan was a
- powerful member of the Committee of 300, which enabled
- Thomas N. Perkins to rapidly further his career in the China
- opium trade. All the Morgans and Perkinses were Freemasons,
- which was another tie that bound them together, for only Free-
- masons of highest rank have any hope of being selected by the
- Committee of 300. Sir Robert Hart, who for almost three decades
- was chief of the Imperial Chinese Customs Service (read the
- British Crown's number one agent in the opium trade in China
- was subsequently appointed to the board of Morgan Guarantee
- Bank's Far Eastern Division.
- Through access to the historical records in London and
- Hong Kong, I was able to establish that Sir Robert developed an
- intimate relationship with Morgan operations in the United
- States. It is worthy of note that Morgan interests in the opium/
- heroin trade have continued in an unbroken line; witness the
- fact that David Newbigging is on the advisory board of Morgan's
- Hong Kong operation run in conjunction with Jardine Matheson.
- To those who know Hong Kong, the name of Newbigging
- will be familiar as the most powerful name in Hong Kong. In
- addition to his membership of Morgan's elite bank, Newbigging
- doubles as an advisor to the Chinese government. Opium for
- missile technology, opium for gold, opium for high-tech com-
- puters--it is all the same to Newbigging. The way these banks
- financial houses, trading companies and the families who run
- them are intertwined would perplex Sherlock Holmes, yet
- somehow they must be unraveled and followed if we are to
- understand their connections with the drug trade and their
- membership in the Committee of 300.
- The two-track entry into the United States of alcohol and
-
- 138
-
- drugs were products of the same stable occupied by the same
- thoroughbreds. First, prohibition had to be introduced into the
- United States. This was done by the British East India Company
- heirs who, acting upon experience gained through the well-
- documented China Inland Mission records found in India House,
- set up the Women's Christian Temperance Union, supposedly to
- oppose consumption of alcohol in America.
- We say that history repeats itself, and in a sense, this is true.
- except that it repeats itself in an ever-upward spiral. Today we
- find that some of the largest companies, allegedly "polluting"
- the earth, are the largest contributors of funds to the environ-
- mentalist movement. The "big names" send forth their message.
- Prince Philip is one of their heroes, yet his son Prince Charles
- owns a million acres of forested land in Wales from which
- timber is regularly harvested and, in addition, Prince Charles is
- one of the largest owners of slum housing in London, where
- pollution thrives.
- In the case of those who railed against the "evils of drink,"
- we find they were financed by the Astors, the Rockefellers, the
- Spelmans, the Vanderbilts and the Warburgs who had a vested
- interest in the liquor trade. On the instructions of the Crown,
- Lord Beaverbrook came over from England to tell these wealthy
- American families that they were to invest in the WCTU. (It was
- the same Lord Beaverbrook who came to Washington in 1940
- and ORDERED Roosevelt to get involved in Britain's war.)
- Roosevelt complied by stationing a U.S. Navy flotilla in
- Greenland that spent the 9 months prior to Pearl Harbor hunting
- and attacking German U-Boats. Like his successor, George
- Bush, Roosevelt thought the Congress a confounded nuisance
- so, acting like a king-- sense he felt strongly since he is related
- to the British royal family--FDR never sought the permission of
- Congress for his illegal action. This is what the British are most
- fond of referring to as their "special relationship with America."
- The drug trade has a connection with the murder of Presi-
- dent John F. Kennedy, which foul deed stains the national
-
- 139
-
- character and will continue to do so until the perpetrators are
- found and brought to justice. There is proof that the Mafia was
- involved in this through the CIA, which brings to mind that it all
- started with the old Meyer Lansky network which evolved into
- the Irgun terrorist organization, and Lansky proved to be one of
- the best vehicles for peddling cultural warfare against the West.
- Lansky was, through more respectable fronts, associated
- with the British higher-ups in bringing gambling and dope
- distribution to Paradise Island in the Bahamas under the cover
- of The Mary Carter Paint Company--a joint Lansky-British
- M16 venture. Lord Sassoon was later murdered because he was
- skimming money and was threatening to blow the whistle if he
- was punished. Ray Wolfe was more presentable, representing
- the Bronfmans of Canada. While the Bronfmans were not privy
- to Churchill's massive Nova Scotia Project, they were and still
- are nevertheless an important asset of the British royal family in
- the business of dope peddling.
- Sam Rothberg, close associate of Meyer Lansky, also worked
- with Tibor Rosenbaum and Pinchas Sapir, all king pins in the
- Lansky drug ring. Rosenbaum ran a drug money laundering
- operation out of Switzerland through a bank he established for
- this purpose; Banque du Credite International. The bank quickly
- expanded its activities and became the principal bank used by
- Lansky and his mobster associates for laundering money garnered
- from prostitution, drugs and other Mafia rackets.
- It is worthy of note that Tibor Rosenbaum's bank was used
- by the shadowy chief of British Intelligence, Sir William
- Stephenson, whose right hand man, Major John Mortimer
- Bloomfield, a Canadian citizen, ran Division Five of the FBI
- throughout the Second World War. Stephenson was an early
- member of the 2Oth century Committee of 300, although
- Bloomfield never made it that far. As I revealed in my series of
- monographs on the Kennedy assassination, it was Stephenson
- who master-minded the operation which was run as a hands-on
- project by Bloomfield. Fronting for the Kennedy assassination
-
- 140
-
- was done through another drug-related front, Permanent Indus-
- trial Expositions (PERMINDEX), created in 1957 and centered
- in the World Trade Mart building in downtown New Orleans.
- Bloomfield just happened to be the attorney for the Bronfman
- family. The World Trade Mart was created by Colonel Clay
- Shaw and FBI Division Five station chief in New Orleans, Guy
- Bannister. Shaw and Bannister were close associates of Lee
- Harvey Oswald, accused of shooting Kennedy, who was mur-
- dered by CIA contract agent Jack Ruby before he could prove
- that he was not the assassin who shot President Kennedy. In
- spite of the Warren Commission and numerous official reports,
- it has NEVER been established that Oswald owned the
- Mannlicher rifle said to be the murder weapon (it was not) nor
- that he had ever fired it. The connection between the drug trade,
- Shaw, Bannister and Bloomfield has been established several
- times, and need not concern us here.
- In the immediate post-WW II period, one of the most com-
- mon methods used by Resorts International and other drug
- related companies to clean money was by courier service to a
- money laundering bank. Now all that has changed. Only the
- small fry still use such a risky method. The "big fish" conduit
- their money via the CHIPS system, an acronym for Clearing
- House International Payments System, run by a Burroughs
- computer system centered at the New York Clearing House.
- Twelve of the largest banks use this system. One of them is the
- Hong Kong and Shanghai Bank. Another is Credite Suisse, that
- oh so respectable paragon of virtue in banking--until the lid is
- lifted. Combined with the SWIFT system based in Virginia,
- dirty drug money becomes invisible. Only wanton carelessness
- results in the FBI getting lucky now and then, if and when it is
- told not to look the other way.
- Only low echelon drug dealers get caught with drug money
- in their hands. The elite, Drexel Burnham, Credite Suisse, Hong
- Kong and Shanghai Bank, escape detection. But this, too, is
- changing with the collapse of Bank of Credit and Commerce
-
- 141
-
- International (BCCI) which is likely to expose a great deal
- about the drug trade if ever a proper investigation is carried out.
- One of the largest assets in the portfolio of the Committee of
- 300 companies is American Express (AMEX). Its presidents
- regularly occupy positions on the Committee of 300. I first got
- interested in Amex when I was carrying out an on-the-spot
- investigation that led me to the Trade Development Bank in
- Geneva. Later, this got me into a lot of trouble. I discovered that
- Trade Development Bank, then run by Edmund Safra, key man
- in the gold for opium trade, was supplying tons of gold to the
- Hong Kong market via Trade Development Bank.
- Before going to Switzerland, I went to Pretoria, South Africa,
- where I talked with Dr. Chris Stals, at that time the deputy
- governor of the South African Reserve Bank which controls all
- bulk dealings in South African-produced gold. After several
- discussions over a period of a week, I was told that the bank
- could not supply me with the ten tons of gold that I was
- authorized to buy on behalf of clients I was supposed to be
- representing. My friends in the right places knew how to produce
- the documentation which passed without question.
- The Reserve Bank referred me to a Swiss company whom I
- cannot name, because it would blow cover. I was also given the
- address of Trade Development Bank in Geneva. The purpose of
- my exercise was to find out the mechanics of how gold is moved
- and traded, and secondly to test bogus documents which had been
- prepared for me by ex-intelligence friends of mine who special-
- ized in this kind of thing. Remember "M" in the "James Bond"
- series? Let me assure you that "M" does exist, only his correct
- initial is "C." The documents I had consisted of "buying orders"
- from Liechtenstein companies with supporting papers to match.
- On approaching Trade Development Bank I was at first
- greeted cordially but, as discussions progressed with more and
- more suspicion until, when I felt it was no longer safe for me to
- visit the bank, without telling anyone at the bank I left Geneva.
- Later the bank was sold to American Express. American Express
-
- 142
-
- was briefly investigated by former Attorney General Edwin
- Meese, after which he was quickly removed from office and
- labeled "corrupt." What I found was that American Express was
- and still is a conduit for laundering drug money and, thus far, no
- one has been able to explain to me why a private company has
- the right to print dollars--aren't American Express travelers
- checks dollars? I subsequently exposed the Safra-Amex drug
- connections which upset a lot of people, as can be imagined.
- Committee of 300 member Japhet controls Charterhouse
- Japhet, which in turn controls Jardine Matheson as a direct link
- to the Hong Kong opium trade. The Japhets are reportedly
- English Quakers. The Matheson family, also members of the
- Committee of 300, were kingpins in the China opium trade, at
- least up until 1943. The Mathesons have appeared in the Queen
- of England Honors List since the early 19th century.
- The top controllers of the drug trade in the Committee of
- 300 have no conscience about the millions of lives they ruin
- each year. They are Gnostics, Cathars, members of the cult of
- Dionysus, Osiris, or worse. To them, "ordinary" people are
- there to be used for their purposes. Their high-priests, Bulwer-
- Lytton and Aldous Huxley, preached the gospel of drugs as a
- beneficial substance. To quote Huxley:
-
- "And for private everyday use, there have always been
- chemical intoxicants. All the vegetable sedatives and
- narcotics, all the euphorics that grow on trees, the hal-
- lucinogens that ripen in berries, have been used by
- humans since time immemorial. And to these modifiers
- of conscience, modern science has added its quota of
- synthetics. For unrestricted use the West has permitted
- only alcohol and tobacco. All other chemical Doors in
- the Wall are labeled DOPE."
-
- To the oligarches and plutocrats of the Committee of 300,
- drugs have a two-fold purpose, firstly to bring in colossal sums
-
- 143
-
- of money and secondly, to eventually turn a major part of the
- population into mindless drug zombies who will be easier to
- control than people who don't need drugs, as punishment for
- rebellion will mean withholding of supplies of heroin, cocaine,
- marijuana, etc. For this it is necessary to legalize drugs so that a
- MONOPOLY SYSTEM, which has been readied for introduc-
- tion once severe economic conditions, of which the 1991 de-
- pression is the forerunner, cause drug usage to proliferate as
- hundreds of thousands of permanently jobless workers turn to
- drugs for solace.
- In one of the Royal Institute of International Affairs top
- secret papers, the scenario is laid out as follows (in part):
-
- "...having been failed by Christianity, and with unem-
- ployment on every hand, those who have been without
- jobs for five years or more will turn away from the
- church and seek solace in drugs. That is when full con-
- trol of the drug trade must be completed in order that the
- governments of all countries who are under our juris-
- diction will have a MONOPOLY which we will control
- through supply.... Drug bars will take care of the unruly
- and the discontent, would be revolutionaries will be
- turned into harmless addicts with no will of their own...."
-
- There is ample evidence that the CIA and British intelli-
- gence, specially M16, have already spent at least a decade
- working toward this goal.
- The Royal Institute of International Affairs used the life-
- time work of Aldous Huxley and Bulwer-Lytton as its blueprint
- to bring about a state where mankind will no longer have wills
- of their own in the One World Government-New World Order of
- the fast-approaching New Dark Age. Again, let us see what high
- priest Aldous Huxley had to say about this:
-
- "In many societies at many levels of civilization, attempts
-
- 144
-
- have been made to fuse drug intoxication with God
- intoxication. In ancient Greece, for example, ethyl alcohol
- had its place in the established religions. Dionysus,
- Bacchus, as he was often called, was a true divinity.
- Complete prohibition of chemical changes can be decreed
- but cannot be enforced. (THE LANGUAGE OF THE
- PRO-DRUG LOBBY ON CAPITOL HILL.)
-
- "Now let us consider another type of drug--still undis-
- covered, but probably just around the corner--a drug
- making people happy in situations where they would
- normally feel miserable. (Is there anyone more miserable
- than a person who has sought and been unable to find
- work?) Such a drug would be a blessing, but a blessing
- fraught with grave social and political dangers. By making
- a harmless chemical euphoria freely available, a dictator
- (read Committee of 300) could reconcile an entire
- population to a state of affairs to which self-respecting
- human beings ought not to be reconciled."
-
- Quite a dialectical masterpiece. What Huxley was advocat-
- ing and which is official policy of the Committee of 300 and its
- surrogate, RIIA, can be quite simply stated as mass mind control.
- As I have often said, all wars are wars for the souls of mankind.
- Thus far it has not dawned on us that the drug trade is irregular
- low-intensity warfare against the whole human race of free
- men. Irregular warfare is the most terrible form of warfare
- which, while it has a beginning, has no ending.
- Some will question the involvement of the British royal
- families, past and present, in the drug trade. To see it in print
- appears on the surface to be preposterous, and it is being seen in
- print more often these days to make it appear exactly that,
- preposterous. The oldest maxim in the intelligence business is,
- "If you want to hide something, put it where everyone can see it.
- F. S. Turner's book, "BRITISH OPIUM POLICY," pub-
-
- 145
-
- lished in 1876, shows how the British monarchy and its hang-
- ers-on family relatives were deeply involved in the opium trade.
- Turner was the secretary of the Anglo Oriental Society of the
- Suppression of the Opium Trade. He declined to be silenced by
- Crown spokesperson Sir R. Temple. Turner stated that the gov-
- ernment, and therefore the Crown, had to withdraw from the
- opium monopoly, "and if it takes any revenues at all, take only
- that which accrues from taxation honestly meant to have a
- restrictive force. "
- Turner was answered by a spokesman for the monarchy,
- Lord Lawrence, who fought against the BEIC losing its mo-
- nopoly. "It would be desirable to get rid of the monopoly, but I
- myself am disinclined to be the agent of change. If it is
- question of moderate loss that we could afford, I would not
- hesitate to undertake it." (Taken from the Calcutta Papers 1870.)
- By 1874 the war against the British monarchy and the
- aristocracy over its deep involvement in the China opium trade
- was getting heated. The Society for the Suppression of the
- Opium Trade violently assailed the aristocracy of the day and
- pressed home its attacks in a fearless manner we would do well
- to emulate. The society said that the Treaty of Tientsin, which
- Forced China to accept the importation of enormous amounts of
- opium, was a dastardly crime against the Chinese people.
- There arose a mighty warrior, Joseph Grundy Alexander, a
- barrister by profession who, in 1866, led a strong attack on
- British Crown opium policy in China in which he openly men-
- tioned the involvement of the royal family and the aristocracy.
- For the first time Alexander brought India, "the Jewel in the
- Crown," into the picture. He laid the blame squarely where it
- belonged, on the monarchy, the so-called aristocracy and its
- servants in the British government.
- Under the direction of Alexander, the society committed
- itself to the total destruction of the cultivation of opium poppies
- in Bengal, India. Alexander proved to be a doughty opponent.
- Through his leadership, the drug aristocracy began to falter and,
-
- 146
-
- in the face of his open denouncements of the royal family and its
- hangers-on, several Members of Parliament began siding with
- him Conservatives, Unionists, Labor. Alexander made it clear
- that the drug trade was not a party political issue; it was for all
- parties to join together in helping to eradicate the menace.
- Lord Kimberly, spokesman for the royal family and the
- entrenched oligarchists, threatened that any attempts to interfere
- with what he called "the commerce of the nation will run into
- serious opposition from the cabinet." Alexander and his society
- pressed on in the face of innumerable threats and finally parlia-
- ment agreed to appoint a Royal Commission to enquire into the
- opium trade, with Lord Kimberly, who was Secretary of India,
- as its chairman. A more inappropriate person to head the com-
- mission could not have been found. It was akin to Dulles being
- appointed to the Warren Commission.
- In his first statement, Lord Kimberly made it clear that he
- would rather resign from his august position than consent to a
- resolution that would surrender Indian Opium Revenues. It is
- worthy of note that "Indian Opium Revenue" implied money
- shared by the nation. Like the idea that the people of South
- Africa share in the enormous profits from the sale of gold and
- diamonds, this was just not the case. Indian opium revenues
- went straight into the royal coffers and the pockets of the
- nobility and the oligarchists and plutocrats, and made them
- billionaires.
- Rowntree's book, "THE IMPERIAL DRUG TRADE" gives
- a fascinating account of how Prime Minister Gladstone and his
- fellow plutocrats lied, cheated, twisted and turned to keep the
- astonishing truth of the involvement of the British monarchy in
- the opium trade from being exposed. Rowntree's book is a
- treasure house of information on the deep involvement of the
- British royal family and the lords and ladies of England and the
- huge fortunes they accumulated from the misery of the Chinese
- opium addicts.
- Lord Kimberly, secretary of the commission of inquiry, was
-
- 147
-
- himself deeply involved in the opium trade so he did everything
- in his power to close the proceedings to all who sought the truth.
- Finally, under a great deal of pressure from the public, the Royal
- Commission was forced to open the door to this inquiry just a
- crack, so that it became apparent that the highest in the land
- were running the opium trade and receiving huge benefits from
- it. But the door was quickly slammed shut again, and the Royal
- Commission called no expert witnesses, thereafter sitting for an
- absurdly short period of time. The commission was nothing but
- a farce and a cover-up, such as we have become accustomed to
- in 20th century America.
- The Eastern Liberal Establishment families of the United
- States were just as deeply involved in the China opium trade as
- were the British, indeed they still are. Witness recent history
- when James Earl Carter toppled the Shah of Iran. Why was the
- Shah deposed and then murdered by the United States govern-
- ment? fn a word, because of DRUGS. The Shah had clamped
- down and virtually put an end to the immensely lucrative opium
- trade being conducted out of Iran by the British. At the time that
- the Shah took over in Iran, there were already one million
- opium/heroin addicts.
- This the British would not tolerate, so they sent the United
- States to do their dirty work for them in terms of the "special
- relationship" between the two countries. When Khomeini took
- over the U.S. Embassy in Teheran, arms sales by the United
- States, which had begun with the Shah, were not discontinued.
- Why not? Had the United States done so, Khomeini would have
- canceled the British monopoly of the opium trade in his country.
- To prove the point, after 1984, Khomeini's liberal attitude toward
- opium had increased the number of addicts to 2 million, according
- to United Nations and World Health Organization statistics.
- Both President Carter and his successor, Ronald Reagan,
- willingly and with full knowledge of what was at stake, went on
- supplying arms to Iran even while American hostages languished
- in captivity. In 1980 I wrote a monograph under the title, "What
-
- 148
-
- Really Happened in Iran," which set out the facts. The arms
- trade with Iran was sealed at a meeting between Cyrus Vance, a
- servant of the Committee of 300, and Dr. Hashemi, which
- resulted in the U.S. Air Force beginning an immediate airlift of
- arms to Iran, carried on even at the height of the hostage crisis
- the arms came from U.S. Army stockpiles in Germany and
- some were even flown directly from the United States with
- refueling stops at the Azores.
- With the advent of Khomeini, who was put in power in Iran
- by the Committee of 300, opium production skyrocketed. By
- 1984 Iran's opium production exceeded 650 metric tons of
- opium per annum. What Carter and Reagan did was ensure that
- there was no further interference in the opium trade and they
- carried out the mandate given to them by the oligarchical fami-
- lies in Britain in this connection. Iran presently rivals the Golden
- Triangle in the volume of opium produced.
- The Shah was not the only victim of the Committee of 300
- William Buckley, CIA station chief in Beirut, in all his lack of
- experience on who is behind the opium trade, began conducting
- investigations in Iran, Lebanon and even spent time in Pakistan.
- From Islamabad, Buckley began sending back damning reports
- to the CIA in Langley about the burgeoning opium trade in the
- Golden Crescent and Pakistan. The U.S. Embassy in Islamabad
- was firebombed, but Buckley escaped the mob attack and re-
- turned to Washington because his cover was blown by forces
- unknown.
- Then a very strange thing happened. Contrary to all proce-
- dures laid down by the CIA when an agent's cover has been
- blown, Buckley was sent back to Beirut. Buckley was in effect
- sentenced to death by the CIA in order to silence him, and this
- time the sentence was carried out. William Buckley was kidnaped
- by agents of the Committee of 300. Under brutal interrogation
- by General Mohammed el Khouili of Syrian intelligence to
- force him to disclose the names of all field officers of the DEA
- in these countries, he was brutally murdered. His efforts to
-
- 149
-
- expose the huge opium trade developing out of Pakistan, Leba-
- non and Iran cost Buckley his life.
- If the remaining free men in this world believe that
- singlehandedly or in small groups they can smash the drug
- trade, they are sorely mistaken. They could cut off the tentacles
- of the opium and cocaine trade here and there, but never the
- head. The crowned cobras of Europe and their Eastern Liberal
- Establishment family will not tolerate it. The war on drugs
- which the Bush administration is allegedly fighting, but which it
- is not, is for TOTAL legalization of ALL types and classes of
- drugs. Such drugs are not solely a social aberration, but a full-
- scale attempt to gain control of the minds of the people of this
- planet, or as the "Aquarian Conspiracy" authors put it, "to bring
- about radical changes in the United States." THIS IS THE
- PRINCIPAL TASK OF THE COMMITTEE OF 300, THE
- ULTIMATE SECRET SOCIETY.
- Nothing has changed in the opium-heroin-cocaine trade. It
- is still run by the same "upper class" families in Britain and the
- United States. It is still a fabulously profitable trade where what
- seem to be big losses through seizures by the authorities are
- written off in paneled boardrooms in New York, Hong Kong and
- London over port and cigars as "merely the cost of doing
- business, old boy."
- British colonial capitalism has always been the mainstay of
- the oligarchical feudal system of privilege in England and remains
- so to the present day. When the poor, untutored pastoral people
- in South Africa who became known as the Boers fell into the
- bloodstained hands of the British aristocracy in 1899, they had
- no idea that the revoltingly cruel war so relentlessly pursued by
- Queen Victoria, was financed by the incredible amounts of
- money which came from the "instant fortunes" of the BEIC
- opium trade in China into the pockets of the plutocrats.
- Committee of 300 members Cecil John Rhodes, Barney
- Barnato and Alfred Beit instigated and engineered the war.
- Rhodes was the principle agent for the Rothschilds, whose
-
- 150
-
- banks were awash in cash flowing from the opium trade.
- These robbers, thieves and liars--Rhodes, Barnato,
- Oppenheimer, Joel and Beit--dispossessed the South African
- Boers of their birthright, the gold and diamonds that lay beneath
- their soil. The South African Boers received nothing out of the
- BILLIONS UPON BILLIONS of dollars derived from the sale
- of THEIR gold and diamonds.
- The Committee of 300 quickly took full control of these vast
- treasures, control which it even now maintains through one of
- its members, Sir Harry Oppenheimer. The average South African
- receives $100 per annum per capita from the gold and diamond
- industry. The BILLIONS which flow out annually go to the
- bankers of the Committee of 300. It is one of the most foul and
- vile stories of greed, theft and the murder of a nation ever
- recorded in the annals of history.
- How could the British Crown have succeeded in pulling off
- this stunning fraud of gigantic proportion? To accomplish such
- a Herculean task requires skilled organizing with devoted agents-
- in-place to carry out the daily instructions passed down from the
- conspirators' hierarchy. The first step was a press propaganda
- campaign portraying the Boers as uncivilized barbarians, only
- slightly human, who were denying British citizens the right to
- vote in the Boer Republic. Then, demands were made on Paul
- Kruger, leader of the Transvaal Republic, which of course could
- not be met. After that, a series of incidents were staged to
- provoke the Boers into retaliation, but that didn't work either.
- Then came the infamous Jameson Raid where a certain Jameson
- led a party of several hundred armed men in an attack on the
- transvaal. War followed immediately thereafter.
- Queen Victoria mounted the largest and best equipped army
- that the world had ever seen at that time ( 1898). Victoria thought
- he war would be over in two weeks, since the Boers had no
- standing army and no trained militia and would be no match for
- her 400,000 soldiers drawn from the ranks of Britain's
- underclasses. The Boers never numbered more than 80,000
-
- 151
-
- farmers and their sons--some were as young as fourteen--
- Rudyard Kipling also thought the war would be over in less than
- a week.
- Instead, with rifle in one hand and the Bible in the other, the
- Boers held out for three years. "We went to South Africa think-
- ing the war would be over in a week," said Kipling. "Instead, the
- Boers taught us no end of a lesson." That same "lesson" could
- be taught to the Committee of 300 today if we could but muster
- 10,000 leaders, good men and true to lead this nation in battle
- against the gargantuan monster threatening to devour everything
- our Constitution stands for.
- After the war ended in 1902, the British Crown had to
- consolidate its grip on the unimaginable fortune of gold and
- diamonds that lay beneath the barren veldt of the Boer Repub-
- lics of Transvaal and Orange Free State. This was done through
- the Round Table of the legend of King Arthur and his Knights.
- The Round Table is strictly a British M16 intelligence operation
- established by the Committee of 300 which, together with the
- Rhodes Scholarship program, is a dagger in the heartland of America.
- The Round Table was established in South Africa by Cecil
- Rhodes and funded by the English Rothschild family. Its pur-
- pose was to train business leaders loyal to the British Crown
- who would secure the vast gold and diamond treasures for the
- British Crown. South Africans had their birthright stolen from
- them in a coup so massive and all pervading that it was apparent
- only a central unified command could have pulled it off. That
- unified command was the Committee of 300.
- That this was accomplished is not in dispute. By the early
- 1930's, the British Crown had a stranglehold on the biggest
- supplies of gold and diamonds ever found in the world. NOW
- THE COMMITTEE OF 300 HAD AT ITS DISPOSAL BOTH
- THE VAST FORTUNE COMING FROM THE DRUG TRADE
- AND THE EQUALLY VAST FORTUNE OF THE MINERAL
- AND METAL WEALTH OF SOUTH AFRICA. Financial con-
- trol of the world was complete.
-
- 152
-
- The Round Table played a pivotal role in the coup. The
- express purpose of the Round Table, after swallowing up South
- Africa, was to blunt the benefits to the United States of the
- American War of Independence, and once more bring the United
- States under British control. Organizing ability was essential for
- such an enterprise and it was provided by Lord Alfred Milner,
- protege of the London Rothschild family. Using Scottish Rite
- Freemason principles in selecting members of Round Table,
- chose chosen underwent a period of intense training at Cambridge
- and Oxford Universities under the watchful eyes of John Ruskin,
- a self-confessed "old school communist," and T. H. Green, an
- operative of M16.
- It was Green, the son of a Christian evangelical cleric, who
- spawned Rhodes, Milner, John Wheeler Bennet, A. D. Lindsay,
- George Bernard Shaw and Hjalmar Schacht, Hitler's finance
- minister. I pause here to remind readers that the Round Table is
- only ONE SECTOR of this vast and all-encompassing Commit-
- tee of 300. Yet the Round Table itself consists of a maze of
- companies, institutions, banks and educational establishments,
- which in itself would take qualified insurance actuaries a year to
- sort out.
- Round Tablers fanned out throughout the world to take
- control of fiscal and monetary policies and political leadership
- in all countries where they operated. In South Africa, General
- Smuts, who had fought against the British in the Boer War, was
- "turned" and became a leading British intelligence, military and
- political agent who espoused the cause of the British Crown. In
- the United States, in later years, the task of boring away at the
- United States from the inside fell to William Yandell Elliot, the
- man who spawned Henry Kissinger and who was responsible
- for his meteoric rise to power as chief U.S. advisor to the
- Committee of 300.
- William Yandell Elliot was "an American at Oxford," who
- had already served the Committee of 300 well, which is a
- prerequisite for higher office in the service of the committee.
-
- 153
-
-
- <<<<< cont in Committee of 300 - part 7 >>>>>
-
-
- --
- <*> Don Allen <*> 1:363/81.1 - Fidonet #1 - Homebody BBS
- dona@bilver.uucp - Internet 1:363/29.8 - Fidonet #2 - Gourmet Delight
- 88:4205/1.1 - MUFON Network 1:3607/20.2 -- Odyssey - Alabama UFO Net
- NSA grep food: Aviary, Ed Dames, Los Alamos - Majestic - Jason - RIIA - UN
-
- Path: igor.rutgers.edu!rutgers!jvnc.net!darwin.sura.net!wupost!uunet!peora!tarpit!tous!bilver!dona
- From: dona@bilver.uucp (Don Allen)
- Newsgroups: alt.conspiracy
- Subject: FILE: Committee of 300 - Part 7
- Message-ID: <1992Nov15.195515.27391@bilver.uucp>
- Date: 15 Nov 92 19:55:15 GMT
- Organization: W. J. Vermillion - Winter Park, FL
- Lines: 925
-
-
- --- Committee of 300 - Part 7 ------------------------------------------
-
-
- Copyright (C) 1992 by Dr. John Coleman
-
- Conspirators' Hierarchy: The Story of the Committee of 300", by
- Dr. John Coleman, is reproduced here with the permission of the
- publisher: America West Publishers.
-
- INSTITUTIONS THROUGH WHICH
-
- CONTROL IS EXERCISED
- (Cont.)
-
- After graduating from Vanderbilt University in 1917, Elliot was
- drafted by the Rothschild-Warburg banking network. He worked
- at the Federal Reserve Bank in San Francisco and rose to be a
- director. From there he acted as a Warburg-Rothschild intelli-
- gence officer, reporting on the important areas of the United
- States he was overseeing. Elliot's "Freemason" talent spotters
- recommended him for a Rhodes Scholarship and, in 1923, he
- went to Balliol College at Oxford University whose "dreaming
- spires" hid a network of intrigue and future traitors to the West.
- Balliol College was, and still is, the center of recruiting for
- the Round Table. After a thorough brainwashing conducted by
- the Tavistock Institute of Human Relations representative, A.D.
- Lindsay, who had succeeded Master of Balliol T. H. Green,
- Elliot was received into the Round Table and sent to The Royal
- Institute of International Affairs to be given his assignment,
- which was that he return to the United States to become a leader
- in the academic community.
- The Round Table's driving philosophy was to have Round
- Tablers in positions to formulate and carry out social policies
- through social institutions whereby what Ruskin called "the
- masses" could be manipulated. Members infiltrated the highest
- levels of banking after under going a course at the Tavistock
- Institute. The course was drawn up by Lord Leconsfield, an
- intimate of the British royal family, and later run by Robert
- Brand who went on to manage Lazard Freres. The Royal Insti-
- tute of International Affairs was and remains totally interfaced
- with the British monarchy.
- Some of the spinoffs of the Round Table are the Bilderbergers,
- set up and run by Duncan Sandys, a prominent politician and
- son-in-law of the late Winston Churchill, the Ditchley Founda-
- tion, a secret banker's club which I exposed in my 1983 work,
- "International Banker's Conspiracy: The Ditchley Foundation,"
- the Trilateral Commission, the Atlantic Council of the United
- States and the Aspen Institute for Humanistic Studies, whose
- well-hidden, behind the scenes founder was Lord Bullock of the
-
- 154
-
- RIIA for whom Robert Anderson fronted.
- The way in which Henry Kissinger, the RllA's chief asset in
- the United States, came to power is a story of the triumph of the
- institution of the British monarchy over the Republic of the
- United States of America. It is a tale of horror, too long to be
- included here. Nevertheless, it would be remiss of me if I did not
- mention just a few of the highlights of Kissinger's rise to fame,
- fortune and power.
- After a stint in the United States Army, beginning with the job
- of driving General Fritz Kraemer around war-torn Germany,
- thanks to the Oppenheimer family Kissinger was picked to attend
- Wilton Park for further training. At the time he held the rank of
- private first class. In 1952 Kissinger was sent to the Tavistock
- Institute where R. V. Dicks took him in hand and turned him
- inside out. Thereafter there was no holding Kissinger back. He
- was later drafted to serve under George Franklin and Hamilton
- Fish of the Council on Foreign Relations' New York office.
- It is believed that the official nuclear policy adopted by the
- United States was delivered to Kissinger during his stay at
- Tavistock and further shaped by his participation in "Nuclear
- Weapons and Foreign Policy," a Round Table seminar which
- brought forth the doctrine known as "flexible response," a total
- irrationality, which became known by the acronym MAD.
- Thanks to William Yandell Elliot and under the tutelage of
- John Wheeler Bennett, top intelligence director of the Round
- Table and chief of MI6 field operations in the United States,
- Kissinger became Elliot's "favorite son" as he explained in his
- book, "The Pragmatic Revolt in Politics." Kissinger was co-
- opted into the Round Table to push monetarist policies he
- studied at Harvard International Seminars.
- Kissinger avidly absorbed Elliot's teachings and was no
- longer recognizable as the man General Kraemer once described
- as "my little Jew-boy driver." Kissinger was inculcated with the
- spirit of the Master of Balliol, becoming an ardent disciple of
- decadent British aristocracy. Adopting the philosophies of
-
- 155
-
- Toynbee, chief intelligence director for MI6 at the Royal Insti-
- tute of International Affairs, Kissinger used its papers to write
- his undergraduate "dissertation."
- By the mid 1960's Kissinger had proved his worth to the
- Round Table and the RIIA, and thus to the British monarchy. As
- a reward and a test of what he had learned, Kissinger was placed
- in charge of a small group consisting of James Schlessinger,
- Alexander Haig and Daniel Ellsberg. The Round Table was
- using to conduct a series of experiments. Cooperating with this
- group was the Institute of Policy Studies chief theoretician
- Noam Chomsky.
- Haig, like Kissinger, worked for General Kraemer, albeit
- not as a driver, and the general found a number of varied
- openings in the Department of Defense for his protege. Once
- Kissinger was installed as National Security Advisor, Kraemer
- got Haig the job as his deputy. Ellsberg, Haig, and Kissinger
- then set in motion the RIIA's Watergate plan to oust President
- Nixon for disobeying direct instructions. Haig played the lead
- role in brainwashing and confusing President Nixon, and in
- effect it was Kissinger who ran the White House during this
- softening up of the President. As I mentioned in 1984, Haig was
- the White House go-between known as "Deep Throat," passing
- information to the Washington Post team of Woodward and
- Bernstein.
- The Watergating of Nixon was the biggest coup yet pulled
- off by the Round Table as an agency and an arm of the RIIA. All
- the tangled threads led back to the Round Table; from there to
- the RIIA, and right back to the Queen of England. The humilia-
- tion of Nixon was an object lesson and a warning to future
- Presidents of the United States not to imagine they could go
- against the Committee of 300 and win. Kennedy was brutally
- murdered in full view of the American people for the same
- reason; Nixon was not considered worthy enough to suffer the
- same fate as John F. Kennedy.
- But whatever the method used, the Committee of 300 made
-
- 156
-
- sure that all would-be aspirants for the White House got the
- message: "Nobody is beyond our reach." That this message
- remains just as forceful as it was when Kennedy was murdered
- and Nixon hounded out of office, is evidenced by the character
- of President George Bush, whose eagerness to please his mas-
- ters should be cause for grave concern among those who worry
- about the future of the United States.
- The purpose of the exercise was made clear in the Pentagon
- Papers episode and the drafting of Schlessinger into the Nixon
- Administration to act as a spoiler in the defense establishment
- and a counterforce to the development of atomic energy, which
- role Schlessinger carried out from the shelter of his position in
- the Atomic Energy Commission, one of the key factors in
- deindustrializing the United States in the planned Club of Rome
- Post Industrial-Zero-growth strategies. From this beginning we
- can trace the roots of the 1991 recession/depression which has
- thus far cost the jobs of 30 million Americans.
- It is virtually impossible to penetrate the Committee of 300
- and the oligarchical families that go to make it up. The camou-
- flage they pull over themselves as protective covering is very
- hard to rip off. This fact should be noted by every freedom-
- loving American: The Committee of 300 dictates what passes
- for United States foreign and domestic policies and has done so
- for over 200 years. Nowhere was this more strikingly portrayed
- than when a cocky President Truman had the wind knocked out
- of him by Churchill ramrodding the so-called "Truman Doctrine"
- down the throat of the little man from Independence, Missouri.
- Some of their former members, whose descendants filled
- vacancies caused by death, and present members include Sir
- Mark Turner, Gerald Villiers, Samuel Montague, the Inchcapes,
- Keswicks, Peases, Schroeders, Airlies, Churchills, Frasers, Lazars
- and Jardine Mathesons. The full list of members is presented
- elsewhere in this book; these people on the Committee OR-
- DERED President Wilson to go to war against Germany in the
- First World War; this Committee ordered Roosevelt to engineer
-
- 157
-
- the Japanese attack on Pearl Harbor with the object of getting
- the United States into the Second World War.
- These people, this Committee, ordered this nation to war in
- Korea, Vietnam and the Persian Gulf. The plain truth is that the
- United States has fought in 5 wars this century for and on behalf
- of the infamous Committee of 300. It seems that, apart from just
- a few, no one has stopped to ask, "WHY ARE WE FIGHTING
- THESE WARS?" The big drum of "patriotism," martial music
- and waving flags and yellow ribbons, it seems, caused a great
- nation to become bereft of its senses.
- On the 50th anniversary of Pearl Harbor, a new "hate Japan"
- campaign is being waged, not by the Institute of Pacific Relations
- (IPR), but in the most direct and brazen manner by the Bush
- Administration and the Congress. The object is the same as it
- was when Roosevelt inspired the attack on Pearl Harbor, paint
- the Japanese as aggressors and wage economic war, then ready
- our forces for the next phase--armed aggression against Japan.
- This is already in the works; it is only a matter of time before
- more of our sons and daughters are sent off to be slaughtered in
- the service of the feudal lords of the Committee of 300. We
- ought to shout from the housetops, "It is not for freedom nor for
- love of country that we are going to die, but for a system of
- tyranny that will shortly envelope the entire world."
- So tight is the grip of this organization on Britain that 95%
- of British citizens have, since the 1700's, been forced to accept
- as their share, less than 20% of the national wealth of the
- country. This is what the oligarchical feudal lords of England
- like to call "democracy." These nice, proper English gentlemen
- are, in reality, utterly ruthless--what they did in India, Sudan,
- Egypt, Iraq, Iran and Turkey will be repeated in every country
- under the New World Order-One World Government. They will
- use every nation and its wealth to protect their privileged way of
- life. It is this class of British aristocracy whose fortunes are
- inextricably woven and intertwined with the drug trade, the
- gold, diamond and arms trades, banking, commerce and industry,
-
- 158
-
- oil, the news media and entertainment industry.
- Apart from the rank and file of the Labour Party (but not its
- leaders), the majority of British political leaders are descendants
- of titled families, the titles being hereditary and handed down
- from father to eldest son. This system ensures that no "outside-
- ers" aspire to political power in England. Nevertheless, some
- aliens have been able to squeeze their way in.
- Take the case of Lord Halifax, former British Ambassador to
- Washington and the man who delivered Committee of 300
- orders to our government during the Second World War. Halifax's
- son, Charles Wood, married a Miss Primrose, a blood relative of
- Lord Rothschild. Behind such names as Lord Swaythling is
- hidden the name of Montague, director of the Bank of England
- and adviser and confidant of the majority stockholder of the
- Shell Oil Company, Queen Elizabeth II. All are members of the
- Committee of 300. Some of the old barriers have been broken
- down. Title is today not the only criteria for admission to the
- Club of Rome.
- It is appropriate to provide an overview of what the Com-
- mittee of 300 hopes to achieve, what its aims and objectives are
- before we proceed to its vast, far flung interlocking interfacing
- of banks, insurance companies, corporations, etc. The following
- information has taken years of investigative research to put together
- from hundreds of documents and sources of mine who gave me
- access to some of the papers in which the details are hidden.
- The Committee of 300 consists of certain individuals special-
- ists in their own fields, including cultus diabolicus, mind altering
- drugs, and specialists in murder by poison, intelligence; banking,
- and every facet of commercial activity. It will be necessary to
- mention former members since deceased, because of their former
- roles and because their places were given to family members of
- new members considered worthy of the honor.
- Included in the membership are the old families of the
- European Black Nobility, the American Eastern Liberal Estab-
- lishment (in Freemason hierarchy and the Order of Skull and
-
- 159
-
-
- Bone), the Illuminati, or as it is known by the Committee
- "MORIAH CONQUERING WIND," the Mumma Group, The
- National and World Council of Churches, the Circle of Initiates,
- the Nine Unknown Men, Lucis Trust, Jesuit Liberation
- Theologists, The Order of the Elders of Zion, the Nasi Princes,
- International Monetary Fund (IMF), the Bank of International
- Settlements (BIS), the United Nations (U.N.), the Central, British
- Quator Coronati, Italian P2 Masonry--especially those in the
- Vatican hierarchy--the Central Intelligence Agency, Tavistock
- Institute selected personnel, various members of leading foun-
- dations and insurance companies named in the lists that follow,
- the Hong Kong and Shanghai Bank, the Milner Group-Round
- Table, Cini Foundation, German Marshall Fund, Ditchley
- Foundation, NATO, Club of Rome, Environmentalists, The Or-
- der of St. John of Jerusalem, One World Government Church,
- Socialist International, Black Order, Thule Society, Anenherbe-
- Rosicrucianists, The Great Superior Ones and literally HUN-
- DREDS of other organizations.
- What then are we looking at? A loosely-knit gathering of
- people with weird ideas? Certainly not. In the Committee of 300,
- which has a 150-year history, we have some of the most brilliant
- intellects assembled to form a completely totalitarian, absolutely
- controlled "new" society only it isn't new, having drawn most
- of its ideas from the Clubs of Cultus Diabolicus. It strives toward
- a One World Government rather well described by one of its late
- members, H. G. Wells, in his work commissioned by the Com-
- mittee which Wells boldly called: "THE OPEN CONSPIRACY--
- PLANS FOR A WORLD REVOLUTION."
- It was a bold statement of intent, but not really so bold since
- nobody believed Wells except the Great Superior Ones, the
- Anenherbes and those who were what we would call "insiders"
- today. Here is an extract of what Wells proposed:
-
- "The Open Conspiracy will appear first, I believe as a
- conscious organization of intelligent, and in some cases
-
- 160
-
- wealthy men, as a movement having distinct social and
- political aims, confessedly ignoring most of the existing
- apparatus of political control, or using it only as an
- incidental implement in the stages, a mere movement of
- a number of people in a certain direction, who will
- presently discover, with a sort of a surprise, the common
- object toward which they are all moving. In all sorts of
- ways, they will be influencing and controlling the os-
- tensible government."
-
- Like George Orwell's 1984, Wells'account is a mass-appeal
- for a One World Government. Summarized, the intent and pur-
- pose of the Committee of 300 is to bring to pass the following
- conditions:
- A One World Government and one-unit monetary system
- under permanent non-elected hereditary oligarchists who self
- select from among their numbers in the form of a feudal system
- as it was in the Middle Ages. In this One World entity, popula-
- tion will be limited by restrictions on the number of children per
- family, diseases, wars, famines, until 1 billion people who are
- useful to the ruling class, in areas which will be strictly and
- clearly defined, remain as the total world population.
- There will be no middle class, only rulers and servants. All
- laws will be uniform under a legal system of world courts
- practicing the same unified code of laws, backed up by a One
- World Government police force and a One World unified military
- to enforce laws in all former countries where no national bound-
- aries shall exist. The system will be on the basis of a welfare state;
- those who are obedient and subservient to the One World Gov-
- ernment will be rewarded with the means to live; those who are
- rebellious will simply be starved to death or be declared outlaws,
- thus a target for anyone who wishes to kill them. Privately owned
- firearms or weapons of any kind will be prohibited.
- Only one religion will be allowed and that will be in the
- form of a One World Government Church, which has been in
-
- 161
-
- existence since 1920 as we shall see. Satanism, Luciferianism
- and Witchcraft shall he recognized as legitimate One World
- Government curricula with no private or church schools. All
- Christian churches have already been subverted and Christian-
- ity will be a thing of the past in the One World Government.
- To induce a state where there is no individual freedom or
- any concept of liberty surviving, there shall be no such thing as
- republicanism, sovereignty or rights residing with the people.
- National pride and racial identity shall be stamped out and in the
- transition phase it shall be subject to the severest penalties to
- even mention one's racial origin.
- Each person shall be fully indoctrinated that he or she is a
- creature of the One World Government with an identification
- number clearly marked on their person so as to be readily
- accessible, which identifying number shall be in the master file
- of the NATO computer in Brussels, Belgium, subject to instant
- retrieval by any agency of the One World Government at any
- time. The master Files of the CIA, FBI, state and local police
- agencies, IRS, FEMA, Social Security shall be vastly expanded
- and form the basis of personal records of all individuals in the
- United States.
- Marriage shall be outlawed and there shall be no family life
- as we know it. Children will be removed from their parents at an
- early-age and brought up by wards as state property. Such an
- experiment was carried out in East Germany under Erich
- Honnecker when children were take away from parents consid-
- ered by the state to be disloyal citizens. Women will he degraded
- through the continued process of "women's liberation" move-
- ments. Free sex shall be mandatory.
- Failure to comply at least once by the age of 20 shall be
- punishable by severe reprisals against her person. Self-abortion
- shall be taught and practiced after two children are born to a
- woman; such records shall be contained in the personal file of
- each woman in the One World Government's regional comput-
- ers. If a woman falls pregnant after she has previously given
-
- 162
-
- birth to two children, she shall be forcibly removed to an abor-
- tion clinic for such an abortion and sterilization to be carried out
- Pornography shall be promoted and be compulsory showing
- in every theater of cinema, including homosexual and lesbian
- pornography. The use of "recreational" drugs shall be compul-
- sory, with each person allotted drug quotas which can be pur-
- chased at One World Government stores throughout the world.
- Mind control drugs will be expanded and usage become com-
- pulsory. Such mind control drugs shall be given in food and/or
- water supplies without the knowledge and/or consent of the
- people. Drug bars shall be set up, run by One World Government
- employees, where the slave-class shall be able to spend their
- free time. In this manner the non-elite masses will be reduced to
- the level and behavior of controlled animals with no will of their
- own and easily regimented and controlled.
- The economic system shall be based upon the ruling oligar-
- ethical class allowing just enough foods and services to be
- produced to keep the mass slave labor camps going. All wealth
- shall be aggregated in the hands of the elite members of the
- Committee of 300. Each individual shall be indoctrinated to
- understand that he or she is totally dependent upon the state for
- survival. The world shall be ruled by Committee of 300 Executive
- Decrees which become instant law. Boris Yeltsin is using Com-
- mittee of 300 decrees to impose the Committee's will on Russia
- as a trial run. Courts of punishment and not courts of justice
- shall exist.
- Industry is to be totally destroyed along with nuclear powered
- energy systems. Only the Committee of 300 members and their
- elitists shall have the right to any of the earth's resources.
- Agriculture shall be solely in the hands of the Committee of 300
- with food production strictly controlled. As these measures
- begin to take effect, large populations in the cities shall be
- forcibly removed to remote areas and those who refuse to go
- shall be exterminated in the manner of the One World Govern-
- ment experiment carried out by Pol Pot in Cambodia.
-
- 163
-
- Euthanasia for the terminally ill and the aged shall be com-
- pulsory. No cities shall be larger than a predetermined number
- as described in the work of Kalgeri. Essential workers will be
- moved to other cities if the one they are in becomes overpopu-
- lated. Other non-essential workers will be chosen at random and
- sent to underpopulated cities to fill "quotas."
- At least 4 billion "useless eaters" shall be eliminated by the
- year 2050 by means of limited wars, organized epidemics of
- fatal rapid-acting diseases and starvation. Energy, food and
- water shall be kept at subsistence levels for the non-elite, start-
- ing with the White populations of Western Europe and North
- America and then spreading to other races. The population of
- Canada, Western Europe and the United States will be decimated
- more rapidly than on other continents, until the world's population
- reaches a manageable level of 1 billion, of which 500 million
- will consist of Chinese and Japanese races, selected because
- they are people who have been regimented for centuries and
- who are accustomed to obeying authority without question.
- From time to time there shall be artificially contrived food
- and water shortages and medical care to remind the masses that
- their very existence depends on the goodwill of the Committee
- of 300.
- After the destruction of housing, auto, steel and heavy goods
- industries, there shall he limited housing, and industries of any
- kind allowed to remain shall be under the direction of NATO's
- Club of Rome as shall all scientific and space exploration
- development, limited to the elite under the control of the Com-
- mittee of 300. Space weapons of all former nations shall be
- destroyed along with nuclear weapons.
- All essential and non-essential pharmaceutical products,
- doctors, dentists and health care workers will be registered in
- the central computer data bank and no medicine or medical care
- will he prescribed without express permission of regional con-
- trollers responsible for each city, town and village.
- The United States will be flooded by peoples of alien cultures
-
- 164
-
- who will eventually overwhelm White America, people with no
- concept of what the United States Constitution stands for and
- who will, in consequence, do nothing to defend it, and in whose
- minds the concept of liberty and justice is so weak as to matter
- little. FOOD and shelter shall be the main concern.
- No central bank save the Bank of International Settlement
- and the World Bank shall be allowed to operate. Private banks
- will be outlawed. Remuneration for work performed shall be
- under a uniform predetermined scale throughout the One World
- Government. There shall be no wage disputes allowed, nor any
- diversion from the standard uniform scales of pay laid down by
- the One World Government. Those who break the law will be
- instantly executed.
- There shall be no cash or coinage in the hands of the non-
- elite. All transactions shall be carried out by means of a debit
- card which shall bear the identification number of the holder.
- Any person who in any way infringes the rules and regulations
- of the Committee of 300 shall have the use of his or her card
- suspended for varying times according to the nature and sever-
- ity of the infringement.
- Such persons will find, when they go to make purchases,
- that their card is blacklisted and they will not be able to obtain
- services of any kind. Attempts to trade "old" coins, that is to say
- silver coins of previous and now defunct nations, shall be treated
- as a capital crime subject to the death penalty. All such coinage
- shall be required to be surrendered within a given time along
- with guns, rifles, explosives and automobiles. Only the elite and
- One World Government high-ranking functionaries will be al-
- lowed private transport, weapons, coinage and automobiles.
- If the offense is a serious one, the card will be seized at the
- checking point where it is presented. Thereafter that person
- shall not be able to obtain food, water, shelter and employment
- medical services, and shall be officially listed as an outlaw.
- Large bands of outlaws will thus be created and they will live in
- regions that best afford subsistence, subject to being hunted
-
- 165
-
- down and shot on sight. Persons assisting outlaws in any way
- whatsoever, shall likewise be shot. Outlaws who fail to surren-
- der to the police or military after a declared period of time, shall
- have a former family member selected at random to serve prison
- terms in their stead.
- Rival factions and groups such as Arabs and Jews and
- African tribes shall have differences magnified and allowed the
- wage wars of extermination against each other under the eyes of
- NATO and U.N. observers. The same tactics will be used in
- Central and South America. These wars of attrition shall take
- place BEFORE the take-over of the One World Government and
- shall be engineered on every continent where large groups of
- people with ethnic and religious differences live, such as the
- Sikhs, Moslem Pakistanis and the Hindu Indians. Ethnic and
- religious differences shall be magnified and exacerbated and
- violent conflict as a means of "settling" their differences shall
- be encouraged and fostered.
- All information services and print media shall be under the
- control of the One World Government. Regular brainwashing
- control measures shall be passed off as "entertainment" in the
- manner in which it was practiced and became a fine art in the
- United States. Youths removed from "disloyal parents," shall
- receive special education designed to brutalize them. Youth of
- both sexes shall receive training to qualify as prison guards for
- the One World labor camp system.
- It is obvious from the foregoing that much work remains to
- be done before the dawning of the New World Order can occur.
- The Committee of 300 has long ago perfected plans to destabi-
- lize civilization as we know it, some of which plans were made
- known by Zbignew Brzezinski in his classic work "THE
- TECHNOTRONIC ERA" and the works of Aurellio Peccei
- who founded the Club of Rome, especially in his book, "THE
- CHASM AHEAD."
- In "THE CHASM AHEAD," Peccei spelled out Committee
- of 300 plans to tame man, whom he called "THE ENEMY."
-
- 166
-
- Peccei quoted what Felix Dzerzinski once said to Sydney Reilly
- at the height of the Red Terror when millions of Russians were
- being murdered: "Why should I concern myself with how many
- die? Even the Christian Bible says what is man that God should
- be mindful of him? For me men are nothing but a brain at one
- end and a shit factory at the other. "
- It was from this brutish view of man that Emmanuel The
- Christ came to rescue the world. Sydney Reilly was the MI6
- operative sent to watch over Dzerzinski's activities. Reilly was
- allegedly shot by his friend Felix while attempting to flee Rus-
- sia. The elaborate plot was devised when certain members of the
- British Parliament raised a hue and cry and began to loudly
- demand an accounting of Reilly's activities in Russia, which
- threatened to expose the role of the Committee of 300 in gaining
- control of the Baku oilfields and its major role in assisting Lenin
- and Trotsky during the Bolshevik Revolution. Rather than have
- the truth dragged out of Reilly, MI6 thought it expedient to stage
- his death. Reilly lived out his days in utter luxury in a Russia
- villa usually reserved for the Bolshevik elite.
- Arguing that chaos would ensue unless the "Atlantic Alli-
- ance," a euphemism for the Committee of 300 ruled post in-
- dustrial America, Peccei proposed a Malthusian triaging on a
- global scale. He envisioned a collision between the scientific-
- technological-military apparatus of the Soviet Union and the
- Western world. Thus the Warsaw Pact countries were to be
- offered a convergence with the West in a One World Govern-
- ment to run global affairs on the foundations of crisis manage-
- ment and global planning.
- Events unfolding in what was formerly the USSR and the
- emergence of several independent states in a loose federation in
- Russia, is exactly what was envisaged by Peccei and the Club of
- Rome and this is clearly spelled out in both the books I have
- mentioned. A USSR thus divided will be easier to cope with
- than a strong, united Soviet nation. Plans that were laid down by
- the Committee of 300 for a One World Government, which
-
- 167
-
- included the prospect of a divided Russia, are now approaching
- a point of rapid escalation. Events in Russia at the close of 1991
- are all the more dramatic when viewed against the 1960 long-
- range planning by the Committee of 300.
- In Western Europe the people are working toward a federa-
- tion of states within a one government framework with a single
- currency. From there the EEC system will be transferred bit by
- bit to the United States and Canada. The United Nations is benign
- slowly but surely transformed into a rubber stamp of One World
- Government, with policies dictated to it by the United States as
- we saw in the case of the Gulf War.
- Precisely the same thing is happening with the British Par-
- liament. Discussion on Britain's participation in the Gulf War
- was kept to a ridiculously minimal level and belatedly took
- place only during a motion to adjourn the House. This has never
- happened before in the ancient history of parliament, where so
- important a decision had to be made and so little time was
- allowed for discussion. One of the most noteworthy events in
- parliamentary history has gone virtually unnoticed.
- We are close to the point where the United States will send its
- military Forces to settle any and all disputes brought before the
- United Nations. Departing Secretary General Perez de Cuellar,
- heavily laden with bribe money, was the most compliant U.N.
- leader in history in granting demands of the United States without
- discussion. His successor will be even more inclined to go along
- with whatever the U.S. government places before him. This is an
- important step along the road to a One World Government.
- The International Court of Justice at The Hague will be used
- in increasing measure in the next two years to settle legal
- arguments of all types. It is of course the prototype for a One
- World Government legal system that will supplant all others. As
- for central banks, essential in the planning of the New World
- Order, this is already very much a fait-accompli with the Bank
- of International Settlements dominating the scene at the close of
- 1991. Private banks are fast disappearing in preparation for the
-
- 168
-
- Big Ten banks that will control banking the world over under the
- guidance of BIS and the IMF.
- Welfare states abound in Europe, and the United States is
- fast becoming the largest welfare state in the world. Once
- people come to depend on government for their subsistence, it
- will be very hard to wean them away from it as we saw in the
- results of the last mid-term election held in the United States
- where 98% of incumbents were returned to Washington to enjoy
- the good life in spite of their utterly deplorable records.
- The abolition of privately owned firearms is already in force
- in three quarters of the world. Only in the United States can the
- populace still own guns of all types, but that legal right is being
- chipped away at an alarming rate by local and state laws which
- violate the Constitutional right of all citizens to bear arms.
- Private gun ownership will have become a thing of the past in
- the United States by the year 2010.
- SlMILARLY, EDUCATION IS BEING ERODED AT AN
- ALARMING RATE. PRIVATE SCHOOLS ARE BEING
- FORCED TO CLOSE BY A VARIETY OF LEGAL STRATA-
- GEMS AND LACK OF FUNDING. The standard of education
- in the United States has already sunk to such a deplorable level
- that today it can barely be classified as education at all. This is
- according to plan; as I described earlier, the One World Gov-
- ernment does not want our youth to be properly educated.
- Destruction of national identity proceeds apace. It is no
- longer a good thing to be patriotic unless it is in the cause of
- some One World Government project such as the war of geno-
- cide being waged against the nation of Iraq, or the impending
- destruction of Libya. Racial pride is now frowned upon and
- deemed to be an illegal act in many parts of the world, IN-
- CLUDING THE UNITED STATES, BRITAIN, WESTERN
- EUROPE AND CANADA, ALL COUNTRIES HAVING THE
- LARGEST CONCENTRATIONS OF THE WHITE RACE.
- Led by the secret societies in America, destruction of repub-
- lican forms of government has proceeded apace since the close
-
- 169
-
- of WW II. A list of such governments destroyed by the U.S. is
- long, and it is difficult for the non-informed to accept that
- government of a country allegedly wedded to republicanism
- under a unique constitution would engage in such conduct, but
- the facts speak for themselves.
- This is a goal which was set over a century ago by the
- Committee of 300. The United States has led the attacks on such
- governments and continues to do so even as the United States
- republican base is being steadily undermined. Starting with
- James Earl Carter's legal counsel, Lloyd Cutler, a committee of
- constitutional lawyers has been working to change the U.S.
- Congress into a non-representative parliamentary system. Work
- has been in progress since 1979 on the blueprint for such a
- change, and because of his devotion to the cause, Cutler was
- made a member of the Committee of 300. The final draft for a
- parliamentary type of government is to be presented to the
- Committee of 300 at the end of 1993.
- In the new parliamentary system, members will not be re-
- sponsible to their constituents, but to parliamentary whips and
- will vote the way they are told to vote. Thus, by judicial and
- bureaucratic subversion will the Constitution vanish as will
- individual liberty. Preplanned degrading of man through licen-
- tious sexual practices will be stepped up. New sexually degen-
- erate cults are even now being set up by the British Crown--
- working through the SIS and MI6 services. As we already know,
- all cults operating in the world today are the product of British
- intelligence acting for the oligarchical rulers.
- We may think this phase of creating a whole new cult which
- specializes in sexual degenerate behavior is still far off, but my
- information is that it is due to be stepped up in 1992. By 1994 it
- will be quite commonplace to have "live shows" in the most
- prestigious clubs and places of entertainment. This type of
- "entertainment" is already in the process of having its image
- cleaned and brightened.
- Soon the big names in Hollywood and the entertainment
-
- 170
-
- world will be recommending this or that club as a "must" for
- live sex shows. Lesbianism and homosexuality will not be
- featured. This new socially acceptable "entertainment" will
- consist of heterosexual displays and will be written up in reviews
- as one finds in today's newspapers about shows on Broadway,
- or the latest hit movie.
- An unprecedented assault on moral values will go into high
- gear in 1992. Pornography will no longer be called "pornogra-
- phy," but adult sex entertainment. Sloganeering will take the
- form of "why hide it when everybody does it. Let's take away
- the image that public displays of sex are ugly and dirty." No
- more will those who care for this type of unbridled sexual lust
- have to go to seedy porno parlours. Instead, the upper-class
- supper clubs and places favored by the rich and famous will
- make public sexual displays a highly "artistic" form of enter-
- tainment. Worse yet, some church "leaders" will even recom-
- mend it.
- The voluminous all-pervading and enormous social psy-
- chiatry apparatus put in place by the Tavistock Institute and its
- huge web of related capabilities has been under the control of
- one single entity, and that entity is still in control as we enter
- 1992. That single entity, the conspirators'hierarchy, is called
- THE COMMITTEE OF 300. It is a power structure and a power
- center that operates far beyond the reach of any single world
- leader or any government, including the United States govern-
- ment and its Presidents--as the late John F. Kennedy found out.
- The Kennedy murder was an operation of the Committee of 300
- and we shall return to that.
- The Committee of 300 is the ultimate secret society made up
- of an untouchable ruling class, which includes the Queen of
- England, the Queen of the Netherlands, the Queen of Denmark
- and the royal families of Europe. These aristocrats decided at
- the death of Queen Victoria, the matriarch of the Venetian Black
- Guelphs that, in order to gain world-wide control, it would be
- necessary for its aristocratic members to "go into business" with
-
- 171
-
- the non-aristocratic but extremely powerful leaders of corporate
- business on a global scale, and so the doors to ultimate power
- were opened to what the Queen of England likes to refer to as
- "the commoners."
- From my days in the intelligence business I know that heads
- of foreign governments refer to this all-powerful body as "The
- Magicians." Stalin coined his own phrase to describe them:
- "The Dark Forces," and President Eisenhower, who was never
- able to get beyond the "hofjuden" (court Jew) grade, referred to
- it in a colossal understatement as "the military-industrial com-
- plex." Stalin kept the USSR heavily armed with conventional
- and nuclear forces because he did not trust what he called "the
- family." His ingrained mistrust and fear of the Committee of
- 300 proved to be well-founded.
- Popular entertainment, especially the medium of movie
- making, was used to bring discredit upon those who tried to
- warn of this most dangerous threat to individual liberty and
- freedom of mankind. Freedom is a God-given law which man
- has constantly sought to subvert and undermine; yet the yearn-
- ing for freedom by each individual is so great that up to now, no
- system has been able to tear that feeling from the heart of mad.
- The experiments that have gone on in the USSR, Britain and the
- USA, to blunt and dull mans yearnings for freedom, have thus
- far proved to be unsuccessful.
- But with the coming of the New World Order-One World
- Government, far-reaching experiments will be stepped up to
- drive mans God-given yearning for freedom out of his mind,
- body and soul. What we are already experiencing is but nothing,
- a mere bagatelle, when compared with what is to come. Attacking
- the soul is the thrust of a host of experiments being readied, and
- I regret to say that institutions in the United States will play a
- leading role in the terrible experiments which have already been
- carried out on local small-scale levels at such places as Bethesda
- Naval Hospital and Vacaville prison in California.
- The movies we have seen thus far include the James Bond
-
- 172
-
- series, the "Assassination Bureau," the "Matarese Circle" and
- so on. They were make-believe movies, designed to hide the
- truth that such organizations do exist and on a far greater scale
- than even Hollywood's fertile idea-men could dream up.
- Yet the Assassination Bureau is absolutely real. It exists in
- Europe and the United States solely to do the bidding of the
- Committee of 300 to carry out high-level assassinations where
- all other remedies have failed. It was PERMINDEX which ran
- the Kennedy assassination under the direction of Sir William
- Stephenson, for years the Queen of England's number one "pest
- control" operative.
- Clay Shaw, a contract agent of the CIA, ran PERMINDEX
- out of the Trade Mart Center in New Orleans. Former New
- Orleans District Attorney Jim Garrison came very close to
- cracking the Kennedy assassination plot up to the level of Clay
- Shaw until Garrison was "dealt with" and Shaw was found not
- quilty of involvement in the Kennedy assassination plot. The
- fact that Shaw was eliminated in the manner of Jack Ruby,
- another CIA contract agent--both died of induced quick-acting
- cancer--speaks volumes that Garrison was on the right track.
- A second assassination bureau is located in Switzerland and
- was until recently run by a shadowy figure of whom no photo-
- graphs existed after 1941. The operations were and probably
- still are financed by the Oltramaire family--Swiss Black Nobility,
- owners of the Lombard Odier Bank of Geneva, a Committee
- of 300 operation. The primary contact man was Jacques
- Soustelle--this according to U.S. Army-G2 intelligence files.
- This group was also closely allied with Allen Dulles and
- Jean de Menil, an important member of the Committee of 300
- and a very prominent name in the oil industry in Texas. Army-
- G2 records show that the group was heavily involved in the
- arms trade in the Middle East, but more than that, the assassi-
- nation bureau made no less than 30 attempts to assassinate
- General de Gaulle, in which Jacques Soustelle was directly
- involved. The same Soustelle was the contact man for the
-
- 173
-
- Sendero Luminosa-Shining Pathway guerilla group protecting
- the Committee's Peruvian cocaine producers.
- When all of the best that the assassination bureau could do
- had failed, thanks to the excellent work done by DGSE (French
- intelligence-formerly SDECE) the job was assigned to MI6--
- Military Intelligence Department Six, and also known as Secret
- Intelligence Service (SIS), under the code name "Jackal." SDECE
- employed clever young graduates and was not infiltrated by
- MI6 or the KGB to any measurable extent. Its record in tracking
- down foreign agents made it the envy of the secret services of
- every nation, and it was this group that followed "Jackal" to his
- final destination and then killed him before he could fire on
- General de Gaulle's motorcade.
- It was the SDECE who uncovered a Soviet mole in the
- cabinet of De Gaulle, who also happened to be a liaison man
- with the CIA in Langley. In order to discredit the SDECE, Allen
- Dulles, who hated De Gaulle, (the feeling was mutual) had one
- of its agents, Roger De Louette, caught with $12 million worth
- of heroin in his possession. After a great deal of expert "interro-
- gation," De Louette "confessed" but was unable to say why he
- was smuggling drugs into the United States. The whole thing
- stank to high heaven of a set-up.
- Based upon an examination of SDECE methods in protect-
- ing De Gaulle, especially in motorcades, the FBI, Secret Service
- and the CIA knew exactly how to strip President Kennedy of his
- security and make it easy for the three PERMINDEX shooters
- to murder him in Dealey Plaza in November 1963.
- Another example of FACT disguised as fiction is the Leon
- Uris novel, "TOPAZ." In "TOPAZ" we find a factual account of
- the activities of Thyraud de Vosjoli, the very KGB agent un-
- covered by SDECE and denounced as the KGB's liaison man
- with the CIA. There are many fictionalized accounts of the
- MOSSAD's activities, nearly all of which are based on fact.
- The MOSSAD is also known as "The Institute." Many
- would-be writers make nonsensical statements about it, especially
-
- 174
-
- one writer who is much in favor with the Christian right wing,
- which is accepted as truth. One can pardon the offender because
- he has no intelligence training, but that does not stop him from
- dropping "Mossad names" all over the place.
- Such disinformation exercises are routinely run against
- American right wing patriotic groups. Originally the MOSSAD
- consisted of 3 groups, the Bureau of Military Intelligence, the
- Political Department of the Foreign Office and the Department
- of Security (Sherut Habitachon). David Ben Gurion, a member
- of the Committee of 300, received some considerable help from
- MI6 in putting it together.
- But it was not a success, and in 1951 Sir William Stephenson
- of MI6 restructured it into a single unit as arm of the Political
- Department of the Israeli Foreign Office, with a special operations
- group for espionage and "black job" operations. British intelli-
- gence gave further assistance in training and equipping for
- servicing the Sarayet Maktal, also known as the General Staff
- Reconnaissance unit, in the format of Britain's Special Air
- Service (SAS). This service unit of the MOSSAD is never
- mentioned by name and is known simply as "The Guys."
- "The Guys" are merely an extension of British intelligence's
- SAS unit who continually train and update them in new meth-
- ods. It was "The Guys" who killed the leaders of the P.L.0. and
- kidnaped Adolph Eichmann. "The Guys" and indeed ALL
- MOSSAD agents, operate on a war-time footing. The MOSSAD
- has a tremendous advantage over other intelligence services in
- that every country in the world has a large Jewish community.
- By studying social and criminal records, the MOSSAD is
- able to pick agents among local Jews it can have a hold over
- AND MAKE THEM WORK FOR IT WITHOUT PAY. The
- MOSSAD also has the advantage of having access to the records
- of all U.S. law enforcement agencies and U.S. intelligence
- services The Office of Naval Intelligence (OM) ELINT services
- the Mossad at no cost to Israel. Citizens of the United States
- would be shocked, angered and dismayed if ever it was
-
- 175
-
- discovered just how much the MOSSAD knows about the lives
- of millions of Americans in every walk of life, even those who
- are not political in any way.
- The first head of the MOSSAD, Reuben Shiloach, was made
- a member of the Committee of 300, but it is not known whether
- his successor enjoyed the same privilege. Chances are that he
- does. The MOSSAD has a skillful disinformation service. The
- amount of disinformation it feeds to the American "market" is
- embarrassing, but even more embarrassing is how it is swal-
- lowed hook, line and sinker and all.
- What we are actually witnessing in the microcosm of the
- MOSSAD is the extent of control exercised by the "Olympians"
- over the intelligence services, entertainment, publishing, opin-
- ion-making (polls) and the television "news" media on a global
- scale. Ted Turner was recently given a seat on the Committee of
- 300 in recognition for his "news" (making) CNN broadcasts. The
- Committee has the power and the means to tell the people of this
- world ANYTHING, and it will be believed by the vast majority,
- On every occasion that a researcher happens upon this as-
- tounding central control group, he is either successfully bought
- off, or else he undergoes some "speciality training" at the
- Tavistock Institute after which he becomes a contributor to
- more fiction, of the James Bond type, i.e., he is derailed and
- well rewarded. If such a person as John F. Kennedy should
- stumble onto the truth about who directs world events, and
- cannot be bought, he is assassinated.
- In the case of John F. Kennedy, the assassination was carried
- out with great attendant publicity and with the utmost brutality
- to serve as a warning to world leaders not to get out of line. Pope
- John Paul I was quietly murdered because he was getting close
- to the Committee of 300 through Freemasons in the Vatican
- hierarchy. His successor, Pope John Paul 11, was publicly hu-
- miliated as a warning to cease and desist--which he has done.
- As we shall see, certain Vatican leaders are today seated on the
- Committee of 300.
-
- 176
-
- It is easy to put serious researcher off track of the
- Committee of 300 because Britain's MI6 (SAS) promotes a
- wide variety of kookery such as the New Age, Yogaism, Zen
- Buddhism, Witchcraft, Delphic Priesthood of Apollo (Aristotle
- was a member) and hundreds of small "cults" of all kinds. A
- group of "retired" British intelligence agents who stayed on the
- track labeled the conspirators'hierarchy "Force X," and declared
- that it possesses a super-intelligence service that has corrupted
- the KGB, the Vatican Intelligence, the CIA, the ONI, DGSE,
- U.S. military intelligence, the State Department intelligence
- service and even the most secret of all U.S. intelligence agen-
- cies, the Office of National Reconnaissance.
- The existence of the National Reconnaissance Office (NRO)
- was known to only a handful of people outside of the Commit-
- tee of 300, until Truman stumbled upon it quite by accident.
- Churchill had a hand in setting up the NRO and he was report-
- edly livid when Truman discovered its existence. Churchill
- more than any other servant of the Committee of 300, consid-
- ered Truman His-Little-Man from independence "without an
- independence at all." This referred to Truman's every move
- being controlled by Freemasonry. Even today, NRO's annual
- budget is not known to the Congress of the United States, and it
- is responsible to only a selected few in Congress. But it is a
- creature of the Committee of 300 to whom its reports are
- routinely sent every few hours.
-
-
- <<<<< cont in Committee of 300 - part 8 >>>>>
-
-
- --
- <*> Don Allen <*> 1:363/81.1 - Fidonet #1 - Homebody BBS
- dona@bilver.uucp - Internet 1:363/29.8 - Fidonet #2 - Gourmet Delight
- 88:4205/1.1 - MUFON Network 1:3607/20.2 -- Odyssey - Alabama UFO Net
- NSA grep food: Aviary, Ed Dames, Los Alamos - Majestic - Jason - RIIA - UN
-
- Path: igor.rutgers.edu!rutgers!jvnc.net!darwin.sura.net!haven.umd.edu!uunet!peora!tarpit!tous!bilver!dona
- From: dona@bilver.uucp (Don Allen)
- Newsgroups: alt.conspiracy
- Subject: FILE: Committee of 300 - Part 8
- Message-ID: <1992Nov15.195812.27557@bilver.uucp>
- Date: 15 Nov 92 19:58:12 GMT
- Organization: W. J. Vermillion - Winter Park, FL
- Lines: 939
-
-
- --- Committee of 300 - Part 8 ------------------------------------------
-
-
-
- Thus the fictionalized spoofs one sees about the various
- branches and arms of control of the Committee were designed
- to take suspicion away from the real thing, but we should never
- doubt that the real thing does indeed exist. Take another example
- of what I mean, the book "THE DAY OF THE JACKAL," from
- which a highly successful movie was created.
- The events related in the book are factual. Although for
- obvious reasons the names of some of the players and the
- locales were changed, but the thrust of the story, that a single
- MI6 operative was assigned to get rid of General Charles De
-
- 177
-
- Gaulle, is absolutely correct. General De Gaulle had become
- unmanageable, refusing to cooperate with the Committee--
- whose existence he knew very well since he had been invited to
- join it--came to a climax when De Gaulle withdrew France
- from NATO and immediately began building his own nuclear
- force--the so-called "force de frappe."
- This so angered the Committee that De Gaulle's assassination
- was ordered. But the French secret intelligence service was able
- to intercept "Jackal's" plans and keep De Gaulle safe. In the
- light of the record of MI6, which I might add is the Committee
- of 300's main resource when it comes to intelligence, the work
- done by French intelligence borders on the miraculous.
- Military Intelligence Department Six dates back to Sir Francis
- Walsingham, paymaster of Queen Elizabeth I for dirty tricks
- operations. Over hundreds of years, MI6 has established a record
- which no other intelligence agency can come near to duplicating.
- MI6 agents have gathered information from the four corners of
- the earth and have carried out secret operations that would
- astound even the most knowledgeable if ever they were to be
- made public, which is why it rates as the Master service of the
- Committee of 300.
- Officially, MI6 does not exist, its budget comes out of the
- Queen's purse and "private funds," and is reported to be in a
- range of $350-$500 million per annum, but no one knows for sure
- what the exact amount is. In its present form MI6 dates back to
- 1911, when it was under the leadership of Sir Mansfield Cumming,
- a captain in the Royal Navy, who was always identified by the
- letter "C," from which "M" of James Bond fame is taken.
- No official record of MI6's failures and successes exist--it
- is that secret, although the Burgess-Maclean-Blake-Blunt disas-
- ters did great damage to the morale of MI6 officers. Unlike
- other services, future members are recruited from universities
- and other areas of learning by highly skilled "talent scouts" as
- we saw in the case of Rhodes Scholars inducted into the Round
- Table. One of the requirements is an ability to speak foreign
-
- 178
-
- languages. Candidates undergo a rigorous "blooding."
- With the backing of such a formidable force, the Committee
- of 300 had little fear from ever being exposed, and this will go
- on for decades. What makes the Committee incredible is the
- incredible secrecy that prevails. None of the news media has
- ever made mention of this conspiratorial hierarchy; therefore, as
- is to be expected, people doubt its existence.
- The Committee of 300 is for the most part under the control
- of the British monarch, in this case, Elizabeth II. Queen Victoria
- is believed to have been quite paranoid about keeping it secret
- and went to great lengths to cover up MASONIC writings left at
- the scene of "Jack the Ripper" murders which alluded to the
- Committee of 300's connections with "experiments" carried out
- by a family member who was also a highly-placed member of
- the Scottish Rite of Freemasonry. The Committee of 300 is
- filled with members of British aristocracy which has corporate
- interests and associates in every country of the world, including
- the USSR.
- The Committee's structure is as follows:
- The Tavistock Institute at Sussex University and London
- sites is owned and controlled by the Royal Institute for Interna-
- tional Affairs whose "hofjuden" in America is Henry Kissinger.
- The EAGLE STAR GROUP, which changed its name to the
- STAR GROUP after the close of the Second World War, is
- composed of a group of major international companies involved
- in overlapping and interfaced areas (1) Insurance, (2) Banking,
- (3) Real Estate, (4) Entertainment, (5) High technology, including
- cybernetics, electronic communications, etc.
- Banking, while not the mainstay, is vitally important, espe-
- cially in the areas where banks act as clearing houses and money
- launderers of drug money. The main "big name banks" are The
- Bank of England, the Federal Reserve Banks, Bank of Interna-
- tional Settlements, the World Bank and the Hong Kong and
- Shanghai Bank. American Express Bank is a means of recycling
- drug dollars. Each of these banks is affiliated with and/or con-
-
- 179
-
- trols hundreds of thousands of large and small banks throughout
- the world.
- Banks large and small in the thousands are in the Committee
- of 300 network, including Banca Commerciale d'Italia, Banca
- Privata, Banco Ambrosiano, the Netherlands Bank, Barclays
- Bank, Banco del Colombia, Banco de Ibero-America. Of spe-
- cial interest is Banca del la Svizzeria Italiana (BSI)--since it
- handles flight capital investments to and from the United States--
- primarily in dollars and U.S. bonds--located and isolated in
- "neutral" Lugano, the flight capital center for the Venetian
- Black Nobility. Lugano is not in Italy or in Switzerland, and is a
- kind of a twilight zone for shady flight capital operations.
- George Ball, who owns a large block of stock in BSI, is a
- prominent "insider" and the hank's U.S. representative.
- BCCI, BNL, Banco Mercantil de Mexico, Banco Nacional
- de Panama, Bangkok Metropolitan Bank, Bank Leumi, Bank
- Hapoalim, Standard Bank, Bank of Geneva, Bank of Ireland,
- Bank of Scotland, Bank of Montreal, Bank of Nova Scotia,
- Banque Paris et Pays Bas, British Bank of the Middle East and
- the Royal Bank of Canada to name but a very small number in a
- huge list of "speciality" banks.
- The Oppenheimers of South Africa are much bigger "heavy-
- weights" than the Rockefellers. For instance, in 1981 Harry
- Oppenheimer, chairman of the giant Anglo American Corpora-
- tion that controls gold and diamond mining, sales and distribu-
- tion in the world, stated that he was about to launch into the
- North American banking market. Oppenheimer promptly in-
- vested $10 billion in a specially created vehicle for the purpose
- of buying into big banks in the U.S., among which was Citicorp.
- Oppenheimer's investment vehicle was called Minorco, which
- set up shop in Bermuda, a British royal family preserve. On the
- board of Minorco was to be found Walter Wriston of Citicorp
- and Robert Clare, its chief counsel.
- The only other company to rival Oppenheimer in the field of
- precious metals and minerals was Consolidated Gold Fields of
-
- 180
-
- South Africa, but Oppenheimer took control of it with a 28%
- stake the largest single stockholder. Thus gold, diamonds,
- platinum, titanium, tantalite, copper, iron ore, uranium and 52
- other metals and minerals, many of them of absolutely vital
- strategic value to United States, passed into the hands of the
- Committee of 300.
- Thus was the vision of one of the earlier South African
- members of the Committee of 300, Cecil John Rhodes, fully
- realized, a vision which started with the spilling of the blood of
- thousands upon thousands of White farmers and their families
- in South Africa, whom history records as the "Boers." While the
- United States stood by with folded hands as did the rest of the
- world, this small nation was subjected to the most vicious war
- of genocide in history. The United States will be subjected to the
- same treatment by the Committee of 300 when our turn comes
- and it will not be long in coming.
- Insurance companies play a key role in the business of the
- Committee of 300. Among these are found such top insurance
- companies as Assicurazioni Generali of Venice and Riunione
- Adriatica di Sicurta, the largest and second largest insurance
- companies in the world, who keep their bank accounts at Bank
- of International Settlements in Swiss gold francs. Both control a
- multiplicity of investment banks whose turnover in stocks on
- Wall Street double that of U.S. investors.
- Prominent on the board of these two insurance giants are
- Committee of 300 members: the Giustiniani family, Black No-
- bility of Rome and Venice who trace their lineage to the Emperor
- Justianian; Sir Jocelyn Hambro of Hambros (Merchant) Bank;
- Pierpaolo Luzzatti Fequiz, whose lineage dates back six centu-
- ries to the most ancient Luzzatos, the Black Nobility of Venice,
- and Umberto Ortolani of the ancient Black Nobility family of
- the same name.
- Other old Venetian Black Nobility Committee of 300 mem-
- bers and board members of ASG and RAS are the Doria family,
- the financiers of the Spanish Hapsburgs, Elie de Rothschild of the
-
- 181
-
- French Rothschild family, Baron August von Finck (Finck, the
- second richest man in Germany is now deceased), Franco Orsini
- Bonacassi of the ancient Orsini Black Nobility that traces its
- lineage to an ancient Roman senator of the same name, the Alba
- family whose lineage dates back to the great Duke of Alba, and
- Baron Pierre Lambert, a cousin of the Belgian Rothschild family.
- The English companies controlled by the British royal fam-
- ily are Eagle Star, Prudential Assurance Company, the Pruden-
- tial Insurance Company, which own and control most American
- insurers, including Allstate Insurance. At the head of the list is
- Eagle Star, probably the most powerful "front" for Military
- Intelligence Department Six (MI6). Eagle Star, although nowhere
- near as large as Assicurazioni Generale, is perhaps equally
- important simply because it is owned by members of the Queen
- of England's family and, as titular head of the Committee of
- 300, Eagle Star makes a tremendous impact.
- Eagle Star is more than a major "front" for MI6, it is also a
- Front for major British banks, including Hill-Samuels, N. M.
- Rothschild and Sons (one of the gold price "fixers" who meet
- daily in London), and Barclays Bank (one of the funders of the
- African National Congress-ANC). It can be said with a great
- degree of accuracy that the most powerful British oligarchical
- families created Eagle Star as a vehicle for "black operations"
- against those who oppose Committee of 300 policies.
- Unlike the CIA, British law makes it a serious crime to name
- MI6 officials, so the following is but a partial list of "top brass"
- of MI6, who are (or were) also members of the Committee of 300:
- Lord Hartley Shawcross.
- Sir Brian Edward Mountain.
- Sir Kenneth Keith.
- Sir Kenneth Strong.
- Sir William Stephenson.
- Sir William Wiseman.
- All of the fore going are (or were) heavily involved in key
- Committee of 300 companies which interface with literally
-
- 182
-
- thousands of companies engaged in every branch of commercial
- activity as we shall see.
- Some of these companies include Rank Organization, Xerox
- Corporation, ITT, IBM, RCA, CBS, NBC, BBC and CBC in
- communications, Raytheon, Textron, Bendix, Atlantic Richfield,
- British Petroleum, Royal Dutch Shell, Marine Midland Bank,
- Lehman Brothers, Kuhn Loeb, General Electric, Westinghouse
- Corporation, United Fruit Company and a great many more.
- MI6 ran a large number of these companies through British
- intelligence stationed in the RCA building in New York, which
- was the headquarters of its chief officer, Sir William Stephenson.
- Radio Corporation of America (RCA) was formed by G.E.,
- Westinghouse, Morgan Guarantee and Trust (acting for the
- British crown), and United Fruit, back in 1919 as a British
- intelligence center. RCA's first president was J.P. Morgan's
- Owen Young, after whom the Young Plan was named. In 1929
- David Sarnoff was appointed to run RCA. Sarnoff had acted as an
- assistant to Young at the 1919 Paris Peace Conference where a
- fallen Germany was stabbed in the back by the victorious "allies."
- A network of Wall Street banks and brokerage houses takes
- care of the stock market for the Committee, and prominent
- among these are Blyth, Eastman Dillon, the Morgan groups,
- Lazard Freres and Kuhn Loeb Rhodes. Nothing happens on
- Wall Street that is not controlled by the Bank of England, whose
- instructions are relayed through the Morgan groups
- and then put into action through key brokerage houses whose top executives
- are ultimately responsible for carrying out Committee directives.
- Before it overstepped the limits laid down by Morgan Guar-
- antee, Drexel Burnham Lambert was a favorite of the Commit-
- tee of 300. In 1981 almost every major brokerage house on Wall
- Street had sold out to the Committee, Phibro merging with
- Salomon Brothers. Phibro is the business arm of the
- Oppenheimers of Anglo American Corporation. By this control
- mechanism, the Committee of 300 ensures that its members and
- their far-flung business corporations turned their investments on
-
- 183
-
- Wall Street over at a rate of double that of the "non-insider"
- foreign investors.
- Remember, some of the richest families in the world live in
- Europe, so it is natural that they should have a preponderance of
- members on the Committee. The Von Thurn und Taxis family
- who once owned the German postal franchise, make David
- Rockefeller look like a very poor relation. The Von Thurn und
- Taxis dynasty dates back 300 years and generation after gen-
- eration of family members have had seats on the Committee
- which they occupy to this day. We have already mentioned by
- name many of the most wealthy Venetian Black Nobility mem-
- bers of the Committee of 300 and other names will be added as
- we come across them in their various fields of endeavor. Now
- we shall include some American members of the Committee of
- 300 and try to trace their affiliations and connections to the
- British Crown.
- How can these facts be verified? Actually, some of them
- cannot be verified because the information comes straight out of
- intelligence files, but with a lot of legwork, there are many
- sources which can verify at least part of the facts. The work
- would involve a diligent search of Dun and Bradstreet Refer-
- ence Book of Corporations, Standard and Poors, British and
- American "Who's Who" with long hours of hard work in cross-
- referencing names with their corporate affiliations.
- Committee of 300 corporations, banks, and insurance com-
- panies operate under the unified command covering every con-
- ceivable matter of strategy and cohesive action. The Committee
- is the ONLY organized power hierarchy in the world transcend-
- ing all governments and individuals, however powerful and
- secure they may feel themselves to be. This covers finance,
- defense matters and political parties of all colors and types.
- There is no entity the Committee cannot reach and control,
- and that includes organized religions of the world. This then, is
- the all powerful OLYMPIAN GROUP whose power base is in
- London and the City of London's financial centers with its grip
-
- 184
-
- on minerals, metals and precious gems, cocaine, opium and
- pharmaceutical drugs, rentier-financier bankers, cult promoters
- and founders of rock music. The British Crown is the control
- point from which all things radiate. As the saying goes, "They
- have a finger in every pie."
- It is obvious that the communications field is tightly con-
- trolled. Going back to RCA, we find that its directorate is
- composed of British-American establishment figures who feature
- prominently in other organizations such as the CFR, NATO, the
- Club of Rome, the Trilateral Commission, Freemasonry, Skull
- and Bones, Bilderbergers, Round Table, Milner Society and the
- Jesuits-Aristotle Society. Among them was David Sarnoff who
- moved to London at the same time Sir William Stephenson
- moved into the RCA building in New York.
- All three major television networks came as spinoffs from
- RCA, especially the National Broadcasting Company (NBC)
- which was first, closely followed by the American Broadcasting
- Company (ABC) in 1951. The third big television network was
- Columbia Broadcasting System (CBS) which, like its sister
- companies was, and still is, dominated by British intelligence.
- William Paley was trained in mass brainwashing techniques at the
- Tavistock Institute prior to being passed as qualified to head CBS.
- Thus, if we the people of the United States but knew it, all
- our major television networks are subject to British oversight,
- and information they provide first goes to London for clearance.
- It is interesting to note that the Tavistock intelligence paper
- written by Stanford Research Institute, commonly named "The
- Aquarian Conspiracy" was funded by donations from all three
- major television networks.
- All three major networks are represented on the Committee
- of 300 and are affiliated with the giant of the mass communica-
- tion business, the Xerox Corporation of Rochester, New York,
- whose Robert M. Beck holds a seat on the Committee. Beck is also
- a director of the Prudential Life Insurance Company, which is a
- subsidiary of the London Prudential Assurance Company Limited.
-
- 185
-
- Others on the board of Xerox are Howard Clark of the
- American Express Company, one of the main conduits for mov-
- ing drug money through "travelers checks," former Secretary of
- the Treasury, William Simon, and Sol Linowitz, who negotiated
- the Panama Canal Treaties for the Committee. Linowitz is im-
- portant to the Committee by virtue of his long standing expertise
- in laundering drug money through Marine Midland and the
- Hong Kong and Shanghai Bank.
- Another Xerox board member is Robert Sproull, who is of
- real interest because, as president of the University of Rochester,
- he allowed the Tavistock Institute, working through the CIA, to
- use the university's facilities for the 20-year MK-Ultra LSD
- experiments. Some 85 other universities in the U.S. also allowed
- their facilities to be misused in this manner. As giant-sized as
- Xerox is, it is dwarfed by the Rank Organization, a London-
- based conglomerate fully controlled by members of Queen
- Elizabeth's immediate family.
- Notable members of the board of Rank Organization who
- are also members of the Committee of 300 are the following:
- Lord Helsby, chairman of the drug money clearing house,
- Midland Bank. Helsby's other positions include a directorship
- in the giant Imperial Group and the Industrial and Commercial
- Finance Corporation.
- Sir Arnold France, a director of Tube Investments who runs
- the London underground train service. France is also a director
- of the BANK OF ENGLAND which has so much control over
- the Federal Reserve Banks.
- Sir Dennis Mountain, chairman of the mighty Eagle Star
- group and a director of English Property Corp, one of the
- rentier-financier companies of the British royal family. One
- such member is the Honorable Angus Ogilvie, "Prince of Com-
- panies," who is married to Her Royal Highness Princess Alex-
- andria, sister of the Duke of Kent, leader of the Scottish Rite of
- Freemasonry and who takes the place of the Queen when she is
- outside of Britain. Ogilvie is a director of the Bank of England
-
- 186
-
- and chairman of the giant LONRHO conglomerate. It was
- LONRHO that ended the rule of Ian Smith in Rhodesia so that
- he could be replaced by Robert Mugabe. At stake was Rhodesia's
- chrome mines which produce the finest high-grade chrome ore
- in the world.
- Cyril Hamilton, chairman of the Standard and Chartered
- Bank (the old Lord Milner-Cecil Rhodes bank) and a board
- member of the Bank of England. Hamilton is also on the board
- of the Xerox Corporation, the Malta International Banking Cor-
- poration (A Knights of Malta bank), a director of the Standard
- Bank of South Africa--the largest bank in that country, and a
- director of the Banque Belge d'Afrique.
- Lord O'Brien of Lotherby, past president of the British Bankers
- Association, director of Morgan Grenfell--a powerful bank, direc-
- tor of Prudential Assurance, director of J. P.Morgan, director of the
- Bank of England, a board member of the Bank of International
- Settlements, a director of the giant Unilever conglomerate.
- Sir Reay Geddes, chairman of the giant Dunlop and Pirelli
- tyre companies, director of the Midland and International Banks,
- director of the Bank of England. Note how many of these
- powerful men are directors of the Bank of England which
- makes control of American fiscal policies simple.
- Many of these organizations and institutions, companies
- and banks are so interfaced and interlocked as to make it an
- almost impossible task to sort them out. On RCA's board sits
- Thornton Bradshaw, president of Atlantic Richfield and a member
- of NATO, World Wildlife Fund, the Club of Rome, The Aspen
- Institute for Humanistic Studies, the Council on Foreign Rela-
- tions. Bradshaw is also chairman of NBC. The most important
- function of RCA remains its service to British intelligence.
- It is not generally known how powerful was the role played
- by the Committee of 300 in stopping the investigation into the
- CIA which Senator McCarthy almost succeeded in pulling off.
- Had McCarthy been successful, it is very likely that President
- John F. Kennedy would be alive today.
-
- 187
-
- When McCarthy said he was going to summon William
- Bundy to appear before his commission of enquiry, panic swept
- Washington and London. Bundy, had he been called to testify,
- would most probably have cracked and opened the door to the
- "special relations" that existed between British oligarchical
- circles and their cousins in the United States Government.
- Such a possibility could not be entertained. The Royal In-
- sititute of International Affairs was called in to put an end to
- McCarthy. The RIIA chose Allen Dulles, a man who was totally
- enamored of decadent British society, to attack McCarthy head
- on. Dulles put Patrick Lyman and Richard Helms in charge of
- the McCarthy case. Helms was later rewarded for his service
- against McCarthy by being made head of the CIA.
- General Mark Clark, a member of the CFR and a well-liked
- military man in London circles, was appointed by General
- Eisenhower to turn back McCarthy's full-fledged attack on the
- CIA. McCarthy was preempted when Clark announced that a
- special committee was to be appointed to examine the agency.
- Clark, on instructions from the RIIA, recommended a Congres-
- sional watchdog committee to "periodically examine the work
- of government intelligence agencies." The whole thing was a
- super tragedy for America and a victory for the British, who
- feared that McCarthy would accidentally stumble onto the
- Committee of 300 and its control over every aspect of United
- States affairs.
- Lehman Brothers-Kuhn Loeb's former chairman, Peter
- G.Peterson, served under former MI6 chief Sir William Wiseman
- and as such was no stranger to British royalty. Peterson is tied in
- with Aspen Institute, yet another arm of British intelligence.
- John R. Petty is president and chairman of the Marine
- Midland Bank--a bank whose drug trade connections have
- been well established long before it was taken over by the Hong
- Kong and Shanghai Bank, probably the number one bank in the
- opium trade, a position it has held since 1814.
- But the best proof I can offer of the existence of the Com-
-
- 188
-
- mittee of 300 is the Rank Organization which, in conjunction
- with Eagle Star, IS THE BRITISH CROWN. It is also the black
- operations center of MI6 (SIS). Between them, these two Com-
- mittee of 300 companies control Her Majesty's Dominion of
- Canada, using the "hofjuden" Bronfman family to carry out
- their orders.
- Trizec Holdings, ostensibly owned by the Bronfman family,
- is in reality the main asset of the Queen of England's in Canada.
- The entire Southeast Asian opium trade interfaces with the
- Bronfman empire and is one of the means whereby heroin is
- brought to America. In a sense, Canada is like Switzerland
- pristine snow-covered landscapes, big cities, a place of great
- beauty, but underneath lies a deep layer of filth and dirt arising
- from its massive heroin trade.
- The Bronfman family are "cut-outs"'what is known in MI6
- as "front men" controlled from London by MI6 "deskmen,"
- intelligence jargon for controllers at headquarters. Edgar
- Bronfman, the family leader, was sent to "Moscow Center"--
- cover name for the KGB headquarters at 2 Dzerzhinsky Square,
- Moscow, on a large number of occasions.
- At a low level, Bronfman was probably very useful as a
- contact man with Moscow. Bronfman was never at any stage a
- contract agent for MI6 and so never carried the title "Paroles," a
- key intelligence word for mutual identification between agents,
- which greatly disappointed the eager Bronfman family head. At
- one stage when it was thought that some of the family were
- acting suspiciously, "watchers"--intelligence jargon for intelli-
- gence officers keeping persons under surveillance, were put on
- the Bronfman family, but found only that one of the Bronfmans
- had been bragging to a United States "cousin" (the word MI6
- uses for the C.I.A.) who was unaware of the role of Edgar
- Bronfman. This was quickly corrected.
- Two Eagle Star directors, who were also the two top MI6
- operatives, took control of the Bronfman family about six months
- after the war ended. Sir Kenneth Keith and Sir Kenneth Strong,
-
- 189
-
- whom we have already met, legitimated the Bronfman family
- by setting up Trizec Holdings. There is no one in the world who
- can do a better job of "fronting," through companies, than MI6
- Yet, like Switzerland, there is a dirty side to Canada that has
- been well-hidden from view by the Committee of 300 under
- cover of the Official Secrets Act, a carbon-copy of the British
- law passed in 1913. Drugs, dirty money laundering, crime and
- racketeering are all covered by their infamous Act.
- Not known to many is that, if charged under the Official
- Secrets Act, which can be interpreted any way the Crown agents
- choose, persons could face the death penalty. As I have said so
- many times since 1980, Canada is not a nation like South Africa,
- or Holland or Belgium; it always was, and remains tied to the
- Queen of England's apron strings. Canada, we find, is always
- first in carrying out Queen Elizabeth's wishes. Canadian troops
- have fought in every one of Her Majesty's wars, including the
- Boer War ( 1899- 1903).
- Like its American counterpart, the Canadian Institute of
- International Affairs is a child of the Royal Institute for Interna-
- tional Affairs (RIIA) and runs Canadian politics. Its members
- have filled the position of Secretary of State ever since it was
- founded in 1925. The Institute for Pacific Relations, the body
- that fostered the attack on Pearl Harbor, was welcomed in
- Canada after Owen Lattimore and his fellow members had their
- treasonous activities exposed in 1947 and left the United States
- before they could be charged.
- The Canadian Institute for International Affairs is connected
- with the Rank Organization through Sir Kenneth Strong, who
- was second in charge of MI6 at the end of the Second World
- War. As a member of the Order of St. John of Jerusalem, Strong
- is the number two man in Canada for Rank and the British
- Crown's commercial interests. He is on the board of one of the
- most prolific drug banks in the world after the Hong Kong and
- Shanghai Bank, the Bank of Nova Scotia, through which proceeds
- of the Canadian heroin trade are handled.
-
- 190
-
- First in line is Sir Brian Edward Mountain, the ranking
- member of the Knights of the Order of St. John of Jerusalem. It
- is well to remember that, when the British Crown wanted the
- United States to enter the Second World War, it sent Lord
- Beaverbrook and Sir Brian Mountain to meet with President
- Roosevelt to deliver the Crown's orders in this regard. Roosevelt
- complied by ordering the United States Navy to operate out of a
- base in Greenland, from where attacks on German submarines
- were carried out nine months before Pearl Harbor. This was
- done without the knowledge and consent of the Congress.
- Another big name in the Rank-Canadian interfacing was Sir
- Kenneth Keith, a director of Canada's equivalent of the Hong
- Kong and Shanghai Bank, the Bank of Nova Scotia, dripping in
- drug money laundering. He was also on the board of Britain's
- oldest and most venerable newspaper institution, the London
- Times and the Sunday Times. For over 100 years the "Times"
- has been the Crown's voice on foreign affairs, finance matters
- and political life in England.
- Like so many Committee of 300 members, Sir Kenneth
- circulated between MI6 and the opium supply chain of command
- in Hong Kong and China, ostensibly on business for the Cana-
- dian Institute for International Affairs, of which he was a member
- Furthermore, as a director of the Hill Samuel banking house, his
- presence in China and Hong Kong could be explained without
- any problem. One of his closest associates outside of MI6
- circles was Sir Philip de Zuleta, the Committee of 300's direct
- controller of all British prime ministers, both Conservative and
- Labor. Sir Kenneth Strong tied in all the spokes of the drug
- wheel, including terrorism, production of opium, the gold mar-
- kets, dirty money laundering and banking to its central core, the
- British Crown.
- At the top of British Crown control of Canada was Walter
- Gordon. A former member of the Queen's hands-on oversight
- committee, also known as the Privy Council, Gordon sponsored
- the Institute for Pacific Relations via the Canadian Institute of
-
- 191
-
- International Affairs. As a former minister of finance, Gordon
- was able to place Committee of 300 selected accountants and
- lawyers inside the three main chartered banks: the Bank of
- Nova Scotia, the Canadian Imperial Bank and the Toronto
- Dominion Bank.
- Through these three "Crown banks" a network of Commit-
- tee of 300 agents responsible to Gordon oversaw the world's
- second largest dirty drug money laundering operation, with a
- direct open door to China. Before his death, Gordon controlled
- James Endicott, Chester Ronning and Paul Linn, identified by
- MI6 as Canada's top "China specialists." All three men worked
- closely with Chou-En-lai, who once told Gamal Abdul Nasser
- that he would do to Britain and the USA what they had done to
- China, i.e., turn them into nations of heroin addicts. Chou-En-
- lai made good on his promise, starting with American GI's in
- Vietnam. Other close collaborators in the Canadian heroin drug
- ring were John D. Gilmer and John Robert Nicholson, both
- members of the Order of the Knights of St. John of Jerusalem.
- Lord Hartley Shawcross, who is believed to report directly
- to Queen Elizabeth II, was on the board of the Royal Institute
- for International Affairs and chancellor of Sussex University
- where the notorious Tavistock Institute for Human Relations is
- located, with extensive connections in Canada.
- As part of Rank's United States operation, no other single
- company has been more successful for Rank than the Corning
- Group, owners of the Metropolitan Life Insurance Company
- and the New York Life Insurance Company. Committee of 300
- members, Amory Houghton and his brother James Houghton,
- have long served the British Crown through the above named
- insurance companies, and Corning Glass, Dow Corning and
- Corning International. Both sit on the board of IBM and Citicorp.
- James Houghton is a director of the Princeton Institute for
- Advanced Studies, a director of the J. Pierpont Morgan Library,
- a stronghold of the RIIA and the CFR, and he is also a director
- of CBS.
-
- 192
-
- It was the Houghton brother who donated hundreds of
- acres known as Wye Plantation in Maryland to the British
- Crown's Aspen Institute. Also on the Corning Glass board sits
- the Bishop of the Archdiocese of the Anglican (Episcopalian)
- Church of Boston. All this gives the group its much-vaunted air
- of respectability, which insurance company executive s must
- carry, and as we shall see, in addition to James Houghton, Keith
- Funston and John Harper, both on Corning's board, run the
- Metropolitan Life Insurance Company.
- The MASSIVE gridding and interfacing of just this one
- single unit of the Committee of 300 will give us a good indica-
- tion of the vast power at the disposal of the conspirators' hier-
- archy, before which all knees are bowed, including the knee of
- the President of the United States, whomever that happens to be.
- What is important to note is how this American company,
- one of HUNDREDS, is interfaced with British intelligence,
- with Canada, the Far East and South Africa, not to mention its
- gridding of corporate officials and directors reaching into every
- aspect of business and politics in the United States.
- While Metropolitan Life Insurance Company does not begin
- to compare with the Committee of 300's giant Assicurazioni
- Generale, it is nevertheless a good indicator of how the
- Houghtons'power extends right across the business spectrum
- of the U.S. and Canada. Starting with R. H. Macy, (whose floor
- walkers no longer wear red carnations to honor the company's
- affiliation with Communism), the Royal Bank of Canada, Na-
- tional and Westminster Bank, Intertel (a virulent and vile private
- intelligence agency), Canadian Pacific, The Reader's Digest,
- RCA, AT&T, the Harvard Business School, W. R. Grace Shipping
- Company, Ralston Purina Company, U.S. Steel, Irving Trust,
- Consolidated Edison of New York and ABC, the Houghtons'
- power grid extends as far as the Hong Kong and Shanghai Bank.
- Another successful Rank company in the United States is
- the Reliance Insurance Group. As an integral part of the Strate-
- gic Bombing Survey, Reliance established the initial structural
-
- 193
-
- base for brainwashing, opinion-making, polling, survey and the
- systems analysis used by the Tavistock Institute in the United
- States. The Reliance Insurance Company, based in Philadelphia,
- set up the corporate structure which enabled the Strategic
- Bombing Survey to be turned against the people of the United
- States who, although unaware of it, have been subjected to
- savage psychological warfare for the past 45 years.
- A key operative in this assault on the United States was
- David Bialkin of the Committee of 300 law firm, Wilkie, Farr
- and Gallagher. Bialkin ran the Anti-Defamation League (ADL)
- for many years. The ADL is a British intelligence operation
- founded in the U.S. by MI6 and run by Saul Steinberg and Eric
- Trist of Tavistock. Saul Steinberg is the U.S. representative and
- business partner of the Jacob de Rothschild family of London.
- Reliance Corporation is home for Carl Lindner who suc-
- ceeded Eli Black when he "fell" from a 44th floor window of a
- New York skyscraper. Reliance Company interfaces with the
- powerful United Fruit Company of Boston and New Orleans
- run by Max Fisber who, before be was sheepdipped, was a well-
- known Detroit underworld figure. United Fruit Company has
- long been a conveyer of heroin and cocaine into the U.S. under
- the expertise of Misbulam Riklis of Rapid American Corporation
- who masterminds shipments from Canada to the U.S. Remem-
- ber, all this is under the aegis of a single company, gridding and
- interfacing with a myriad of smaller companies and operations
- to give the Committee of 300 full control of a multiplicity of
- operations, each one carefully interlocked in the grid.
- Reliance Group is a spinoff of the parent company whose
- function it is to brainwash the American people through a
- network of pollsters and opinion makers and relies on Opera-
- tions Research for direct links with the Tavistock Institute.
- Another associate company is Leasco, which is closely inter-
- faced with AT&T, Disclosure Incorporated, Western Union In-
- ternational, Imbucon Ltd and Yankelovich, Skelly and White.
- Daniel Yankelovich is the emperor of the polling-opinion
-
- 194
-
- making corporate structure in the United States, a vast apparatus
- which provides "public opinions on social, economic and political
- matters of substance," to quote Edward Bernays. It was this vast
- apparatus that turned the majority of Americans, who had never
- even heard of Saddam Hussein and vaguely knew that Iraq was
- a country somewhere in the Middle East, into a people howling
- for his blood and the extermination of Iraq as a nation.
- Yankelovich utilized to the full all knowledge gained during
- the Second World War. As a second-generation warrior,
- Yankelovich has no equal, which is why ABC polls conducted
- by his company are always in the forefront of "public opinion."
- The population of the United States was targeted in the same
- manner of German worker housing by attacking the sense of
- reality. This technique is, of course, standard training for certain
- intelligence groups, which includes the CIA.
- Yankelovich's task was to destroy traditional American values
- and replace them with New Age-Age of Aquarius values. As the
- Committee of 300's most senior public opinion maker, no one
- can doubt that Yankelovich has done a superb job.
- Probably the best way to explain what methods are used and
- what results are expected to be achieved is to quote John Naisbitt's
- work as explained in his "Trend Report." Naisbitt has acted as
- advisor to Lyndon Johnson, Eastman Kodak, IBM, America
- Express, the Center for Policy Study, Chase Manhattan, General
- Motors, Louis Harris Polls, the White House, Institute of Life
- Insurance, the American Red Cross, Mobil Oil, B.P. and a host of
- Committee of 300 companies and institutions. His methodology,
- derived from MI6 Tavistock procedures, is of course not unique:
-
- "I will briefly outline our methodology. In developing
- Trend Report for our clients we rely mostly on a system
- of monitoring local events and behavior. We are over-
- whelmingly impressed with the extent to which this is a
- bottom-up society, so we monitor what is going on
- locally, rather than what is going on in Washington or
-
- 195
-
- New York. Things start in Los Angeles, in Tampa, in
- Hartford, in Wichita, Portland, San Diego and Denver. It
- is a very much 'from the bottom-up' society.
-
- "The tracking concept employed in determining these
- trends has its roots in WW II. During the war, intelli-
- gence experts sought to find a method for obtaining
- information on enemy nations that public opinion polls
- would normally have provided. Under the leadership of
- Paul Lazarsfeld and Harold Laswell, a method was de-
- veloped for monitoring what was going on in these
- societies that involved doing a content analysis of the
- daily press.
-
- "Although this method of monitoring public thinking
- continues to be the choice of the intelligence commu-
- nity the nation annually spends millions of dollars
- doing newspaper content analyses in all parts of the
- world.... The reason this system of monitoring changes
- in society works so well is that 'news holes' in newspa-
- pers is a closed system. For economic reasons the amount
- of space devoted to news in a newspaper doesn't change
- over time.
-
- "So when something new is introduced into that news
- hole, something or a combination of things has to go out
- or be omitted. The principle involved here is classified
- as a forced choice within a closed system. In this forced
- situation societies add new preoccupations and forget
- old ones. We keep track of the ones that are added and
- the ones that are given up.
-
- "Evidently, societies are like human beings. I do not
- know what the number is, but a person can only keep so
- many problems and concerns in his head at any one
-
- 196
-
- time. If new problems or concerns are added, some
- existing ones must be given up. We keep track of what
- Americans have given up and have taken up.
-
- "The United States is rapidly shifting from a mass indus-
- trial society to an information society and the final impact
- will be more profound than the 19th century shift from
- an agricultural to an industrial society. Starting in 1979,
- the number one occupation in the U.S. became clerking,
- replacing laborer and farmer. In this latter statement is a
- brief history of the United States."
-
- It is not by chance that Naisbitt is a member of the Club of
- Rome and, as such, a "senior staffer" of the Committee of 300.
- He is also one of the senior vice presidents of Yankelovich,
- Skelly and White. What Naisbitt is doing is not forecasting
- trends but MAKING them. We have seen how the industrial
- base of the United States has been destroyed, starting with the
- steel industry. In 1982 I wrote a work I called "Death of the
- Steel Industry," in which I stated that by the mid-1990's, steel
- production in the U.S. will have declined to a point of no return,
- and that the auto and housing industries would go the same way.
- All this has come to pass, and what we are witnessing today
- is not an economic recession due not only to unsound economic
- policies, but the deliberately planned destruction of our indus-
- trial base--and along with it the destruction of America's unique
- middle class--the backbone of the country--which depends on
- a progressive industrial expansion for growth and for steady
- employment.
- This is one of the reasons why the recession, which started
- in earnest in January of 1991, has turned into a depression from
- which the United States as we knew it in the 1960's-1970's will
- most probably never reappear. The economy will not come out
- of the depression of 1991 until at least 1995- 1996, at which time
- the United States will have become an entirely different society
-
- 197
-
- from the one it when the recession began.
- Opinion makers have played no small part in this war on the
- United States; we need to examine the role of the Committee of
- 300 in bringing about these far-reaching changes and how the
- social engineers have used central systems analyses to keep
- public opinion from expressing anything other than the policies
- of the invisible government. How and where did it all begin?
- From documents covering the First World War that I was
- able to gather and examine in the War Office in Whitehall,
- London, it appears that the Royal Institute for International
- Affairs was commissioned by the Committee of 300 to do a
- study of manipulating war information. This task was given to
- Lord Northcliffe and Lord Rothmere and Arnold Toynbee, who
- was MI6's agent at the RIIA. Lord Rothmere's family owned a
- newspaper which was used to support various government po-
- sitions, so it was thought that the paper could change public
- perceptions, especially among the ranks of growing opposition
- to the war.
- The project was housed in Wellington House, named after
- the Duke of Wellesly. American specialists drafted to help Lords
- Rothmere and Northcliffe included Edward Bernays and Walter
- Lippman. The group held "brain storming" sessions to work out
- techniques for mobilizing mass support for the war, especially
- among the working class people whose sons were expected to
- go to the slaughter fields of Flanders in record numbers.
- Using Lord Rothmere's newspaper, new manipulative tech-
- niques were tried out and, after a period of about 6 months, it was
- apparent that they were a success. What the researchers discov-
- ered was that only a very small group of people understood the
- process of reasoning and the ability to observe the problem as
- opposed to passing an opinion on it. This, said Lord Rothmere,
- was the way in which 87% of the British public approached the
- war, and that the same principle applied not only to the war, but
- to every conceivable problem in society in general.
- In this manner, irrationality was elevated to a high level of
-
- 198
-
- public consciousness. The manipulators then played upon this
- to undermine and distract the grasp of reality governing any
- given situation and, the more complex the problems of a modern
- industrial society became, the easier it became to bring greater
- and greater distractions to bear so that what we ended up with
- was that the absolutely inconsequential opinions of masses of
- people, created by skilled manipulators, assumed the position of
- scientific fact.
- Having literally stumbled upon so profound a conclusion,
- the manipulators put it to one test after another during the war,
- so that in spite of hundreds of thousands of the youth of Britain
- being slaughtered on the battlefields of France, there was virtually
- no opposition to the bloody war. Records of the time show that
- by 1917, just before the United States entered the war, 94% of
- the British working class bearing the brunt of the war did not
- have the faintest idea what they were fighting for, other than the
- image created by the media manipulators that the Germans were
- a horrible race, bent upon destroying their monarch and their
- country, and who had to be wiped off the face of the earth.
- Certainly nothing has changed because, in 1991, we had the
- exact same situation created by the news media which allowed
- President Bush to flagrantly violate the Constitution in waging a
- war of genocide against the nation of Iraq with the full consent
- of 87% of the American people. Woodrow Wilson can be cred-
- ited--if that is the proper expression to use--of jumping on the
- public opinion manipulators' band wagon and using it to further
- the causes whispered in his ear by his controller, Colonel House.
- On instructions from President Wilson, or rather Colonel
- House, the Creel Commission was created and, as far as can bb
- ascertained, the Creel Commission was the first organization in
- the United States to use the RIIA techniques and methodology
- for polling and mass propaganda. The psychological warfare
- experiments perfected at Wellington House were used in the
- Second World War with equal success, and have been in continuous
- use in the massive psychological war against the United States
-
- 199
-
- which began in 1946. The methods did not change, only the
- target. Now it was not German worker housing but the middle
- class of the United States that became the focus of the attack.
- As so often happens, the conspirators could not contain their
- glee. After WW II, in 1922 to be precise, Lippmann detailed the
- work done by the RIIA in a book he called "PUBLIC OPINION":
-
- "Public opinion deals with indirect, unseen and puzzling
- facts, and there is nothing obvious about them. The
- situations to which public opinion refers are known only
- as opinions, pictures inside heads of human beings,
- pictures of themselves, of others, of their needs, purposes
- and relationships, are their public opinions. These pictures
- which are acted upon by groups of people, or by indi-
- viduals acting in the name of groups are PUBLIC
- OPINION with capital letters. The picture inside the
- head often misleads men in their dealings with the world
- outside of their heads."
-
- No wonder Lippmann was chosen to make the people of the
- United States "like" the Beatles when they arrived on our shores
- and were thrust upon an unsuspecting country. Combined with
- the propaganda sent forth night and day from radio and television
- it was only a comparatively short time before The Beatles
- became "popular." The technique of radio stations allegedly
- receiving hundreds of requests from imaging listeners for
- Beatlemusic, led to charts and ratings for first, the "top ten" and
- gradually escalated until, by 1992, it has expanded to "the top
- 40 on the charts."
- In 1928, Lippmann's compatriot Edward Bernays wrote a
- book called "CRYSTALLIZING PUBLIC OPINION" and in
- 1928 a second book of his was published entitled simply
- "PROPAGANDA." In it Bernays described his experiences at
- Wellington House. Bernays was a close friend of Master Ma-
- nipulator H.G. Wells, whose many quasi-novels were used by
-
- 200
-
- Bernays to help formulate mass mind control techniques.
- Wells was not shy about his role as a leader in changing
- lower class society, mainly because he was a close friend of
- members of the British royal family, and spent a great deal of
- time with some of the most highly placed politicians of the day,
- men like Sir Edward Grey, Lord Haldane, Robert Cecil of the
- Jewish Cecil family that had controlled the British monarchy
- since a Cecil became the private secretary and lover of Queen
- Elizabeth I, Leo Amery, Halford Mackinder of MI6 and later
- head of the London School of Economics, whose pupil Bruce
- Lockhart would become MI6 controller of Lenin and Trotsky
- during the Bolshevik Revolution, and even the great man himself,
- Lord Alfred Milner.
- One of Well's favorite watering holes was the prestigious St.
- Ermins Hotel, meeting place of the Coefficient Club, a club to
- which certified gentlemen only were admitted and where they
- met once a month. All of the men mentioned above were mem-
- bers and also members of the Souls Club. Wells claimed that
- any nation could be defeated, not by direct confrontation but by
- understanding the human mind--what he called, "the mental
- hinterlands hidden behind the persona."
- With such a powerful backer, Bernays felt confident enough
- to launch his "PROPAGANDA":
-
- "As civilization becomes more complex, AND AS THE
- NEED FOR INVISIBLE GOVERNMENT HAS
- BEEN INCREASINGLY DEMONSTRATED (em-
- phasis added-JC), the technical means have been invented
- and developed BY WHICH PUBLIC OPINION MAY
- BE REGIMENTED (emphasis added-JC). With print-
- ing press and newspaper, the telephone, telegraph, radio
- and airplanes, ideas can be spread rapidly, and even
- instantaneously, across the whole of America." Bernays
- had not yet seen how much better television, which was
- to follow, would do the job.
-
- 201
-
-
- <<<<< cont in Committee of 300 - part 9 >>>>>
-
-
- --
- <*> Don Allen <*> 1:363/81.1 - Fidonet #1 - Homebody BBS
- dona@bilver.uucp - Internet 1:363/29.8 - Fidonet #2 - Gourmet Delight
- 88:4205/1.1 - MUFON Network 1:3607/20.2 -- Odyssey - Alabama UFO Net
- NSA grep food: Aviary, Ed Dames, Los Alamos - Majestic - Jason - RIIA - UN
-
- Path: igor.rutgers.edu!rutgers!jvnc.net!darwin.sura.net!haven.umd.edu!uunet!peora!tarpit!tous!bilver!dona
- From: dona@bilver.uucp (Don Allen)
- Newsgroups: alt.conspiracy
- Subject: FILE: Committee of 300 - Part 9
- Message-ID: <1992Nov15.200046.27739@bilver.uucp>
- Date: 15 Nov 92 20:00:46 GMT
- Organization: W. J. Vermillion - Winter Park, FL
- Lines: 1247
-
-
- --- Committee of 300 - Part 9 --------------------------------------------
-
-
- Copyright (C) 1992 by Dr. John Coleman
-
- Conspirators' Hierarchy: The Story of the Committee of 300", by
- Dr. John Coleman, is reproduced here with the permission of the
- publisher: America West Publishers.
-
- INSTITUTIONS THROUGH WHICH
-
- CONTROL IS EXERCISED
- (Cont.)
-
- "The conscious and intelligent manipulation of orga-
- nized habits and opinions of the masses is an impor-
- tant element in a democratic society. Those who ma-
- nipulate this unseen mechanism of society constitute an
- INVISIBLE GOVERNMENT WHICH IS THE
- TRUE RULING POWER IN OUR COUNTRY." To
- back up his position, Bernays quoted H. G. Wells' article
- published in the New York Times in which Wells enthu-
- siastically backed the idea of modern means of commu-
- nication "opening up a new world of political processes
- which will allow the common design to be documented
- and sustained against perversion and betrayal" (of the
- invisible government).
-
- To continue with the revelations contained in
- "PROPAGANDA":
-
- "We are governed, our minds are moulded, our tastes
- formed, our ideas suggested, largely by men we have
- never heard of. What ever attitude one chooses to take
- toward this condition, it remains a fact that in almost
- every act of our daily lives, whether in the sphere of
- politics or business, our social conduct or our ethical
- thinking, we are dominated by a relatively small number
- of persons, a trifling fraction of our hundred and twenty
- million, who understand the mental processes and social
- patterns of the masses. It is they who pull the wires
- which control the public mind, and who harness old
- social forces and contrive new ways TO BIND AND
- GUIDE THE WORLD" (emphasis added-JC).
-
- Bernays was not bold enough to tell the world who the
- "THEY" are who "pull the wires which control the public
- mind...," but in this book we shall make up for his intentional
- oversight by disclosing the existence of that "relatively small
-
- 202
-
- number of persons," the Committee of 300. Bernays was roundly
- applauded for his work by the CFR whose members voted to
- place him in charge of CBS. William Paley became his "under-
- graduate" and eventually replaced Bernays, having acquired
- thorough knowledge of the new-science science of public opin-
- ion making, which made CBS the leader of the field, a role
- which CBS television and radio has never relinquished.
- Political and financial control by the "relatively small num-
- ber," as Bernays called them, is exercised through a number of
- secret societies, most notably the Scottish Rite of Freemasonry,
- and perhaps even more importantly, through the Venerable Or-
- der of the Knights of St. John of Jerusalem, an ancient order
- consisting of the British monarch's hand-picked executives
- chosen for their expertise in areas vital to the continued control
- of the Committee.
- In my work "The Order of St. John of Jerusalem" published
- in 1986, I described The Order in the following manner:
-
- "...It is therefore not a secret society, except where its
- purposes have been perverted in the inner councils like
- the Order of the Garter, which is a prostituted oligarchi-
- cal creation of the British royal family, which makes a
- mockery of what the Sovereign Order of St. John of
- Jerusalem stands for.
-
- "As an example, we find the atheist Lord Peter
- Carrington, who pretends to be an Anglican Christian
- but who is a member of the Order of Osiris and other
- demonic sects, including Freemasonry, installed as a
- Knight of the Garter at St. George's Chapel, Windsor
- Castle, by Her Majesty, Queen Elizabeth II of England,
- of the Black Nobility Guelphs, also head of the Anglican
- Church, which she thoroughly despises."
-
- Carrington was selected by the Committee of 300 to bring
-
- 203
-
- down the government of Rhodesia, sign over the mineral wealth
- of Angola and South West Africa to City of London control,
- wreck the Argentine and turn NATO into a leftwing political
- organization beholden to the Committee of 300.
- Another strange face we see attaching itself to the Holy
- Christian Order of St. John of Jerusalem, and I use the word
- stranger as it is used in the original Hebrew of the Old Testa-
- ment to denote the lineage of an individual, is that of Major
- Louis Mortimer Bloomfield, the man who helped plan the mur-
- der of John F. Kennedy. We see photos of this "strange" man
- wearing with pride the Cross of Malta, the same cross worn on
- the sleeve of the Knights of the Order of the Garter.
- We have been so brainwashed that we believe the British
- royal family is just a nice, harmless and colorful institution, and
- fail to realize just how corrupt and therefore highly dangerous is
- this institution called the British Monarchy. The Knights of the
- Order of the Garter are the INNERMOST circle of the most
- corrupt public servants who have utterly betrayed the trust
- placed in them by their nation, their people.
- The Knights of the Order of the Garter are the leaders of the
- Committee of 300, Queen Elizabeth II's most trusted "privy
- council." When I did my research on the Order of St. John of
- Jerusalem some years ago, I went to Oxford to talk with one of
- the Masters who is a specialist on ancient and modern British
- traditions. He told me that the Knights of the Garter are the inner
- sanctum, the elite of the elite of Her Majesty's Most Venerable
- Order of St. John of Jerusalem. Let me say this is not the
- original order founded by the true Christian warrior, Peter Gerard,
- but is typical of many fine institutions that are taken over and
- destroyed from the inside, while yet appearing to the uninitiated
- to be the original.
- From Oxford I went to the Victoria and Albert Museum and
- gained access to the papers of Lord Palmerston, one of the
- founders of the Opium Dynasty in China. Palmerston, like so
- many of his kind, was not only a Freemason, but a dedicated
-
- 204
-
- servant of Gnosticism.... Like the present 'royal family,'
- Palmerston made a pretense of being a Christian but was in fact
- a servant of Satan. Many satanists became leaders of British aris-
- tocracy and made immense fortunes out of the China opium trade.
- I learned from the papers in the museum named after Victoria
- that she changed the name of the Order of St. John of Jerusalem
- in 1885 in order to break away from the Catholic connection of
- the Order's founder, Peter Gerard, and renamed it the "Protestant
- Most Venerable Order of Jerusalem." Membership was open to
- every oligarchical family that had made its fortune in the China
- opium trade and every thoroughly decadent family received
- place in the 'new order.'
- Many of these venerable gentlemen were responsible for
- overseeing the prohibition era in the United States from Canada,
- where several of its members supplied the whisky ferried to the
- United States. Notable among this group was Committee of 300
- member Earl Haig, who gave his whisky franchise to old Joe
- Kennedy. Both prohibition and the distilleries who met the
- demand for alcohol were creations of the British Crown acting
- through the Committeemen of 300. It was an experiment which
- became the forerunner of today's drug trade, and the lessons
- learned from the prohibition era are being applied to the soon to
- be legalized drug trade.
- Canada is the route most used by Far East heroin suppliers.
- The British Monarchy sees to it that this information never
- becomes public. Using her powers, Queen Elizabeth rules over
- Canada through the Governor-General (one wonders how modern
- Canadians can accept such an archaic arrangement?), who is the
- Queen's PERSONAL representative, and on down the line to
- the Privy Council (yet another archaic hang-over from colonialist
- days) and the Knights of St. John of Jerusalem, who control
- Canadian commerce in all of its facets.
- Opposition to British rule is suppressed. Canada has some
- of the most restrictive laws in the world, including so-called
- "hate crime" laws imposed upon the country by Jewish men-
-
- 205
-
- bers of the House of Lords in England. At present there are four
- major trials in various stages in Canada involving persons charged
- with "hate crimes." These are the Finta, Keegstra, Zundel and
- Ross cases. Anyone who dares to try and show proof of Jewish
- control of Canada (which the Bronfmans exercise), is immedi-
- ately arrested and charged with so-called "hate crimes." This
- will give us some idea of the vastness of the reach of the
- Committee of 300 which quite literally sits on top of everything
- n this world.
- Testifying to the truth of this statement is the fact that the
- Committee of 300 set up the International Institute for Strategic
- Studies (IISS) under the auspices of the Round Table. This
- institute is the vehicle for M16-Tavistock black propaganda and
- wet jobs (an intelligence cover name denoting an operation
- where bloodshed is required), nuclear and terrorist, which goes
- to the world's press for dissemination, as well as to government
- and military establishments.
- Membership of IISS includes representatives of 87 major
- wire services and press associations as well as 138 senior editors
- and columnists drawn from international newspapers and maga-
- zines. Now you know where your favorite columnist gets all of
- his information and opinions from. Remember Jack Anderson,
- Tom Wicker, Sam Donaldson, John Chancellor, Mary McGrory,
- Seymour Hersh, Flora Lewis and Anthony Lewis, et al? The
- information provided by IISS, especially scenarios like those
- prepared to blacken President Hussein and to justify the coming
- attack on Libya and condemn the PLO are all specially tailor-
- made for the occasion. The Mai Lai massacre story published by
- Seymour Hersh came straight out of IISS, just in case we wrongly
- suppose that men like Hersh do their own research work.
- The International Institute for Strategic Studies is nothing
- more than a higher echelon opinion-maker as defined by
- Lippmann and Bernays. Instead of writing books, newspapers
- report opinions presented by chosen columnists, and IISS was
- formed to be a coordinating center for not only creating opin-
-
- 206
-
- ions, but to get those opinions and scenarios out much faster and
- to a greater audience than could be reached by a book, for
- example. IISS is a good example of the gridding and interfacing
- of Committee of 300 institutions.
- The idea of bringing IISS into being arose at the 1957
- Bilderberger meeting. It will be recalled that the Bilderberger
- Conference is a creation of M16 under the direction of the Royal
- Institute of International Affairs. The idea came from Alastair
- Buchan, son of Lord Tweedsmuir. Buchan was chairman at the
- time, and a board member of the RIIA and a member of the
- Round Table reportedly very close to the British royal family
- This was the same conference that welcomed Labour Party
- leader Dennis Healey to its ranks. Others in attendance were
- Francois Duchene, whose mentor, Jean Monet Duchenes, ran
- the Trilateral Commission under the tutelage of H. V. Dicks
- from Tavistock's Columbus Center.
- Among the governing council of this gigantic propaganda
- opinion-making apparat is included the following:
- Frank Kitson, a one time controller of The IRA
- PROVISIONALS, the man who started the Mau-
- Mau insurgency in Kenya.
- Lazard Freres, represented by Robert Ellsworth.
- N. M. Rothschild, represented by John Loudon.
- Paul Nitze, representative of Schroeder Bank. Nitze has
- played a very prominent and substantial role in mat-
- ters of Arms Control agreements, which have AL-
- WAYS been under the direction of the RIIA.
- C. L. Sulzberger of the New York Times.
- Stansfield Turner, a former director of the CIA.
- Peter Calvocoressi, representing Penguin Books.
- Royal Institute for International Affairs, represented by
- Andrew Schoenberg.
- Columnists and Reporters, represented by Flora Lewis,
- Drew Middleton, Anthony Lewis, Max Frankel.
- Daniel Ellsberg.
-
- 207
-
- Henry Kissinger.
- Robert Bowie, a former director of the ClA's National
- Intelligence Estimates.
- Flowing from the 1957 Bilderberger meeting, Kissinger was
- instructed to open a Round Table office in Manhattan, the nucleus
- of which consisted of Haig, Ellsberg, Halperin, Schlessinger,
- McNamara and the McBundy brothers. Kissinger was directed to
- fill all executive positions in the Nixon administration with
- Round Tablers, loyal to the RIIA and therefore to the Queen of
- England. It was no accident that Kissinger chose President
- Nixon's old hangout, the Hotel Pierre, as his center of operations.
- The significance of the Round Table-Kissinger operation
- was thus: On orders of the RIIA chairman Andrew Schoeberg, a
- block was placed on all agencies involved in intelligence, pre-
- venting them from giving information to President Nixon. This
- meant Kissinger and his staff were getting ALL INTELLI-
- GENCE, FOREIGN AND DOMESTIC, LAW ENFORCE-
- MENT INFORMATION, INCLUDING FBI DIVISION 5, be-
- fore any of it was released to the President. This made certain
- that all M16-controlled terrorist operations in the U.S. would
- have no chance of being leaked. This was Halperin's bailiwick.
- By working this methodology, Kissinger at once established
- hegemony over the Nixon presidency, and after Nixon was
- disgraced by the Kissinger group and hounded from office,
- Kissinger emerged with unprecedented powers such as have not
- been equaled before or since Watergate. Some of these seldom
- enumerated powers included the following:
- Kissinger ordered National Security Decision Memorandum
- No. I to be drafted by Halperin, who got the actual wording
- directly from the RIIA through Round Table circles. The
- memorandum appointed Kissinger as the supreme U.S. author-
- ity, chairman of the Verification Panel. All SALT negotiations
- were directed from here, using Paul Nitze, Paul Warnke and a
- nest of traitors inside the Arms Control mission at Geneva.
- In addition, Kissinger was appointed to The Vietnam Special
-
- 208
-
- Studies Group, which oversaw and made evaluations of all
- reports, civilian and military, including intelligence reports
- coming out of Vietnam. Kissinger also demanded and got over-
- sight of the "40 Committee," a super-secret agency that has the
- task of deciding when and where to initiate covert activities and
- then monitors the progress of operations it sets in motion.
- Meantime Kissinger ordered a blizzard of wire-taps by the
- FBI, even on his closest assistants, so as to give the impression
- that he was on top of everything. Most of his circle were told
- that wiretaps on them were in force. This nearly backfired was
- an M16 operative by the name of Henry Brandon was ordered
- wiretapped, but was not informed by Kissinger. Brandon was
- doubling as a reporter for the London Times and Kissinger very
- nearly got thrown out because nobody does this to the London Times.
- The full story of the Ellsberg break-in and the subsequent
- Watergating of Nixon is too long to be included here. Suffice to
- say, Kissinger had control of Ellsberg from the day that Ellsberg
- was recruited while at Cambridge. Ellsberg had always been a
- hardliner in favor of the Vietnam War, but was gradually "con-
- verted" to a radical leftist activist. His "conversion" was only a
- shade less miraculous than St. Paul's Damascus Road experience.
- The entire spectrum of the new left in the United States was
- the work of British intelligence M16 acting through Round
- Table assets and the Institute for Policy Studies (IPS). Just as it
- did with all countries with a republican base, whose policies had
- to be changed, LPS played a leading role, even as it does today in
- South Africa and South Korea. Much of IPS's activities are
- explained in my work "IPS Revisited" published in 1990.
- IPS had one main function, that being to sow discord and
- spread disinformation resulting in chaos. One such program,
- aimed at America's youth, centered on drugs. Through a series
- of IPS fronts, acts like the stoning of Nixon's motorcade and a
- large number of bombings, a climate of deception was effec-
- tively created which led a majority of Americans to believe that
- the United States was under threat from the KGB, the GRU and
-
- 209
-
- Cuban DGI. The word went out that a lot of these imaginary
- agents had close ties to the Democrats through George
- McGovern. It was in fact, a model disinformation campaign for
- which M16 is justly famous.
- Haldeman, Ehrlichman and Nixon's closest aides had no
- clue as to what was happening, hence a flurry of statements
- emanating from the White House that East Germany, The Soviet
- Union, North Korea and Cuba were training terrorists and funding
- their operations in the United States. I doubt whether Nixon
- knew very much about IPS, let alone suspected what it was
- doing to his presidency. We suffered the same kind of
- disinformation during the Gulf War when the word went out that
- terrorists of all stripes were about to invade the United States
- and blow up everything in sight.
- President Nixon was literally left in the dark. He didn't even
- know that David Young, a Kissinger pupil, was working in the
- basement of the White House, supervising "leaks." Young was a
- graduate of Oxford and a long-time Kissinger associate through
- Round Table assets such as the law firm of Milbank Tweed.
- President Nixon was no match for the forces arrayed against
- him under the direction of M16 on behalf of the Royal Institute
- for International Affairs and hence the British royal family.
- About the only thing that Nixon was guilty of, in so far as
- Watergate is concerned, was his ignorance of what was going on
- all around him. When James McCord "confessed" to Judge John
- Sirica, Nixon should have been on to it like a flash that McCord
- was playing a double game. He ought to have challenged
- Kissinger about his relationship with McCord there and then.
- That would have thrown a spanner in the works and derailed the
- whole M16-Watergate operation.
- Nixon did not abuse his presidential powers. His crime was
- not defending the Constitution of the United States of America
- and not charging Mrs. Katherine Meyer Graham and Ben Brad-
- ley with conspiracy to commit insurrection. Mrs. Katherine
- Meyer Graham's pedigree is of the most doubtful kind, as
-
- 210
-
- "Jessica Fletcher" of "Murder She Wrote" would soon have
- discovered. But even knowing that, Mrs. Graham's controllers
- in the Round Table would have fought hard to keep the lid on
- things. The role of the Washington Post was to keep the pot
- boiling by one "revelation" after another, thereby engendering a
- climate of public distrust of President Nixon, even when there
- was not one shred of evidence to support wrong doing by him.
- Yet it shows the immense power of the press, as Lippman
- and Bernays had quite properly anticipated, in that Mrs. Graham,
- long suspected of the murder of her husband, Philip L. Gra-
- ham--officially classed as "suicide"--should have retained any
- credibility at all. Other traitors who should have been indicted
- for insurrection and treason were Kissinger, Haig, Halperin,
- Ellsberg, Young, McCord, Joseph Califano and Chomsky of IPS
- and those CIA operatives who went to McCord's house and
- burned all of his papers. Again, it is worth repeating that
- Watergate, like many other operations we do not have the space
- to include here, demonstrated the COMPLETE CONTROL
- exercised over the United States by the Committee of 300.
- While Nixon kept company with people like Earl Warren
- and some Mafia dons who had built Warren's house, that does
- not mean that he should have been disgraced over the Watergate
- Affair. My dislike of Nixon stems from his willingness to sign
- the infamous ABM Treaty in 1972 and his all-too-cozy relation-
- ship with Leonid Brezhnev. One of the sorriest slip-ups of the
- Minority Council was its abject failure to expose the dirty role
- played by INTERTEL, the Corning Group's ugly private intel-
- ligence agency whom we have already met, who "leaked" a lot
- of Watergate material to Edward Kennedy. Private intelligence
- agencies like INTERTEL have no right to exist in the United
- States. They are a MENACE to our right to privacy and an insult
- to all free men everywhere.
- Blame must also fall on those who were supposed to protect
- President Nixon from the kind of steelmesh net that was thrown
- around him to isolate him. The intelligence personnel around
-
- 211
-
- Nixon were a poor lot who had no knowledge of just how
- thorough British intelligence operations are; indeed, they had no
- inkling that Watergate was a British intelligence operation in its
- entirety. The Watergate plot was a coup-d'etat against the United
- States of America, as was the murder of John F. Kennedy.
- Although this fact is not recognized as such today, I am confi-
- dent that when all the secret papers are finally opened, history
- will record that two coup-d'etats, one against Kennedy and one
- against Nixon, did indeed take place, and which in their wake
- brought the most violent rape and assault on the institutions
- upon which the Republic of the United States stands.
- The individual who most deserves the title of traitor and
- who is most guilty of sedition is General Alexander Haig. This
- desk-man office-colonel whose paper-shuffling career did not
- include commanding any troops in battle, was suddenly thrust
- upon the scene by the invisible upper-level parallel government
- President Nixon once described him as a man who had to ask
- Kissinger's permission to go to the bathroom.
- Haig was a product of the Round Table. He was noticed by
- Round Tabler Joseph Califano, one of Her Majesty's most trusted
- Round Tablers in the United States. Joseph Califano, legal
- council of the Democratic National Convention, had actually
- interviewed Alfred Baldwin, one of the plumbers A MONTH
- BEFORE THE BURGLARY TOOK PLACE. Califano was stu-
- pid enough to write a memorandum on his interview with Baldwin,
- in which he gave details of information on McCord's background
- and why McCord had selected Baldwin to be on the "team."
- Even more damaging, Califano's memorandum contained
- full details of transcripts of wiretaps of conversations between
- Nixon and the reelection committee, all this BEFORE the break-
- in occurred. Califano should have been indicted on a score of
- federal offenses; instead he got away cleanly with his criminal
- activity. Sanctimonious Sam Ervin refused to allow Fred
- Thompson, Minority Council, to introduce this highly damag-
- ing evidence at the Watergate hearings--on the spurious grounds
-
- 212
-
- that it was "too speculative."
- On Round Table orders, Kissinger had Haig promoted from
- colonel to four-star general in the most meteoric rise ever re-
- corded in the annals of United States military history, in the
- course of which Haig was leap-frogged over 280 senior U.S.
- Army generals and high-ranking officers.
- During Haig's "promotion," and as a result of it, 25 senior
- generals were forced to resign. As a reward for his treachery
- toward President Nixon, AND THE UNITED STATES, Haig
- was subsequently given the plum job of Commanding General
- of the North Atlantic Treaty Organization forces (NATO), al-
- though he was THE LEAST QUALIFIED COMMANDER
- EVER TO HOLD THAT POSITION. Here again he was leap-
- frogged over 400 senior generals from NATO countries and the
- United States.
- When the news of his appointment reached the Soviet Armed
- Forces High Command, Marshall Orgakov recalled his three top
- Warsaw Pact generals from Poland and East Germany, and there
- was much merrymaking, clinking of glasses and quaffing of
- champagne until well into the night. All through Haig's tenure
- as commander of NATO forces the professional elite cadre of
- the Soviet Armed Forces, men who have never been anything
- else but professional soldiers, held Haig in the utmost contempt
- and openly referred to him as the "office manager of NATO."
- They knew that Haig owed his appointment to the RIIA and not
- to the United States military.
- But before his military promotion took him out of Washing-
- ton, let it be known that Alexander Haig, in conjunction with
- Kissinger, all but destroyed the office of the President of the
- United States and its government. The chaos left by Kissinger
- and Haig in the wake of Watergate has never been chronicled to
- the best of my knowledge. On the insistence of the RIIA, Haig
- virtually took over the management of the Government of the
- United States after the April 1973 coup d'etat. Bringing 100
- Round Table agents chosen from the Brookings Institution,
-
- 213
-
- Institute Policy Studies and the Council on Foreign Rela-
- tions, Haig filled the top one hundred posts in Washington with
- men who, like himself, were beholden to a foreign power. In the
- ensuing debacle, the Nixon Administration was torn asunder
- and the United States along with it.
- Thrusting aside the pious platitudes and posturings of de-
- fending the Constitution, Senator Sam Ervin did more to change
- the United States than anything President Nixon was alleged to
- have done, and the United States has not yet recovered from the
- near-mortal wound of Watergate, a Committee of 300 sponsored
- operation conducted by the Royal Institute for International
- Affairs, the Round Table and "hands on" M16 officers based in
- the United States.
- The way President Nixon was first isolated, surrounded by
- traitors and then confused, followed to the letter the Tavistock
- method of gaining full control of a person according to the
- methodology laid down by Tavistock's chief theoretician, Dr.
- Kurt Lewin. I have already given details of Lewin's methodol-
- ogy elsewhere in this book, but in view of the text-book case of
- President Richard M.Nixon, I think it is worth repeating:
-
- "One of the main techniques for breaking morale through
- a strategy of terror consists in exactly this tactic--keep
- the person hazy as to where he stands and just what he
- may expect. In addition, if frequent vacillations between
- severe disciplinary measures and promises of good
- treatment together with the spreading of contradictory
- news, make the cognitive structure of this situation utterly
- unclear, then the individual may cease even to know a
- particular plan would lead toward or away from his goal.
- Under these conditions even those individuals who have
- definite goals and are ready to take risks are paralyzed
- by severe inner conflict in regard to what to do."
-
- Kissinger and Haig followed Tavistock training manuals to
-
- 214
-
- the letter. The result was a distraught, confused, frightened and
- demoralized President Nixon, whose only course of action--he
- was told by Haig--was to resign. In 1983 I wrote two works, "The
- Tavistock Institute: Sinister and Deadly" and "The Tavistock
- Institute: Britain's Control of U.S. Policy," based upon Tavistock
- secret manuals which had fallen into my hands. Tavistock
- Institute's methods and actions are spelled out in these two works.
- So successfully were Tavistock methods applied to unseat
- President Nixon that the people of this nation fully believed the
- calumny of lies, distortions and set-piece contrived situations
- mounted by the conspirator as truth, when in fact Watergate was
- a diabolical lie from end to end. It is important to stress this because
- we have certainly not seen the last of Watergate-type operations.
- What were the alleged impeachable offenses committed by
- President Nixon, and the so-called "smoking gun" evidence
- which was supposed to back up the charges? First, the "smoking
- gun." This piece of FICTION was created by Kissinger and
- Haig around the June 23rd tape, which Haig coerced Nixon into
- surrendering to Leon Jaworski.
- Haig spent hours convincing President Nixon that this tape
- would sink him, because it proved "beyond any doubt" that
- Nixon was guilty of serious wrong doing and a co-conspirator in
- the Watergate break-in. President Nixon's first response was to
- tell Haig, "It's utter nonsense to make such a big deal of this,"
- but Haig chipped away until Nixon became convinced that he
- could not make a successful defense before the Senate, based
- solely on this particular June 23rd tape!
- How had Haig accomplished his mission? Acting out a
- scenario prepared for him by his Round Table controllers, Haig
- had an unedited transcript of the "smoking gun" tape typed by
- his staff. In reality there was nothing in the tape that President
- Nixon could not have explained. Sensing this, Haig then circu-
- lated his unauthorized unedited transcript of the tape among
- Nixon's staunchest supporters in the House and Senate and the
- Republican Party high command. Peppered with "smoking gun"
-
- 215
-
- and "devastating," and coming from Nixon's trusted aide, the
- transcript had the effect of a falcon hitting a flock of pigeons;
- Nixon's supporters panicked and ran for cover.
- Following up his sedition and insurrection, Haig summoned
- to his office Congressman Charles Wiggins, a staunch Nixon
- supporter who had agreed to lead the fight in the House to head
- off impeachment proceedings. In a bare-faced blatant lie, Wiggins
- was informed by Haig, "The fight is lost." After that Wiggins
- lost all interest in defending Nixon, believing that Nixon himself
- had agreed to give up. Haig then dealt with Senator Griffin, a
- leading supporter of the president in the Senate in the same way.
- AS A RESULT OF HAIG'S SEDITIOUS, TREASONOUS
- ACTIVITIES, SENATOR GRIFFIN IMMEDIATELY WROTE
- A LETTER TO PRESIDENT NIXON CALLING UPON HIM
- TO RESIGN.
- THREE MONTHS EARLIER, Round Table controlled In-
- stitute for Policy Studies, child of James Warburg, founder and a
- fellow, Marcus Raskin, delivered EXACTLY the same ultima-
- tum that President Nixon resign, using the British intelligence
- propaganda journal, The New York Times of May 25th to deliver
- the ultimatum. The Watergate tragedy was a step in the irre-
- versible transition to barbarism which is enveloping the United
- States, and which is leading us into the One World Government-
- New World Order. The United States is now at the same place
- that Italy found itself when Aldo Moro tried to rescue it from
- created instability.
- With what wrongdoing was Nixon charged? John Doar,
- whose brutish character was well-suited to his task of bringing
- so-called articles of impeachment against the president, was the
- author and finisher of one of the most far-reaching ILLEGAL
- domestic surveillance counterintelligence operations ever run in
- the United States.
- Heading the Interdepartmental Intelligence Unit (IDIU), Doar
- garnered information from every conceivable agency of the
- federal government, including the Internal Revenue Service.
-
- 216
-
- The program was linked to the Institute for Policy Studies. One
- of the highlights of John Doar's career was to provide the
- CIA--which is forbidden by law to engage in domestic surveil-
- lance, with 10,000-12,000 names of citizens he suspected as
- political dissidents, for further investigation.
- On July 18th, 1974, this great upholder of the law, with
- measured pomposity, delivered the "charges" against President
- Nixon, which episode was nationally televised. THERE WAS
- NOT A SINGLE PIECE OF EVIDENCE THAT NIXON HAD
- DONE ANYTHING IMPEACHABLE; indeed, Doar's pathetic
- litany of Nixon's alleged "crimes" were so trivial that it is a
- wonder the proceedings went beyond this point. Income tax
- fiddling, unauthorized bombing of Cambodia and a vague "abuse
- of power" charge that would never have stuck in a court of law
- was the best that Doar could do. The United States was as
- unstable as it would ever be when President Nixon resigned on
- August 8th, 1974.
- Nowhere more so than in our economic and fiscal policies.
- In 1983 the international bankers met in Williamsburg, Virginia
- to work out a strategy to prepare the United States for a total
- disintegration of its banking system. This planned event was to
- stampede the U.S. Senate into accepting control of our mon-
- etary and fiscal policies by the International Monetary Fund
- (IMF). Dennis Weatherstone of Morgan Guarantee on Wall
- Street stated that he was convinced this was the only way for the
- United States to save itself.
- The proposal was endorsed by the Ditchley Group which
- had its beginning in May of 1982 at Ditchley Park in London.
- On January lOth-11th, l983, this alien group met in Washington
- D.C., in violation of the Sherman Anti-Trust Act and the Clayton
- Act, and conspired to overthrow the sovereignty of the United
- States of America in its monetary and financial freedom. The
- United States Attorney General knew of the meeting and its
- purpose. Instead of charging members of the group with con-
- spiracy to commit a federal crime, he simply looked the other way.
-
- 217
-
- Under the abovementioned acts, proof of a conspiracy is all
- that is needed for a felony conviction, and there was ample
- evidence that a conspiracy did indeed take place. But as the
- Ditchley Foundation had met at the request of the Royal Insti-
- tute for International Affairs and was hosted by the Round
- Table, no one in the Justice Department had the courage to take
- action as required by those who had sworn to uphold the laws of
- the United States.
- The Ditchley Plan to usurp control of the fiscal and mon-
- etary policies of the United States was the brainchild of Sir
- Harold Lever, a strong backer of Zionism and a close confidant
- of members of the British royal family and a member of the
- Committee of 300. Sir Harold Lever was a director of the giant
- UMILEVER conglomerate, an important Committee of 300
- company. Lever's plan called for the IMF's influence to be
- broadened so that it could influence central banks of all nations,
- including the U.S. and guide them into the hands of a One World
- Government bank.
- This was considered a vital step in bringing about a situation
- where the IMF would become the supreme arbiter of world
- banking. The ultra-secret January meeting was preceded by an
- earlier meeting in October 1982, and was attended by represen-
- tatives of 36 of the world's top banks who met at the New York
- Vista Hotel. Security for the October 26th-27th seminar was as
- tight as anything ever seen in the Big Apple. This earlier Ditchley
- Group meeting also violated United States law.
- Addressing the meeting, Sir Harold Lever said it was essential
- that national sovereignty as an archaic hang-over must be ended
- before the year 2000. "The United States will soon have to
- realize that it will be no better than any Third World country
- when the IMF takes control," said Sir Harold. It was later
- reported to the delegates that plans to appoint the IMF as the
- controller of United States fiscal policies were being readied to
- bring before the United States Senate by the year 2000.
- Rimmer de Vries, speaking for Morgan Guarantee, said it
-
- 218
-
- was high time that the United States became a member of the
- Bank of International Settlements. "There must be a reconsid-
- eration of U.S. hesitancy over the past 50 years," De Vries
- declared. Some British and German bankers, fearing possible
- violations of U.S. law, said that the Ditchley Group is nothing
- but a committee to iron out exchange rate problems. Felix
- Rohatyn also spoke of the great need to change U.S. banking
- laws so that the IMF could play a greater role in this country.
- Rohatyn headed Lazard Freres, a Club of Rome bank and part of
- the Eagle Star Group which we have already met.
- Round Tablers William Ogden and Werner Stang spoke
- enthusiastically in support of surrendering U.S. fiscal sover-
- eignty to the International Monetary Fund and the Bank of
- International Settlements. Delegates representing the Alpha
- ranking Group, a P2 Freemasonry bank, said the United States
- must be forced to surrender to "the higher authority of a world
- bank," before any progress toward the New World Order could
- be made.
- On January 8th, 1983, before their big meeting on January
- lOth-11th, Hans Vogel, a leading Club of Rome member, was
- received at the White House. President Ronald Reagan had
- invited George Schultz, Caspar Weinberger, George Kennan
- and Lane Kirkland to be present at his meeting with Vogel, who
- explained to President Reagan what the aims and objectives of
- the Ditchley Group were. From that day, President Reagan did
- an about face and worked with the Committee of 300's various
- agencies to advance the International Monetary Fund and the
- Bank of International Settlements as the authority on U.S do-
- mestic and foreign monetary policies.
- The invisible government of the Committee of 300 has put
- tremendous pressure on America to change its ways--for the
- worse. America is the last bastion of freedom and unless our
- freedoms are taken away from us, progress toward a One World
- Government will be considerably slowed. Such an undertaking
- as a One World Government is a massive one, requiring a great
-
- 219
-
- deal of skill, organizing abilities, control of governments and
- their policies. The only organization that could possibly have
- undertaken this mammoth task with any hope of success is the
- Committee of 300, and we have seen just how far it has come
- toward total success.
- Above all, the battle is a spiritual one. Unfortunately, the
- Christian churches have become little more than social clubs
- run by the infinitely evil World Council of Churches (WCC),
- whose beginnings lie not in Moscow but in the City of London,
- as we see from the chart at the end of the book which gives the
- structure of the One World Government Church. This body was
- set up in the 1920's to serve as a vehicle for One World Gov-
- ernment policies, and stands as a monument to the long-range
- planning capabilities of the Committee of 300.
- Another corrupt body similar in structure and design to the
- WCC is the Union of Concerned Scientists, set up by the Trilateral
- Commission, and funded by the Carnegie Endowment Fund, the
- Ford Foundation and Aspen Institute. This is the group that has
- led the fight to prevent the United States from mounting an
- effective deterrent against Soviet Cosmospheres, space-based
- laser beam weapons which can destroy selected targets in the
- United States or elsewhere from outer space.
- The United States SDI program was designed to counter the
- threat posed by Soviet Cosmospheres, a threat which still exists
- in spite of the assurances that "communism is dead." Soviet
- spokesman Georgi Arbatov told a meeting of the Union of
- Concerned Scientists that it is important for them to oppose the
- SDI program, because if the SDI program became operational,
- "it will be a military catastrophe." Year after year the Union of
- Concerned Scientists has opposed every budget which included
- funding for the vital SDI program, until by the end of 1991, there
- is not even enough money to fund further research still required
- let alone place the system in orbit. The Union of Concerned
- Scientists is run by the Royal Institute for International Affairs
- and is heavily infiltrated with M16 British intelligence agents.
-
- 220
-
- There is not one single aspect of life in America that is not
- watched over, steered in the "right" direction, manipulated, and
- controlled by the invisible government of the Committee of
- 300. There is not one elected official or political leader that is
- not subject to its rule. No one thus far has got away with defying
- our secret rulers, who do not hesitate to make "a horrible ex-
- ample" of anyone, including the President of the United States
- of America.
- From 1776 when Jeremy Bentham and William Petty, the
- Earl of Shelburne, fresh from the triumph of the French Revo-
- lution which they planned and ran, were drafted by the British
- Crown to bring their combined experience to bear against the
- colonists, to 1812 when the British sacked and burned Washing-
- ton, destroying secret documents that would have exposed the
- treason being worked against the young United States of America
- to the Watergating of President Nixon and assassination of
- President Kennedy, the hand of the Committee of 300 is clearly
- visible. This book is an attempt to open the eyes of the American
- people to this terrible truth: We are not an independent nation,
- nor can we ever be, as long as we are ruled by an invisible
- government, the Committee of 300.
-
- PAST AND PRESENT INSTITUTIONS/
- ORGANIZATIONS AND THOSE DIRECTLY
- UNDER INFLUENCE OF THE
- COMMITTEE OF 300
-
- Academy for Contemporary Problems.
- Africa Fund.
- Agency of International Development.
- Albert Previn Foundation.
- Alliance Israelite Universalle.
- American Civil Liberties Union
-
- 221
-
- American Council of Race Relations.
- American Defense Society.
- American Press Institute.
- American Protective League.
- Anti-Defamation League.
- Arab Bureau.
- Arab Higher Committee.
- ARCA Foundation.
- Armour Research Foundation.
- Arms Control and Foreign Policy Caucus.
- Arthur D. Little, Inc.
- Asian Research Institute.
- Aspen Institute.
- Association for Humanistic Psychology.
- Augmentation Research Center.
- Baron De Hirsh Fund.
- Battelle Memorial Institute.
- Berger National Foundation.
- Berlin Center for Future Research.
- Bilderbergers.
- Black Order.
- Boycott Japanese Goods Conference.
- British Newfoundland Corporation.
- British Royal Society.
- Brotherhood of Cooperative Commonwealth.
- Bureau of International Revolutionary Propaganda.
- Canadian Jewish Congress.
- Cathedral of St. John the Divine, New York.
- Center for Advanced Studies in the Behavioral Sciences.
- Center for Constitutional Rights.
- Center for Cuban Studies.
- Center for Democratic Institutions.
- Center for International Policy.
- Center for the Study of Responsive Law.
- Christian Socialist League.
-
- 222
-
- Cini Foundation.
- Club of Rome.
- Cominform.
- Committee for the Next Thirty Years.
- Committee of Fourteen.
- Committee on National Morale.
- Committee to Frame A World Constitution.
- Communist League.
- Congress of Industrial Organizations.
- Council on Foreign Relations.
- David Sassoon Company.
- De Beers Consolidated Mines.
- Democratic League of Brussels.
- East India Committee of 300.
- Economic and Social Control (ECOSOC).
- Environmental Fund.
- Environmetrics Inc.
- Esalen Institute.
- Fabian Society.
- Federation of American Zionists.
- Fellowship for a Christian Social Order.
- Fellowship of Reconciliation.
- Ford Foundation.
- Fordham University Institution Educational Research.
- Foundation for National Progress.
- Garland Fund.
- German Marshall Fund.
- Governing Body of the Israelite Religious Community.
- Gulf South Research Institute.
- Haganah.
- Harvard University.
- Hells Fire Club.
- Horace Mann League.
- Hudson Guild.
- Hudson Institute.
-
- 223
-
- Hudson Bay Company.
- Imperial College University of London.
- Industrial Christian Fellowship.
- Institute for Brain Research.
- Institute for Pacific Relations.
- Institute for Policy Studies.
- Institute for Social Research.
- Institute for the Future.
- Institute for World Order.
- Institute on Drugs, Crime and Justice.
- Inter-Alpha.
- Inter-American Social Development Institute.
- International Institute for Strategic Studies.
- Interreligious Peace Colloquium.
- Irgun.
- Knights of Malta.
- League of Nations.
- Logistics Management Institute.
- London Board of Deputies of British Jews.
- London School of Economics.
- Mary Carter Paint Company.
- Massachusetts Institute of Technology.
- Mellon Institute.
- Metaphysical Society.
- Milner Group.
- Mocatto Metals.
- Mont Pelerin Society.
- NAACP.
- National Action Research on Military/lndustrial Complex.
- National Center for Productivity Institute.
- National Council of Churches.
- National Opinion Research Center.
- National Training Laboratories.
- New Democratic Coalition.
- New World Foundation.
-
- 224
-
- New York Rand Institute.
- NORML.
- North Atlantic Treaty Organization (NATO).
- Odd Fellows.
- Order of St. John of Jerusalem.
- Order of The Golden Dawn.
- OXFAM.
- Oxford Univac.
- Pacific Studies Center.
- Palisades Foundation.
- Peninsula and Orient Navigation Company.
- PERMINDEX.
- Princeton University.
- Rand Corporation.
- Rand School of Social Sciences.
- Research Triangle Institution.
- Rhodes Scholarship Committee.
- Rio Tinto Zinc Company.
- Riverside Church Disarmament Program.
- Round Table.
- Royal Institute for International Affairs.
- Russell Sage Foundation.
- San Francisco Foundation.
- Sharps Pixley Ward.
- Social Science Research Council.
- Socialist International.
- Socialist Party of the United States.
- Society for Promotion of Study of Religions.
- Society of Heaven (TRIADS).
- Soviet State Committee for Science and Technology.
- Stanford Research Institute.
- Stockholm International Peace Research Institute.
- Sun Yat Sen Society.
- Systems Development Corporation.
- Tavistock Institute of Human Relations.
-
- 225
-
- Tempo Corporation.
- The High Twelve International.
- The Public Agenda Foundation.
- The Quality of Life Institute.
- Theosophist Society.
- Thule Society.
- Transatlantic Council.
- Trilateral Commission.
- U.S. Association of the Club of Rome.
- U.S. Institute for Peace.
- Union of Concerned Scientists.
- UNITAR.
- University of Pennsylvania Wharton School.
- Warburg, James P. and Family.
- Western Training Laboratories.
- Wilton Park.
- Women's Christian Temperance Union.
- Wong Hong Hon Company.
- Work in America Institute.
- World Council of Churches.
-
- SPECIAL FOUNDATIONS AND INTEREST GROUPS
-
- Arab Bureau.
- Aristotelian Society.
- Asian Research Institute.
- Bertrand Russell Peace Foundation.
- British American Canadian Corporation.
- Brotherhood of Eternal Love.
- Cambridge Apostles.
- Canadian Histadrut Campaign.
- Canadian Pacific Ltd.
- Caribbean-Central American Action Group.
- China Everbright Holdings Ltd.
- Chinese People's Institute of Foreign Affairs.
-
- 226
-
- Council of South America.
- Endangered Peoples' Society.
- English Property Corporation Ltd.
- Hospice Inc.
- International Brotherhood of Teamsters.
- International Red Cross.
- Jerusalem Foundation, Canada.
- Kissinger Associates.
- Kowloon Chamber of Commerce.
- Organization of American States.
- Overseas Chinese Affairs Committee.
- Radio Corporation of America (RCA).
- Royal Police of Hong Kong.
- YMCA.
-
- BANKS
-
- American Express.
- Banca de la Svizzera d'Italia.
- Banca Andioino.
- Banca d'America d'Italia.
- Banca Nazionale del Lavoro.
- Banca Privata.
- Banco Ambrosiano.
- Banco Caribe.
- Banco Commercial Mexicana.
- Banco Consolidato.
- Banco d'Espana.
- Banco de Colombia.
- Banco de Commercio.
- Banco de Iberio-America.
- Banco de la Nacion.
- Banco del Estada.
- Banco Internacional.
- Banco Latino.
-
- 227
-
- Banco Mercantile de Mexico.
- Banco Nacional de Cuba.
- Banco Nacional de Panama and 54 smaller Panamanian
- banks.
- Bangkok Commercial d'Italian.
- Bangkok Metropolitan Bank.
- Bank al Meshreq.
- Bank America.
- Bank for International Settlements.
- Bank Hapoalim.
- Bank Leu.
- Bank Leumi.
- Bank of Bangkok.
- Bank of Boston.
- Bank of Canada.
- Bank of Credit and Commerce International.
- Bank of East Asia.
- Bank of England.
- Bank of Escambia.
- Bank of Geneva.
- Bank of Ireland.
- Bank of London and Mexico.
- Bank of Montreal.
- Bank of Norfolk.
- Bank of Nova Scotia.
- Bank Ohio.
- Banque Bruxelles-Lambert.
- Banque Commerciale Arabes.
- Banque du Credit International.
- Banque e Paris et Pays-Bas.
- Banque Francais et Italienn por l'Amerique du Sud.
- Banque Louis Dreyfus e Paris.
- Banque Privee.
- Banques Sud Ameris.
- Barclays Bank.
-
- 228
-
- Baring Brothers Bank.
- Barnett Banks.
- Baseler Handeslbank.
- Basel Committee on Bank Supervision.
- BCCI.*
- Canadian Imperial Bank of Commerce.
- Centrust Bank.
- Chartered Bank.
- Charterhouse Japhet Bank.
- Chase Manhattan Bank.
- Chemical Bank.
- Citibank.
- Citizens and Southern Bank of Atlanta.
- City National Bank of Miami.
- Claridon Bank.
- Cleveland National City Bank.
- Corporate Bank and Trust Company.
- Credit and Commerce American Holdings.
- Credit and Commerce Holdings, Netherlands Antilles.
- Credit Suisse.
- Crocker National Bank.
- de'Neuflize, Schlumberger, Mallet Bank.
- Dresdener Bank.
- Dusseldorf Global Bank.
- First American Bank of Georgia.
- First American Bank of New York.
- First American Bank of Pensacola.
- First American Bank of Virginia.
- First American Banking Corp.
- First Empire Bank.
- First Fidelity Bank.
- First National Bank of Boston.
- First National City Bank.
- Florida National Bank.
- Foreign Trade Bank.
-
- 229
-
- Franklin National Bank.
- Hambros Bank.
- Hong Kong and Shanghai Banking
- Independence Bank of Encino.
- Israeli Discount Bank.
- Litex Bank.
- Ljubljanska Bank.
- Lloyds Bank.
- Marine Midland Bank.
- Midland Bank.
- Morgan Bank.
- Morgan Et Cie.
- Morgan Grenfell Bank.
- Narodny Bank.
- National Bank of Cleveland.
- National Bank of Florida.
- National Westminister Bank.
- Orion Bank.
- Paravicini Bank Ltd.
- Republic National Bank.
- Royal Bank of Canada.
- Schroeder Bank.
- Seligman Bank.
- Shanghai Commercial Bank.
- Soong Bank.
- Standard and Chartered Bank.
- Standard Bank.
- Swiss Bank Corporation.
- Swiss Israel Trade bank.
- Trade Development Bank.
- Unibank.
- Union Bank of Israel.
- Union Bank of Switzerland.
- Vanying Bank.
- White Weld Bank.
-
- 230
-
- World Bank.
- World Commerce Bank of Nassau.
- World Trade Bank.
- Wozchod Handelsbank.
-
- Note: With the exception of the Basel Committee on Banking
- each of the above mentioned banks have been, and may still be
- involved in the drug, diamond, gold and weapons trade.
-
- * BCCI. This bank has been indicted on several charges of
- being heavily involved in drug money laundering throughout
- the world. Its structure girds every operation of the Committee
- of 300. Of interest is its corporate structure. Middle East
- Interests, 35% of stock held by:
-
- Ruling Family of Bahrain.
- Ruling Family of Sharjah.
- Ruling Family of Dhubai.
- Ruling Family of Saudi Arabia.
- Ruling Family of Iran.
- Group of Middle East Businessmen.
- BCCI Cayman Islands 41%.
- Bank of America 24%.
-
- BCCI Cayman Islands and BCCI Luxembourg established
- Agency offices in Miami, Boca Raton, Tampa, New York, San
- Francisco and Los Angeles.
-
- LEGAL ASSOCIATIONS AND LAWYERS
- American Bar Association.
- Clifford and Warnke.
- Coudert Brothers.
- Cravaith, Swain and Moore.
- Wilkie, Farr and Gallagher.
-
- 231
-
- ACCOUNTANTS/AUDITORS
-
- Price, Waterhouse.
-
- TAVISTOCK INSTITUTIONS IN THE
- UNITED STATES
-
- FLOW LABORATORIES
- Gets contracts from the National Institute of Health.
-
- MERLE THOMAS CORPORATION
- Gets contracts from the U.S. Navy, analyzes data from
- satellites.
-
- WALDEN RESEARCH
- Does work in the field of pollution control.
-
- PLANNING RESEARCH CORPORATION, ARTHUR D.
- LITTLE, G.E. "TEMPO," OPERATIONS RESEARCH
- INC.
- Part of approximately 350 firms who conduct research and
- conduct surveys, make recommendations to government.
- They are part of what President Eisenhower called "a pos-
- sible danger to public policy that could itself become captive of
- a scientific-technological elite."
-
- BROOKINGS INSTITUTION
- Dedicates its work to what it calls a "national agenda."
- Wrote President Hoover's program, President Roosevelt's "New
- Deal," the Kennedy Administration's "New Frontiers" program
- (deviation from it cost John F. Kennedy his life), and President
- Johnson's "Great Society." Brookings has been telling the United
- States Government how to conduct its affairs for the past 70
- years and is still doing so on behalf of the Committee of 300.
-
- 232
-
- HUDSON INSTITUTE
- Under the direction of Herman Khan, this institution has
- done more to shape the way Americans react to political and
- social events, think, vote and generally conduct themselves than
- perhaps any except the BIG FIVE. Hudson specializes in de-
- fense policy research and relations with the USSR. Most of its
- military work is classified as SECRET. (One idea during the
- Vietnam War was to build a moat around Saigon.) Some of its
- earlier papers were entitled "Stability and Tranquility Among
- Older Nations," and "Analytical Summary of U.S. National
- Security Policy Issues."
- Hudson prides itself on its diversity; it helped NASA with
- its space programs and helped to promote new youth fashions
- and ideas, youth rebellion and alienation for the Committee of
- 300, ostensibly funded by Coca Cola. Hudson may be quite
- properly classified as one of the Committee of 300's BRAIN-
- WASHING establishments. Some of its nuclear war scenarios
- make for very interesting reading and, if they can be obtained, I
- would recommend "The 6 Basic Thermonuclear Threats" and
- "Possible Outcomes of Thermonuclear War" and one of its more
- frightening papers entitled "Israeli-Arab Nuclear War."
- Hudson also does corporate advising for Committee of 300
- companies, Rank, Xerox, General Electric, IBM and General
- Motors, to name but a few of them, but its really big client
- remains the U. S. Department of Defense which includes matters
- of civil defense, national security, military policy and arms
- control. To date it has not got into "wet NASA," that is to say,
- the National Oceanographic Agency.
-
- NATIONAL TRAINING LABORATORIES
- NTL is also known as the International Institute for Applied
- Behavioral Sciences. This institute is definitely a brainwashing
- center based on Kurt Lewin principles which include so-called
- T-Groups (training groups), artificial stress training whereby
- participants suddenly find themselves immersed in defending
-
- 233
-
- themselves against vicious accusations. NTL takes in the Na-
- tional Education Association, the largest teacher-group in the
- United States.
- While officially decrying "racism," it is interesting to note
- that NTL, working with NEA, produced a paper proposing
- education vouchers which would separate the hard-to-teach
- children from the brighter ones, and funding would be allocated
- according to the number of difficult children who would be
- separated from those who progressed at a normal rate. The
- proposal was not taken up.
-
-
- <<<<< cont in Committee of 300 - part 10 >>>>>
-
-
- --
- <*> Don Allen <*> 1:363/81.1 - Fidonet #1 - Homebody BBS
- dona@bilver.uucp - Internet 1:363/29.8 - Fidonet #2 - Gourmet Delight
- 88:4205/1.1 - MUFON Network 1:3607/20.2 -- Odyssey - Alabama UFO Net
- NSA grep food: Aviary, Ed Dames, Los Alamos - Majestic - Jason - RIIA - UN
-
- Path: igor.rutgers.edu!rutgers!jvnc.net!darwin.sura.net!haven.umd.edu!uunet!peora!tarpit!tous!bilver!dona
- From: dona@bilver.uucp (Don Allen)
- Newsgroups: alt.conspiracy
- Subject: FILE: Committee of 300 - Part 10
- Message-ID: <1992Nov15.200234.27943@bilver.uucp>
- Date: 15 Nov 92 20:02:34 GMT
- Organization: W. J. Vermillion - Winter Park, FL
- Lines: 1196
-
-
- --- Committee of 300 - Part 10 -------------------------------------------
-
-
- UNIVERSITY OF PENNSYLVANIA, WHARTON
- SCHOOL OF FINANCE & COMMERCE
- Founded by Eric Trist, one of the "brain trusts" of Tavistock,
- Wharton has become one of the more important Tavistock in-
- stitutions in the U.S. in so far as "Behavioral Research" is
- concerned. Wharton attracts clients such as the U.S. Department
- of Labor--which it teaches how to produce "cooked" statistics
- at the Wharton Econometric Forecasting Associates Incorpo-
- rated. This method is very much in demand as we come to the
- close of 1991 with millions more out of work than is reflected in
- USDL statistics.
- Wharton's ECONOMETRIC MODELING is used by every
- major Committee of 300 company in the United States, Western
- Europe and by the International Monetary Fund, the United
- Nations and the World Bank. Wharton has produced such note-
- worthy persons as George Schultz and Alan Greenspan.
-
- INSTITUTE FOR SOCIAL RESEARCH
- This is the institute set up by "brain trusters" from Tavistock
- Rensis Likert, Dorwin Cartwright and Ronald Lippert. Among
- its studies are "The Human Meaning of Social Change," "Youth
- in Transition" and "How Americans View Their Mental Health."
- Among the institute's clients are The Ford Foundation, U.S.
- Department of Defense, U.S. Postal Service and the U.S.
- Department of Justice.
-
- 234
-
- INSTITUTE FOR THE FUTURE
- This is not a typical Tavistock institution in that it is funded
- by the Ford Foundation, yet it draws its long-range forecasting
- methodology from the mother of all think tanks. Institute for the
- Future projects what it believes to be changes that will be taking
- place in time frames of fifty years. The institute is supposed to
- be able to forecast socioeconomic trends and to blow the whistle
- on any departures from what it has laid down as normal.
- Institute for the Future believes it is possible and normal to
- intervene now and give decisions for the future. So-called "Delphi
- Panels" decide what is normal and what is not, and prepare
- position papers to "steer" government in the right direction to
- head off such groups as "people creating civil disorder." (This
- could be patriotic groups demanding abolition of graduated
- taxes, or demanding that their right to bear arms is not infringed.)
- The institute recommends actions such as liberalizing abor-
- tion laws, drug usage and that cars entering an urban area pay
- tolls, teaching birth control in public schools, requiring regis-
- tration of firearms, making the use of drugs a non-criminal
- offense, legalizing homosexuality, paying students for scholas-
- tic achievements, making zoning controls a preserve of the
- state, offering bonuses for family planning and last, but by no
- means least, a Pol Pot Cambodia-style proposal that new com-
- munities be established in rural areas. As will be observed,
- many of the Institute for the Future's goals have already been
- more than fully realized.
-
- INSTITUTE FOR POLICY STUDIES (IPS)
- One of the "Big Three," IPS has shaped and reshaped United
- States policies, foreign and domestic, since it was founded by
- James P. Warburg and the Rothschild entities in the United States,
- bolstered by Bertrand Russell and the British Socialists through
- its networks in America which include the League for Industrial
- democracy in which Leonard Woodcock played a leading, if
- behind-the-scenes role. Local lead players in the League for
-
- 235
-
- Industrial Democracy included "conservative" Jeane Kirkpatrick,
- Irwin Suall (of the ADL), Eugene Rostow (Arms Control nego-
- tiator), Lane Kirkland (Labor leader), and Albert Shanker.
- For record purposes only, IPS was incorporated in 1963 by
- Marcus Raskin and Richard Barnett, both highly-trained
- Tavistock Institute graduates. Most of the funding came from
- Rothschild associates in America like the James Warburg Fam-
- ily, the Stern Family Foundation and the Samuel Rubin Foun-
- dation. Samuel Rubin was a registered member of the Commu-
- nist Party who stole the Faberge name (Faberge was "Jeweler of
- the Imperial Russian Court") and made a fortune out of the
- Faberge name.
- The objectives of IPS came from an agenda laid down for it
- by the British Round Table, which agenda in turn came from
- Travistock Institute, one of the most notable being to create the
- "New Left" as a grass roots movement in the U.S. IPS was to
- engender strife and unrest and spread chaos like a wildfire out of
- control, proliferate the "ideals" of left wing nihilistic socialism,
- support unrestricted use of drugs of all types, and be the "big
- stick" with which to beat the United States political establishment.
- Barnett and Raskin controlled such diverse elements as the
- Black Panthers, Daniel Ellsberg, National Security Council staff
- member Halperin, The Weathermen Underground, the
- Venceramos and the campaign staff of candidate George
- McGovern. No scheme was too big for IPS and its controllers to
- take on and manage.
- Take the plot to "kidnap" Kissinger, which was in the hands
- of Eqbal Ahmed, a British M16 intelligence agent of Pakistani
- origin, laundered through "TROTS" (Trotskyite terrorists based
- in London). The "plot" was "discovered" by the FBI so that it
- could not go too far. Ahmed went on to become the director of
- one of IPS's most influential agencies, The Transnational Insti-
- tute which, chameleon-like, changed from its former name,
- Institute of Race Relations, when intelligence agents of BOSS
- (Bureau of State Security) in South Africa unmasked the fact
-
- 236
-
- that it was tied directly to Rhodes Scholarship-Harry Oppen-
- heimer and Anglo-American-British mining interests in South
- Africa. BOSS also discredited the South Africa Foundation at
- the same time.
- Through its many powerful lobbying groups on Capitol Hill,
- IPS relentlessly used its "big stick" to beat Congress. IPS has a
- network of lobbyists, all supposedly operating independently
- but in actual fact acting cohesively, so that Congressmen are
- pummeled from all sides by seemingly different and varied
- lobbyists. In this way, IPS was, and is still, able to successfully
- sway individual Representatives and Senators to vote for "the
- trend, the way things are going." By using key point men on
- Capitol Hill, IPS was able to break into the very infrastructure of
- our legislative system and the way it works.
- To give only a single concrete example of what I am talking
- about: in 1975, an IPS point man persuaded representative John
- Conyers (D-Michigan) and forty-seven members of the House
- to request IPS to prepare a budget study that would oppose the
- budget being prepared by President Gerald Ford. Although not
- adopted, the request was reinstated in 1976, 1977, and 1978
- gathering sponsors as it went.
- Then in 1978, fifty-six Congressmen signed their names to
- sponsor an IPS budget study. This was prepared by Marcus
- Raskin. Raskin's budget called for a fifty percent cut in the
- Defense Budget, a socialist housing program "that would com-
- pete with and steadily replace private housing and mortgage
- markets," a national health service, "radical changes in the
- educational system that would disrupt capitalist control over the
- distribution of knowledge," and several other radical ideas.
- The influence of IPS on Arms Control negotiations was a
- major factor in getting Nixon to sign the treasonous ABM
- Treaty in 1972, which left the United States virtually defense-
- less against ICBM attack for almost 10 years. IPS became, and
- remains to this day one of the most prestigious "think tanks"
- controlling foreign policy decisions, which we, the people, fool-
-
- 237
-
- ishly believe are those of our law makers.
- By sponsoring militant activism at home and with links to
- revolutionaries abroad, by engineering such victories as "The
- Pentagon Papers," besieging the corporate structure, bridging
- the credibility gap between underground movements and ac-
- ceptable political activism, by penetrating religious organiza-
- tions and using them to sow discord in America, such as radical
- racial politics under the guise of religion, using the establish-
- ment media to spread IPS ideas, and then supporting them, IPS
- has lived up to the role which it was founded to play.
-
- STANFORD RESEARCH INSTITUTE
- Jesse Hobson, the first president of Stanford Research Insti-
- tute, in a 1952 speech made it clear what lines the institute was
- to follow. Stanford can be described as one of the "jewels" in
- Tavistock's Crown in its rule over the United States. Founded in
- 1946 immediately after the close of WW II, it was presided over
- by Charles A. Anderson, with emphasis on mind control re-
- search and "future sciences." Included under the Stanford um-
- brella was Charles F. Kettering Foundation which developed the
- "Changing Images of Man" upon which the Aquarian Con-
- spiracy rests.
- Some of Stanford's major clients and contracts were at first
- centered around the defense establishment but, as Stanford grew,
- so did the diversity of its services:
- Applications of Behavioral Sciences to Research
- Management.
- Office of Science and Technology.
- SRI Business Intelligence Program.
- U.S. Department of Defense Directorate of Defense
- Research and Engineering.
- U.S. Department of Defense Office of Aerospace Research.
- Among corporations seeking Stanford's services were Wells
- Fargo Bank, Bechtel Corporation, Hewlett Packard, Bank of
- America, McDonnell-Douglas Corporation, Blyth, Eastman
-
- 238
-
- Dillon and TRW Company. One of Stanford's more secret
- projects was extensive work on chemical and bacteriological
- warfare (CAB) weapons.
- Stanford Research is plugged into at least 200 smaller "think
- tanks" doing research into every facet of life in America. This is
- known as ARPA networking and represents the emergence of
- probably the most far-reaching effort to control the environment
- of every individual in the country. At present Stanford's comput-
- ers are linked with 2500 "sister" research consoles which in-
- clude the Central Intelligence Agency (CIA), Bell Telephone
- Laboratories, U.S. Army Intelligence, the Office of Naval Intel-
- ligence (ONI), RANI), MIT, Harvard and UCLA. Stanford
- plays a key role in that it is the "library," cataloging all ARPA
- documentation.
- "Other agencies"--and one can use one's imagination here,
- are allowed to search through SRI's "library" for key words,
- phrases, look through sources and update their own master files
- with those of Stanford Research Center. The Pentagon, for
- instance, uses SRI's "master files" extensively, and there is little
- doubt that other U.S. Government agencies do the same. Pentagon
- "command and control" problems are worked out by Stanford.
- While ostensibly these apply only to weapons and soldiers,
- there is absolutely no guarantee that the same research could
- not, and will not, be turned to civilian applications. Stanford is
- known to be willing to do anything for anyone, and it is my
- belief that if ever SRI were to be fully exposed, the hostility
- which would arise from revelations as to what it actually does
- would most probably force SRI to close.
-
- MASSACHUSETTS INSTITUTE OF TECHNOLOGY,
- ALFRED P. SLOAN SCHOOL OF MANAGEMENT
- This major institute is not generally recognized as being a
- part of Tavistock U.S.A. Most people look upon it as a purely
- American institution, but that is far from being the case. MIT-
- Alfred Sloan can be roughly divided into the following groups:
-
- 239
-
- Contemporary Technology.
- Industrial Relations.
- Lewin Group Psychology.
- NASA-ERC Computer Research Laboratories.
- Office of Naval Research Group, Psychology.
- Systems Dynamics. Forrestor and Meadows wrote The
- Club of Rome's "Limits of Growth" zero growth
- study.
- Some of MIT's clients include the following:
- American Management Association.
- American Red Cross.
- Committee for Economic Development.
- GTE.
- Institute for Defense Analysis (IDA).
- NASA.
- National Academy of Sciences.
- National Council of Churches.
- Sylvania.
- TRW.
- U.S. Army.
- U.S. Department of State.
- U.S. Navy.
- U.S. Treasury.
- Volkswagen Company.
- So vast is the reach of IDA that it would take hundreds of
- pages to describe the activities in which it is engaged, and IDA
- is fully described in my book on the role played by Institutions
- and Foundations in committing treason against the United States
- of America, which will be published early in 1992.
-
- RAND RESEARCH AND DEVELOPMENT
- CORPORATION
- Without a doubt, RAND is THE think tank most beholden to
- Tavistock Institute and certainly the RIIA's most prestigious
- vehicle for control of United States policies at every level.
-
- 240
-
- Specific RAND policies that became operative include our
- ICBM program, prime analyses for U.S. foreign policy making,
- instigator of space programs, U.S. nuclear policies, corporate
- analyses, hundreds of projects for the military, the Central lntel-
- ligence Agency (CIA) in relation to the use of mind altering
- drugs like peyote, LSD (the covert MK-Ultra operation which
- lasted for 20 years).
- Some of RAND's clients include the following:
- American Telephone and Telegraph Company (AT&T).
- Chase Manhattan Bank.
- International Business Machines (IBM).
- National Science Foundation.
- Republican Party.
- TRW.
- U.S. Air Force.
- U.S. Department of Energy.
- U.S. Department of Health.
- There are literally THOUSANDS of highly important com-
- panies, government institutions and organizations that make use
- of RAND's services, and to list them all would be an impossible
- task. Among RAND's "specialities" is a study group that pre-
- dicts the timing and the direction of a thermonuclear war, plus
- working out the many scenarios based upon its findings. RAND
- was once accused of being commissioned by the USSR to work
- out terms of surrender of the United States Government, an
- accusation that went all the way to the United States Senate,
- where it was taken up by Senator Symington and subsequently
- fell victim to articles of scorn poured out by the establishment
- press. BRAIN WASHING remains the primary function of RAND.
- To summarize, the major Tavistock institutions in the United
- States engaged in brainwashing at all levels, including govern-
- ment, the military, business, religious organizations and educa-
- tion are the following:
- Brookings Institution.
- Hudson Institute.
-
- 241
-
- Institute for Policy Studies.
- Massachusetts Institute of Technology.
- National Training Laboratories.
- Rand Research and Development Corporation.
- Stanford Research Institute.
- Wharton School at University of Pennsylvania.
- It is estimated by sources of mine that the total number of
- people employed by these institutions is in the region of 50,000
- with funding close to $lO billion dollars.
- Some major world-wide Committee of 300 institutions and
- organizations are as follows:
- Americans for a Safe Israel.
- Biblical Archaeology Review.
- Bilderbergers.
- British Petroleum.
- Canadian Institute of Foreign Relations.
- Christian Fundamentalism.
- Council on Foreign Relations, New York.
- Egyptian Exploration Society.
- Imperial Chemical Industries.
- International Institute for Strategic Studies.
- Order of Skull and Bones.
- Palestine Exploration Fund.
- Poor Knights of the Templars
- Royal Dutch Shell Company.
- Socialist International.
- South Africa Foundation.
- Tavistock Institute of Human Relations.
- Temple Mount Foundation.
- The Atheist Club.
- The Fourth State of Consciousness Club.
- The Hermetic Order of the Golden Dawn.
- The Milner Group.
- The Nasi Princes.
- The Order of Magna Mater.
-
- 242
-
- The Order of the Divine Disorder.
- The RIIA.
- The Round Table.
- Trilateral Commission.
- Universal Freemasonry.
- Universal Zionism.
- Vickers Armament Company.
- Warren Commission.
- Watergate Committee.
- Wilton Park.
- World Council of Churches.
-
- PAST AND PRESENT MEMBERS OF THE
- COMMITTEE OF 300
-
- Abergavemy, Marquis of.
- Acheson, Dean.
- Adeane, Lord Michael.
- Agnelli, Giovanni.
- Alba, Duke of.
- Aldington, Lord.
- Aleman, Miguel.
- Allihone, Professor T. E.
- Alsop Family Designate.
- Amory, Houghton.
- Anderson, Charles A.
- Anderson, Robert 0.
- Andreas, Dwayne.
- Asquith, Lord.
- Astor, John Jacob and successor, Waldorf.
- Aurangzeb, Descendants of.
- Austin, Paul.
- Baco, Sir Ranulph
- BalFour, Arthur.
-
- 243
-
-
- Balogh, Lord.
- Bancroft, Baron Stormont.
- Baring.
- Barnato, B.
- Barran, Sir John.
- Baxendell, Sir Peter.
- Beatrice of Savoy, Princess.
- Beaverbrook, Lord.
- Beck, Robert.
- Beeley, Sir Harold.
- Beit, Alfred.
- Benn, Anthony Wedgewood.
- Bennet, John W.
- Benneton, Gilberto or alternate Carlo.
- Bertie, Andrew.
- Besant, Sir Walter.
- Bethal, Lord Nicholas.
- Bialkin, David.
- Biao, Keng.
- Bingham, William.
- Binny, J. F.
- Blunt, Wilfred.
- Bonacassi, Franco Orsini.
- Bottcher, Fritz.
- Bradshaw, Thornton.
- Brandt, Willy.
- Brewster, Kingman.
- Buchan, Alastair.
- Buffet, Warren.
- Bullitt, William C.
- Bulwer-Lytton, Edward.
- Bundy, McGeorge.
- Bundy, William.
- Bush, George.
- Cabot, John. Family Designate.
-
- 244
-
- Caccia, Baron Harold Anthony.
- Cadman, Sir John.
- Califano, Joseph.
- Carrington, Lord.
- Carter, Edward.
- Catlin, Donat.
- Catto, Lord.
- Cavendish, Victor C. W. Duke of Devonshire.
- Chamberlain, Houston Stewart.
- Chang, V. F.
- Chechirin, Georgi or Family Designate.
- Churchill, Winston.
- Cicireni, V. or Family Designate.
- Cini, Count Vittorio.
- Clark, Howard.
- Cleveland, Amory.
- Cleveland, Harland.
- Clifford, Clark.
- Cobold, Lord.
- Coffin, the Rev William Sloane.
- Constanti, House of Orange.
- Cooper, John. Family Designate.
- Coudenhove-Kalergi, Count.
- Cowdray, Lord.
- Cox, Sir Percy.
- Cromer, Lord Evelyn Baring.
- Crowther, Sir Eric.
- Cumming, Sir Mansfield.
- Curtis, Lionel.
- d'Arcy, William K.
- D'Avignon, Count Etienne.
- Danner, Jean Duroc.
- Davis, John W.
- de Benneditti, Carlo.
- De Bruyne, Dirk.
-
- 245
-
- De Gunzberg, Baron Alain.
- De Lamater, Major General Walter.
- De Menil, Jean.
- De Vries, Rimmer.
- de Zulueta, Sir Philip.
- de'Aremberg, Marquis Charles Louis.
- Delano. Family Designate.
- Dent, R.
- Deterding, Sir Henri.
- di Spadaforas, Count Guitierez, (House
- Douglas-Home, Sir Alec.
- Drake, Sir Eric.
- Duchene, Francois.
- DuPont.
- Edward, Duke of Kent.
- Eisenberg, Shaul.
- Elliott, Nicholas.
- Elliott, William Yandel.
- Elsworthy, Lord.
- Farmer, Victor.
- Forbes, John M.
- Foscaro, Pierre.
- France, Sir Arnold.
- Fraser, Sir Hugh.
- Frederik IX, King of Denmark Family Designate.
- Freres, Lazard.
- Frescobaldi, Lamberto.
- Fribourg, Michael.
- Gabor, Dennis.
- Gallatin, Albert. Family Designate.
- Gardner, Richard.
- Geddes, Sir Auckland.
- Geddes, Sir Reay.
- George, Lloyd.
- Giffen, James.
-
- 246
-
- Gilmer, John D.
- Giustiniani, Justin.
- Gladstone, Lord.
- Gloucestor, The Duke of.
- Gordon, Walter Lockhart.
- Grace, Peter J.
- Greenhill, Lord Dennis Arthur.
- Greenhill, Sir Dennis.
- Grey, Sir Edward.
- Gyllenhammar, Pierres.
- Haakon, King of Norway.
- Haig, Sir Douglas.
- Hailsham, Lord.
- Haldane, Richard Burdone.
- Halifax, Lord.
- Hall, Sir Peter Vickers.
- Hambro, Sir Jocelyn.
- Hamilton, Cyril.
- Harriman, Averill.
- Hart, Sir Robert.
- Hartman, Arthur H.
- Healey, Dennis.
- Helsby, Lord.
- Her Majesty Queen Elizabeth II.
- Her Majesty Queen Juliana.
- Her Royal Highness Princess Beatrix.
- Her Royal Highness Queen Margreta.
- Heseltine, Sir William.
- Hesse, Grand Duke descendants, Family Designate.
- Hoffman, Paul G.
- Holland, William.
- House of Braganza.
- House of Hohenzollern.
- House, Colonel Mandel.
- Howe, Sir Geoffrey.
-
- 247
-
- Hughes, Thomas H.
- Hugo, Thieman.
- Hutchins, Robert M.
- Huxley, Aldous.
- Inchcape, Lord.
- Jamieson, Ken.
- Japhet, Ernst Israel.
- Jay, John. Family Designate.
- Keynes, John Maynard.
- Jodry, J. J.
- Joseph, Sir Keith.
- Katz, Milton.
- Kaufman, Asher.
- Keith, Sir Kenneth.
- Keswick, Sir William Johnston, or Keswick, H.N.L.
- Keswick, William Johnston.
- Kimberly, Lord.
- King, Dr. Alexander.
- Kirk, Grayson L.
- Kissinger, Henry.
- Kitchener, Lord Horatio.
- Kohnstamm, Max.
- Korsch, Karl.
- Lambert, Baron Pierre.
- Lawrence, G.
- Lazar.
- Lehrman, Lewis.
- Lever, Sir Harold.
- Lewin, Dr. Kurt.
- Lippmann, Walter.
- Livingstone, Robert R. Family Designate.
- Lockhart, Bruce.
- Lockhart, Gordon.
- Linowitz, S.
- Loudon, Sir John.
-
- 248
-
- Luzzatto, Pieipaolo.
- Mackay, Lord, of Clasfern.
- Mackay-Tallack, Sir Hugh.
- Mackinder, Halford.
- MacMillan, Harold.
- Matheson, Jardine.
- Mazzini, Gueseppi.
- McClaughlin, W. E.
- McCloy, John J.
- McFadyean, Sir Andrew.
- McGhee, George.
- McMillan, Harold.
- Mellon, Andrew.
- Mellon, William Larimer or Family Designate.
- Meyer, Frank.
- Michener, Roland.
- Mikovan, Anastas.
- Milner, Lord Alfred.
- Mitterand, Francois.
- Monett, Jean.
- Montague, Samuel.
- Montefiore, Lord Sebag or Bishop Hugh.
- Morgan, John P.
- Mott, Stewart.
- Mountain, Sir Brian Edward.
- Mountain, Sir Dennis.
- Mountbatten, Lord Louis.
- Munthe, A., or family designate.
- Naisbitt, John.
- Neeman, Yuval.
- Newbigging, David.
- Nicols, Lord Nicholas of Bethal.
- Norman, Montague.
- O'Brien of Lotherby, Lord.
- Ogilvie, Angus.
-
- 249
-
- Okita, Saburo.
- Oldfield, Sir Morris.
- Oppenheimer, Sir Earnest, and successor, Harry.
- Ormsby Gore, David (Lord Harlech).
- Orsini, Franco Bonacassi.
- Ortolani. Umberto.
- Ostiguy, J.P.W.
- Paley, William S.
- Pallavacini.
- Palme, Olaf.
- Palmerston.
- Palmstierna, Jacob.
- Pao, Y.K.
- Pease, Richard T.
- Peccei, Aurellio.
- Peek, Sir Edmund.
- Pellegreno, Michael, Cardinal.
- Perkins, Nelson.
- Pestel, Eduard.
- Peterson, Rudolph.
- Petterson, Peter G.
- Petty, John R.
- Philip, Prince, Duke of Edinburgh.
- Piercy, George.
- Pinchott, Gifford.
- Pratt, Charles.
- Price Waterhouse, Designate.
- Radziwall.
- Ranier, Prince.
- Raskob, John Jacob.
- Recanati.
- Rees, John Rawlings.
- Rees, John.
- Rennie, Sir John.
- Rettinger, Joseph.
-
- 250
-
- Rhodes, Cecil John.
- Rockefeller, David.
- Role, Lord Eric of Ipsden.
- Rosenthal, Morton.
- Rostow, Eugene.
- Rothmere, Lord.
- Rothschild Elie de or Edmon de and/or Baron RothschiLd
- Runcie, Dr.Robert.
- Russell, Lord John.
- Russell, Sir Bertrand.
- Saint Gouers, Jean.
- Salisbury, Marquisse de Robert Gascoiugne Cecil. Shelburne,
- The Salisbury, Lord.
- Samuel, Sir Marcus.
- Sandberg, M. G.
- Sarnoff, Robert.
- Schmidheiny, Stephan or alternate brothers Thomas,
- Alexander.
- Schoenberg, Andrew.
- Schroeder.
- Schultz, George.
- Schwartzenburg, E.
- Shawcross, Sir Hartley.
- Sheridan, Walter.
- Shiloach, Rubin.
- Silitoe, Sir Percy.
- Simon, William.
- Sloan, Alfred P.
- Smuts, Jan.
- Spelman.
- Sproull, Robert.
- Stals, Dr. C.
- Stamp, Lord Family designate.
- Steel, David.
- Stiger, George.
-
- 251
-
- Strathmore, Lord.
- Strong, Sir Kenneth.
- Strong, Maurice.
- Sutherland.
- Swathling, Lord.
- Swire, J. K.
- Tasse, G. Or Family Designate.
- Temple, Sir R.
- Thompson, William Boyce.
- Thompson, Lord.
- Thyssen-Bornamisza, Baron Hans Henrich.
- Trevelyn, Lord Humphrey.
- Turner, Sir Mark.
- Turner, Ted.
- Tyron, Lord.
- Urquidi, Victor.
- Van Den Broek, H.
- Vanderbilt.
- Vance, Cyrus.
- Verity, William C.
- Vesty, Lord Amuel.
- Vickers, Sir Geoffrey.
- Villiers, Gerald Hyde family alternate.
- Volpi, Count.
- von Finck, Baron August.
- von Hapsburg, Archduke Otto, House of Hapsburg-Lorraine.
- Von Thurn and Taxis, Max.
- Wallenberg, Peter or Family Designate.
- Wang, Kwan Cheng, Dr.
- Warburg, S. C.
- Ward Jackson, Lady Barbara.
- Warner, Rawleigh.
- Warnke, Paul.
- Warren, Earl.
- Watson, Thomas.
-
- 252
-
-
- Webb, Sydney.
- Weill, David.
- Weill, Dr. Andrew.
- Weinberger, Sir Caspar.
- Weizman, Chaim.
- Wells, H. G.
- Wheetman, Pearson (Lord Cowdray).
- White, Sir Dick Goldsmith.
- Whitney, Straight.
- Wiseman, Sir William.
- Wittelsbach.
- Wolfson, Sir Isaac.
- Wood, Charles.
- Young, Owen.
-
-
-
-
- CONSPIRATORS' HIERARCHY:
- THE COMMITTEE OF 300
- BIBLIOGRAPHY, SUMMARIES AND NOTES
-
- 1980'S PROJECT, Vance, Cyrus and Yankelovich, Daniel.
-
- 1984, Orwell, George.
-
- AFTER TWENTY YEARS: THE DECLINE OF NATO AND
- THE SEARCH FOR A NEW POLICY IN EUROPE, Raskin,
- Marcus and Barnett, Richard.
-
- AIR WAR AND STRESS, Janus, Irving.
-
- AN AMERICAN COMPANY; THE TRAGEDY OF UNITED
- FRUIT, Scammel, Henry and McCann, Thomas.
-
- 253
-
- AN INTRODUCTlON TO THE PRINCIPLES AND MORALS
- OF LEGISLATION, Bentham, Jeremy. In this 1780 work
- Bentham claimed that "nature has placed mankind under the
- governance of two sovereign masters, pain and pleasure...
- They govern us in all we do." Bentham went on to justify the
- horrors of the Jacobin terrorists in the French Revolution.
-
- ANNUAL REPORT OF BANK LEUMI, 1977.
-
- AT THAT POINT IN TIME: THE INSIDE STORY OF THE
- SENATE WATERGATE COMMITTEE, Thompson, Fred. I was
- told where to find Thompson, who was the Minority Counsel on
- the Ervin Committee, by Bernard Barker, one of the Watergate
- Burglars. My meeting with Barker took place outside an A&P
- supermarket quite close to the Coral Gables Country Club in
- Coral Gables, Florida. Barker said Thompson was with his law
- partner who was on a short visit to his mother in Coral Gables,
- which was only about five minutes away from the A&P Super-
- market. I went there and met Thompson who expressed his
- disappointment over the way Ervin had imposed such severe
- restrictions on evidence he, Thompson, could admit.
-
- BAKU AN EVENTFUL HISTORY, Henry, J. D.
-
- BEASTS OF THE APOCALYPSE, O'Grady, Olivia Maria.
- This remarkable book gives details about a large number of
- historical figures, including William C. Bullitt, who conspired
- with Lloyd George to pull the rug out from under White Russian
- Generals Denekin and Rangle at a time when they had the
- Bolshevik Red Army on the very brink of defeat. It also gives a
- great deal of information about the utterly corrupt Petroleum
- Industry. Of particular interest is the information it provides on
- Sir Moses Montefiore, of the ancient Venetian Black Nobility
- Montefiores.
-
- BRAVE NEW WORLD, Aldous Huxley.
-
- 254
-
- BRITISH OPIUM POLICY IN CHINA, Owen, David Edward.
-
- BRITISH OPIUM POLICY, F. S. Turner.
-
- CECIL RHODES, Flint, John.
-
- CECIL RHODES, THE ANATOMY OF AN EMPIRE, Marlow,
- John.
-
- CONFERENCE ON TRANSATLANTIC IMBALANCE AN
- COLLABORATION, Rappaport, Dr. Anatol.
-
- CONVERSATIONS WITH DZERZHINSKY, Reilly, Sydney.
- In British Intelligence documents not published.
-
- CREATING A PARTICULAR BEHAVIORAL STRUCTURE,
- Cartwright, Dorwin.
-
- CRYSTALIZING PUBLIC OPINION, Bernays, Edward.
-
- DEMOCRATIC IDEALS AND REALITY, Mackinder, Halford.
-
- ERVIN, SENATOR SAM. Apart from obstructing the introduc-
- tion of vital evidence in the Watergate hearings, Ervin, in my
- opinion, while holding himself out as a Constitutional authority,
- consistently betrayed this nation by opposing aid to church
- schools, citing the judicial opinions in the Everson case. Ervin, a
- Scottish Rite Freemason--which in my opinion is why he was
- given the Watergate Committee chair, was eventually honored
- receiving the prestigious Scottish Rite "Individual Right's Sup-
- port" award. In 1973, Ervin held a luncheon in the Senate
- Dining Room in honor of Sovereign Grand Commander Clausen.
-
- EVERSON VS. BOARD OF EDUCATION, 33O U.S. I, 1947.
-
- FRANKFURTER PAPERS, Box 99 and Box 125, "HUGO
- BLACK CORRESPONDENCE."
-
- 255
-
- GNOSTICISM, MAMCHEANISM, CATHARISM, The New
- Columbia Encyclopedia.
-
- GOALS OF MANLL, Lazlo, Ernin.
-
- GOD'S BANKER, Cornwell, Rupert. This book gave some
- insight into P2 and the murder of Roberto Calvi--P2 Masonry.
-
- HUMAN QUALITY, Peccei, A.
-
- INTERNATIONAL JOURNAL OF ELECTRONICS.
-
- INTRODUCTION TO THE SOCIOLOGY OF MUSIC, Adorno,
- Theo. Adorno was kicked out of Germany by Hitler because of
- his Cult of Dionysus music experiments. He was moved to
- England by the Oppenheimers where the British royal family
- gave him facilities at Gordonstoun School and their support. It
- was here that Adorno perfected "Beatlemusic Rock," "Punk
- Rock" "Heavy Metal Rock" and all of the decadent clamor that
- passes for music today. It is worthy of note that the name "The
- Beatles" was chosen to show a connection between modern
- rock, the Isis cult and the Scarab Beatle, a religious symbol of
- ancient Egypt.
-
- INVASION FROM MARS, Cantril. In this work Cantril ana-
- lyzes the behavior patterns of people who fled in panic follow-
- ing the Orson Wells experiment in mass hysteria, using H.G
- Wells' "WAR OF THE WORLDS."
-
- INVESTIGATION OF THE KENNEDY ASSASSINATION,
- THE UNCOMMISSIONED REPORT ON JIM GARRISON
- FINDINGS. Paris, Flammonde.
-
- IPS REVISITED, Coleman, Dr. John.
-
- ISIS UNVEILED, A MASTER KEY TO THE ANCIENT AND
- MODERN SCIENCE AND THEOLOGY, Blavatsky, Madame
- Helena.
-
- 256
-
- JOHN JACOB ASTOR, BUSINESSMAN, Porter, Kenneth
- Wiggins.
-
- JUSTICE BLACK'S PAPERS, Box 25, General Correspon-
- dence, Davies.
-
- KING MAKERS, KING BREAKERS, THE STORY OF THE
- CECIL FAMILY, Coleman, Dr. John.
-
- LIBERATION THEOLOGY. Information was drawn from work
- by Juan Luis Segundo, who in turn drew heavily upon the
- writings of Karl Marx. Segundo savagely attacked the Catholic
- Church instruction against Liberation Theology as found in
- "Instruction on Certain Aspects of the 'Theology of Libera-
- tion'" published August 6th, 1984.
-
- LIES CLEARER THAN TRUTH, Barnett, Richard (Founder
- member of IPS).
-
- McCalls Magazine, January 1983.
-
- McGRAW HILL GROUP, ASSOCIATED PRESS. Portions of
- reports from 28 magazines owned by McGraw Hill, and AP
- stories.
-
- MEMOIRS OF A BRITISH AGENT, Lockhart, Bruce. In this
- book we are told how the Bolshevik Revolution was controlled
- out of London. Lockhart was Lord Milner's representative who
- went to Russia to watch over Milner's investment in Lenin and
- Trotsky. Lockhart had access to Lenin and Trotsky at short
- notice even though Lenin frequently had a waiting room full of
- high-ranking officials and foreign delegates, some having been
- waiting to see him for as long as five days. Yet Lockhart never
- had to wait more than a few hours to see either man. Lockhart
- carried a letter signed by Trotsky informing all Bolshevik officials
- that Lockhart had special status and should be given the utmost
- cooperation at all times.
-
- 257
-
- MIND GAMES, Murphy, Michael.
-
- MISCELLANEOUS OLD RECORDS, India House Documents,
- London.
-
- MK ULTRA LSD EXPERIMENT, CIA Files 1953-1957.
-
- MR. WILLIAM CECIL AND QUEEN ELIZABETH, Read,
- Conyers.
-
- MURDER, Anslinger, Henry. Anslinger was at one time the
- Number 1 agent in the Drug Enforcement Agency and his book
- is highly critical of the so-called war on drugs allegedly being
- waged by the U.S. Government.
-
- MY FATHER, A REMEMBRANCE, Black, Hugo L., Jr.
-
- NATIONAL COUNCIL OF CHURCHES, Josephson, Emman-
- uel in his book "ROCKEFELLER, INTERNATIONALIST."
-
- OIL IMPERIALISM, THE INTERNATIONAL STRUGGLE
- FOR PETROLEUM, Fischer, Louis.
-
- PAPERS OF SIR GEORGE BIRDWOOD, India House Docu-
- ments, London.
-
- PATTERNS IN EASDEA TITLE I READING ACHIEVEMENT
- TESTS, Stanford Research Institute.
-
- POPULATION BOMB, Erlich, Paul.
-
- PROFESSOR FREDERICK WELLS WILLIAMSON, India
- House Documents, London.
-
- PUBLIC AGENDA FOUNDATION. Founded in 1975 by Cyrus
- Vance and Daniel Yankelovich.
-
- PUBLIC OPINION, Lippmann, Walter.
-
- 258
-
- REVOLUTION THROUGH TECHNOLOGY, Coudenhove
- Kalergi, Count.
-
- ROCKEFELLER, INTERNATIONALIST. Josephson details
- how the Rockefellers used their wealth to penetrate the Chris-
- tian Church in America and how they later used their Number 1
- agent, John Foster Dulles--who was related to them--to main-
- tain their grip on every aspect of church life in this country.
-
- ROOM 3603, Hyde, Montgomery. The book gives some detail
- about M16 British Intelligence operations run by Sir William
- Stephenson out of the RCA Building in New York; but, as is
- usual with "cover stories," the REAL events have been omitted.
-
- SPECIAL RELATIONSHIPS: AMERICA IN PEACE AND
- WAR, Wheeler-Bennet, Sir John.
-
- STEPS TO THE ECOLOGY OF THE MIND, Bateson, Gre-
- gory. Bateson was one of the Tavistock new-science scientists in
- the top five at Tavistock and later did much to formulate and
- manage the 46-year war on America conducted by Tavistock.
-
- STERLING DRUG. William C. Bullitt was once on its board of
- directors and was also on the board of I.G. Farben.
-
- TECHNOTRONIC ERA, Brzezinski, Z.
-
- TERRORISM IN THE UNITED STATES INCLUDING AT-
- TACKS ON U.S. INTELLIGENCE AGENCIES: FBI Files #
- 100-447935, #100-447735, and #100-446784.
-
- THE CAIRO DOCUMENTS, Haikal, Mohammed. Haikal was
- the grand old man of Egyptian journalism, and he was present at
- the interview given to Chou En-lai by Nasser in which the
- Chinese leader vowed to "get even" with Britain and the U.S
- over their opium trade in China.
-
- 259
-
- THE CHASM AHEAD, Peccei, A.
-
- THE DlARIES OF SIR BRUCE LOCKHART, Lockhart, Bruce.
-
- THE ENGINEERING OF CONSENT, Bernays. In this 1955
- book, Bernays lays out the modus operandi of how to persuade
- targeted groups to change their minds on important issues that
- can and do alter the national direction of a country. The book
- also deals with the unleashing of psychiatric shock troops such
- as we see in lesbian and homosexual organizations, environ-
- mental groups, abortion rights groups and the like. "Psychiatric
- shock troops" was a concept developed by John Rawlings Reese,
- the founder of the Tavistock Institute of Human Relations.
-
- THE FEDERAL BUDGET AND SOCIAL RECONSTRUC-
- TION, IPS Fellows Raskin and Barnett. A list of members of
- Congress who asked IPS to produce the alternative budget study
- and/or supported it is too long to include here but contained
- such prominent names as Tom Harkness, Henry Ruess, Patricia
- Schroeder, Les Aspin, Ted Weiss, Don Edwards, Barbara
- Mikulski, Mary Rose Oakar, Ronald Dellums and Peter Rodino.
-
- THE HUXLEYS, Clark.
-
- THE IMPERIAL DRUG TRADE, Rowntree.
-
- THE JESUITS, Martin, Malachi.
-
- THE LATER CECILS, Rose, Kenneth.
-
- THE LEGACY OF MALTHUS, Chase, Allan.
-
- THE MANAGEMENT OF SUSTAINABLE GROWTH,
- Cleveland, Harlan. Cleveland was commissioned by NATO to
- report on just how far the Club of Rome's Post Industrial
-
- 260
-
- Society-Zero Growth blueprint to wreck the industrial base of
- the United States had succeeded. This shocking document should
- be read by every patriotic American who feels an urgent need
- for an explanation as to why the U.S. is in a deep economic
- depression at the end of 1991.
-
- THE MEN WHO RULED INDIA, Woodruff, Philip.
-
- THE OPEN CONSPIRACY, Wells, H. G. In this work, Wells
- describes how in the New World Order (which he calls the New
- Republic) "useless eaters," excess population, will be gotten rid
- of: "The men of the New Republic will not be squeamish either
- in facing or inflicting death.... They will have an ideal that will
- make killing worthwhile; like Abraham, they will have the faith
- to kill, and they will have no superstitions about death.... They
- will hold, I anticipate, that a certain portion of the population
- exists only on sufferance out of pity and patience, and, on the
- understanding that they do not propagate, and I do not foresee
- any reason to oppose that they will not hesitate to kill when that
- sufferance is abused.... All such killings will be done with an
- opiate.... If deterrent punishments are used at all in the code of
- the future, the deterrent shall be neither death, nor mutilation of
- the body...but good scientifically caused pain." The United
- States has a very large contingent of Wells converts who would
- not hesitate to follow the dictates of Wells, once the New World
- Order becomes a reality. Walter Lippmann was one of Wells'
- most ardent disciples.
-
- THE POLITICS OF EXPERIENCE, Laing, R.D. Laing was the
- Staff Psychologist at Tavistock and, under Andrew Schofield, a
- member of the Governing Council.
-
- THE POLITICS OF HEROIN IN SOUTH EAST ASIA, McCoy,
- Alfred W., Read, C.B and Adams, Leonard P.
-
- THE PROBLEM OF CHINA, Russell, Bertrand.
-
- 261
-
- THE PUGWASH CONFEREES, Bertrand Russell. In the early
- 1950's Russell led a movement urging a nuclear attack on
- Russia. When it was discovered, Stalin warned that he would
- not hesitate to retaliate in kind. This led to a quick "rethink" on
- he part of Russell, who almost overnight became a pacifist
- thus was born the "Ban the Bomb" Campaign for Nuclear
- Disarmament (CND) out of which arose the Pugwash anti-
- nuclear scientists. In 1957 the first group met at the home of
- Cyrus Eaton in Nova Scotia, a long-time American Communist.
- The Pugwash Conferees dedicated themselves to anti-nuclear
- and environmental issues and were a thorn in the side of U.S.
- efforts to develop nuclear weapons.
-
- THE ROUND TABLE MOVEMENT AND IMPERIAL
- UNION, Kendle, John.
-
- THE STRUCTURE OF THE POPULAR MUSIC INDUSTRY;
- THE FILTERING PROCESS WHEREBY RECORDS ARE
- SELECTED FOR PUBLIC CONSUMPTION, Institute for So-
- cial Research. This work explains how "Hit Parades," "The Top
- Ten"--now expanded to the "Top Forty"--and other charades
- are constructed to deceive listeners and convince them what
- they hear is what "THEY" like!
-
- THE WORKS OF JEREMY BENTHAM, Bowering, John.
- Bentham was the liberal of his day and the agent for Lord
- Shelburne, British Prime Minister at the end of the American
- War of Independence. Bentham believed that man was no more
- than a common animal, and Bentham's theories were later writ-
- ten up by his protege, David Hume. Writing about instinct in
- animals Hume said, "...which we are so apt to admire as extra-
- ordinary and inexplicable. But our wonder will perhaps cease or
- diminish when we consider that the experimental reasoning
- itself which we possess in common with beasts, and upon which
- the whole conduct of life depends, is nothing but a species of
-
- 262
-
- instinct, or mechanical power that acts in us unknown to our-
- selves.... Though the instincts be different, yet still it is an
- instinct."
-
- TIME PERSPECTIVE AND MORALE, Levin B.
-
- TOWARD A HUMANISTIC PSYCHOLOGY, Cantril.
-
- TREND REPORT, Naisbitt, John.
-
- U.S. CONGRESS, HOUSE COMMITTEE ON INTERNAL
- SECURITY, REPORTING ON THE INSTITUTE FOR POLICY
- STUDIES (IPS) AND THE PENTAGON PAPERS. In the spring
- of 1970, FBI operative William McDermott went to see Richard
- Best, who at that time was Rand's top security officer, to warn
- him of the possibility that Ellsberg had removed Vietnam study
- papers done by Rand and had copied them outside of Rand
- premises. Best took McDermott to see Dr. Harry Rowan who
- headed Rand and who was also one of Ellsberg's closest friends.
- Rowan told the FBI that a Defense Department inquiry was
- going on and on his assurance, the FBI apparently dropped its
- investigation of Ellsberg. In fact, no inquiry was in progress, nor
- did the DoD ever conduct one. Ellsberg retained his security
- clearance at Rand and blatantly went on removing and copying
- Vietnam War documents right up to the time of his exposure
- during the Pentagon Papers affair which rocked the Nixon
- Administration to its foundations.
-
- UNDERSTANDING MAN'S SOCIAL BEHAVIOR, Cantril.
- Cantril was primarily responsible for establishing the Association
- for Humanistic Psychology based in San Francisco that taught
- Tavistock methods. It is in institutions of this type that we find
- the lines between pure science and social engineering become
- totally obliterated. The term "social engineering" covers every
- aspect of methods used by Tavistock to bring about massive
-
- 263
-
- charges in group orientation toward social, economic, religious
- and political events and brainwashing of target groups who then
- believe that opinions expressed and viewpoints taken are their
- own. Selected individuals underwent the same Tavistockian
- treatment, resulting in major shifts in personality and behavior.
- The effect of this on the national scene was, and still is, devastat-
- ing and is one of the principal factors in bringing the United
- States into the twilight, decline and fall state-of-being in which
- the country finds itself at the close of 1991. I did a report on this
- national condition under the title: "Twilight, Decline and Fall of
- the United States of America" which was published in l987.
- The Association for Human Psychology was founded by
- Abraham Maselov in l957 as a Club of Rome project. Another
- Tavistock-Club of Rome Commissioned opinion-making
- research center was established by Risis Likhert and Ronald
- Lippert who called it The Center for Research in the Utilization
- of Scientific Knowledge. The facility was under the directorship
- of Club of Rome's Donald Michael. The center drew heavily on
- the Office of Public Opinion Research established at Princeton
- University in l940. It was from here that Cantril taught many of
- the techniques used by today's pollsters-opinion makers.
-
- UNPUBLlSHED LETTERS, Kipling, Rudyard. Kipling was a
- Wells disciple and, like Wells, believed in Fascism, as a means of
- world control. Kipling adopted the Running Cross as his per-
- sonal emblem. The Running Cross was later adopted by Hitler
- and with slight modifications became known as the swastika.
-
- UNPUBLISHED LETTERS, Wells, H. G. Gives interesting
- details of how Wells sold the rights to "WAR OF THE WORLDS"
- to RCA.
-
- WHO OWNS MONTREAL, Aubin, Henry.
-
- WHO'S WHO IN CANADA, several editions.
-
- 264
-
-
- **** End of Book ****
-
- Don
-
-
- --
- <*> Don Allen <*> 1:363/81.1 - Fidonet #1 - Homebody BBS
- dona@bilver.uucp - Internet 1:363/29.8 - Fidonet #2 - Gourmet Delight
- 88:4205/1.1 - MUFON Network 1:3607/20.2 -- Odyssey - Alabama UFO Net
- NSA grep food: Aviary, Ed Dames, Los Alamos - Majestic - Jason - RIIA - UN
-
-